415
RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description Issue 0.5 Date 2011-09-03 HUAWEI TECHNOLOGIES CO., LTD.

RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

Embed Size (px)

DESCRIPTION

Feature RAN14

Citation preview

Page 1: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5

Date 2011-09-03

HUAWEI TECHNOLOGIES CO., LTD.

Page 2: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 2010. All rights reserved.

No part of this document may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means without

prior written consent of Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Trademarks and Permissions

and other Huawei trademarks are the property of Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. All other

trademarks and trade names mentioned in this document are the property of their respective

holders.

Notice

The purchased products, services and features are stipulated by the commercial contract made

between Huawei and the customer. All or partial products, services and features described in this

document may not be within the purchased scope or the usage scope. Unless otherwise agreed by

the contract, all statements, information, and recommendations in this document are provided “AS

IS” without warranties, guarantees or representations of any kind, either express or implied.

The information in this document is subject to change without notice. Every effort has been made in

the preparation of this document to ensure accuracy of the contents, but all statements, information,

and recommendations in this document do not constitute the warranty of any kind, express or

implied.

Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Address: Huawei Industrial Base

Bantian, Longgang

Shenzhen 518129

People's Republic of China

Website: http://www.huawei.com

Email: [email protected]

Telephone: 0755-28560000 4008302118

Fax: 0755-28560111

Page 3: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 3 of 415

Contents

1 Voice & Service............................................................................................................................ 11

1.1 VoIP ................................................................................................................................................................ 11

1.1.1 WRFD-010617 VoIP over HSPA/HSPA+ ............................................................................................. 11

1.1.2 WRFD-01061701 RAB Mapping ......................................................................................................... 12

1.1.3 WRFD-01061703 Optimized Scheduling for VoIP over HSPA ............................................................ 14

1.1.4 WRFD-010618 IMS Signaling over HSPA ........................................................................................... 16

1.1.5 WRFD-011501 PDCP Header Compression (RoHC) ........................................................................... 17

1.1.6 WRFD-010619 CS voice over HSPA/HSPA+ ...................................................................................... 18

1.2 Crystal Voice .................................................................................................................................................. 20

1.2.1 WRFD-010613 AMR-WB (Adaptive Multi Rate Wide Band) ............................................................. 20

1.2.2 WRFD-020701 AMR/WB-AMR Speech Rates Control ....................................................................... 22

1.2.3 WRFD-011600 TFO/TrFO .................................................................................................................... 23

1.2.4 WRFD-140201 AMR Voice Quality Improvement Based on PLVA ..................................................... 25

1.3 CBS ................................................................................................................................................................ 27

1.3.1 WRFD-011000 Cell Broadcast Service................................................................................................. 27

1.3.2 WRFD-011001 Simplified Cell Broadcast ............................................................................................ 28

1.3.3 WRFD-020127 Warning of Disaster ..................................................................................................... 29

1.4 MBMS ............................................................................................................................................................ 31

1.4.1 WRFD-010616 MBMS Introduction Package ...................................................................................... 31

1.4.2 WRFD-01061601 MBMS Broadcast Mode .......................................................................................... 33

1.4.3 WRFD-01061602 MBMS Admission Control ...................................................................................... 34

1.4.4 WRFD-01061603 MBMS Load Control ............................................................................................... 35

1.4.5 WRFD-01061604 MBMS Soft/Selective Combining ........................................................................... 37

1.4.6 WRFD-01061605 MBMS Transport Resource Management ............................................................... 38

1.4.7 WRFD-01061606 Streaming Service on MBMS .................................................................................. 39

1.4.8 WRFD-01061607 MBMS 2 Channels per Cell .................................................................................... 40

1.4.9 WRFD-01061608 16/32/64/128Kbit/s Channel Rate on MBMS.......................................................... 41

1.4.10 WRFD-010660 MBMS Phase 2 .......................................................................................................... 42

1.4.11 WRFD-01066001 MBMS Enhanced Broadcast Mode ....................................................................... 43

1.4.12 WRFD-01066002 MBMS P2P over HSDPA ...................................................................................... 44

1.4.13 WRFD-01066003 MBMS Admission Enhancement .......................................................................... 45

1.4.14 WRFD-01066004 Inter-Frequency Neighboring Cell Selection for MBMS PTP Users ..................... 47

Page 4: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 4 of 415

1.4.15 WRFD-010627 FACH Transmission Sharing for MBMS .................................................................. 48

1.4.16 WRFD-010626 MBMS FLC(Frequency Layer Convergence)/FLD(Frequency Layer Dispersion) ... 50

1.4.17 WRFD-010624 MBMS 8 Channels per Cell ...................................................................................... 51

1.4.18 WRFD-010625 256Kbit/s Channel Rate on MBMS ........................................................................... 52

1.4.19 WRFD-010628 MBMS 16 Channels per Cell .................................................................................... 53

1.4.20 WRFD-010661 MBMS over Iur ......................................................................................................... 54

1.4.21 WRFD-010662 Dynamic Power Estimation for MTCH ..................................................................... 55

1.4.22 WRFD-010663 MSCH Scheduling ..................................................................................................... 56

1.4.23 WRFD-010665 MBMS Channel Audience Rating Statistics .............................................................. 58

1.5 LCS ................................................................................................................................................................ 59

1.5.1 WRFD-020801 Cell ID + RTT Function Based LCS ........................................................................ 59

1.5.2 WRFD-020802 OTDOA Based LCS .................................................................................................... 61

1.5.3 WRFD-020803 A-GPS Based LCS ....................................................................................................... 62

1.5.4 WRFD-020804 LCS Classified Zones .................................................................................................. 63

1.5.5 WRFD-020805 LCS over Iur ................................................................................................................ 64

1.5.6 WRFD-020807 Iupc Interface for LCS service .................................................................................... 68

1.6 PTT................................................................................................................................................................. 70

1.6.1 WRFD-020134 Push to Talk ................................................................................................................. 70

2 MBB ............................................................................................................................................... 73

2.1 HSUPA Prime Service .................................................................................................................................... 73

2.1.1 WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package...................................................................................... 73

2.1.2 WRFD-01061201 HSUPA UE Category Support ................................................................................. 74

2.1.3 WRFD-01061209 HSUPA HARQ and Fast UL Scheduling in Node B ............................................... 76

2.1.4 WRFD-01061202 HSUPA Admission Control ..................................................................................... 78

2.1.5 WRFD-01061203 HSUPA Power Control ............................................................................................ 79

2.1.6 WRFD-01061204 HSUPA Mobility Management ................................................................................ 81

2.1.7 WRFD-01061208 HSUPA DCCC ......................................................................................................... 83

2.1.8 WRFD-01061207 HSUPA Transport Resource Management ............................................................... 85

2.1.9 WRFD-01061206 Interactive and Background Traffic Class on HSUPA ............................................. 87

2.1.10 WRFD-01061210 HSUPA 1.44Mbit/s per User.................................................................................. 88

2.1.11 WRFD-01061211 20 HSUPA Users per Cell ...................................................................................... 89

2.1.12 WRFD-010614 HSUPA Phase 2 ......................................................................................................... 90

2.1.13 WRFD-01061401 HSUPA E-AGCH Power Control (Based on CQI or HS-SCCH) ....................... 91

2.1.14 WRFD-01061402 Enhanced Fast UL Scheduling............................................................................... 93

2.1.15 WRFD-01061403 HSUPA 2ms TTI .................................................................................................... 94

2.1.16 WRFD-01061404 HSUPA 2ms/10ms TTI Handover ......................................................................... 96

2.1.17 WRFD-01061405 HSUPA 5.74Mbit/s per User.................................................................................. 97

2.1.18 WRFD-010632 Streaming Traffic Class on HSUPA ........................................................................... 98

2.1.19 WRFD-010635 HSUPA over Iur ......................................................................................................... 99

2.1.20 WRFD-010640 Uplink Macro Diversity Intelligent Receiving ........................................................ 101

Page 5: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 5 of 415

2.1.21 WRFD-010690 TTI Switch for BE Services Based on Coverage ..................................................... 102

2.2 HSUPA Performance Improvement.............................................................................................................. 104

2.2.1 WRFD-010641 HSUPA Adaptive Transmission ................................................................................. 104

2.2.2 WRFD-010638 Dynamic CE Resource Management ......................................................................... 105

2.2.3 WRFD-01061212 HSUPA Iub Flow Control in Case of Iub Congestion ........................................... 107

2.2.4 WRFD-010692 HSUPA FDE .............................................................................................................. 108

2.2.5 WRFD-010712 Adaptive Configuration of Traffic Channel Power offset for HSUPA ....................... 109

2.2.6 WRFD-020136 Anti-Interference Scheduling for HSUPA ................................................................. 111

2.2.7 WRFD-020137 Dual-Threshold Scheduling with HSUPA Interference Cancellation ........................ 112

2.2.8 WRFD-010634 60 HSUPA Users per Cell .......................................................................................... 113

2.2.9 WRFD-010210 Control Channel Parallel Interference Cancellation (CCPIC) ................................... 114

2.2.10 WRFD-140202 Control Channel Parallel Interference Cancellation (Phase 2) ................................ 115

2.2.11 WRFD-010691 HSUPA UL Interference Cancellation ..................................................................... 116

2.2.12 WRFD-010636 SRB over HSUPA .................................................................................................... 119

2.3 HSDPA Prime Service .................................................................................................................................. 120

2.3.1 WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package.................................................................................... 120

2.3.2 WRFD-01061017 QPSK Modulation ................................................................................................. 122

2.3.3 WRFD-01061001 15 Codes per Cell .................................................................................................. 123

2.3.4 WRFD-01061018 Time and HS-PDSCH Codes Multiplex ................................................................ 124

2.3.5 WRFD-01061009 HSDPA H-ARQ & Scheduling (MAX C/I, RR and PF) ....................................... 125

2.3.6 WRFD-01061005 HSDPA Static Code Allocation and RNC-Controlled Dynamic Code Allocation . 126

2.3.7 WRFD-01061004 HSDPA Power Control .......................................................................................... 128

2.3.8 WRFD-01061003 HSDPA Admission Control ................................................................................... 130

2.3.9 WRFD-01061020 Improvement of User Experience in Low Traffic Service ..................................... 131

2.3.10 WRFD-01061019 HSDPA Dynamic Power Allocation .................................................................... 133

2.3.11 WRFD-01061010 HSDPA Flow Control .......................................................................................... 134

2.3.12 WRFD-01061006 HSDPA Mobility Management ............................................................................ 135

2.3.13 WRFD-01061014 HSDPA Transport Resource Management ........................................................... 137

2.3.14 WRFD-01061008 Interactive and Background Traffic Class on HSDPA ......................................... 139

2.3.15 WRFD-01061002 HSDPA UE Category 1 to 28............................................................................... 140

2.3.16 WRFD-01061015 HSDPA 1.8Mbit/s per User.................................................................................. 143

2.3.17 WRFD-01061016 16 HSDPA Users per Cell .................................................................................... 144

2.3.18 WRFD-010620 HSDPA 3.6Mbit/s per User ..................................................................................... 145

2.3.19 WRFD-010629 DL 16QAM Modulation .......................................................................................... 146

2.4 HSDPA Performance Improvement.............................................................................................................. 147

2.4.1 WRFD-010631 Dynamic Code Allocation Based on Node B ............................................................ 147

2.4.2 WRFD-010621 HSDPA 7.2Mbit/s per User ....................................................................................... 148

2.4.3 WRFD-010622 32 HSDPA Users per Cell .......................................................................................... 149

2.4.4 WRFD-010611 HSDPA Enhanced Package ........................................................................................ 150

2.4.5 WRFD-01061103 Scheduling based on EPF and GBR ...................................................................... 151

2.4.6 WRFD-01061111 HSDPA State Transition ......................................................................................... 153

Page 6: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 6 of 415

2.4.7 WRFD-01061112 HSDPA DRD ......................................................................................................... 154

2.4.8 WRFD-01061113 HS-DPCCH Preamble Support .............................................................................. 156

2.4.9 WRFD-010630 Streaming Traffic Class on HSDPA ........................................................................... 158

2.4.10 WRFD-010650 HSDPA 13.976Mbit/s per User................................................................................ 159

2.4.11 WRFD-010651 HSDPA over Iur ....................................................................................................... 160

2.4.12 WRFD-010652 SRB over HSDPA .................................................................................................... 162

2.4.13 WRFD-010623 64 HSDPA Users per Cell ........................................................................................ 163

2.4.14 WRFD-030010 CQI Adjustment Based on Dynamic BLER Target ................................................. 164

2.4.15 WRFD-030011 MIMO Prime ........................................................................................................... 165

2.4.16 WRFD-030004 Adaptive Configuration of Typical HSPA Rate ....................................................... 167

2.5 HSPA+ Prime Service .................................................................................................................................. 168

2.5.1 WRFD-010680 HSPA+ Downlink 28Mbit/s per User ........................................................................ 168

2.5.2 WRFD-010681 HSPA+ Downlink 21Mbit/s per User ........................................................................ 169

2.5.3 WRFD-010685 Downlink Enhanced L2 ............................................................................................. 170

2.5.4 WRFD-010689 HSPA+ Downlink 42Mbit/s per User ........................................................................ 171

2.5.5 WRFD-010683 Downlink 64QAM ..................................................................................................... 173

2.5.6 WRFD-010684 2×2 MIMO ................................................................................................................ 174

2.5.7 WRFD-010693 DL 64QAM+MIMO .................................................................................................. 176

2.5.8 WRFD-010698 HSPA+ Uplink 11.5 Mbit/s per User ......................................................................... 177

2.5.9 WRFD-010703 HSPA+ Downlink 84 Mbit/s per User (Trial) ............................................................ 178

2.5.10 WRFD-010699 DC-HSDPA+MIMO (Trial) ..................................................................................... 179

2.5.11 WRFD-010694 UL 16QAM .............................................................................................................. 181

2.5.12 WRFD-010695 UL Layer 2 Improvement ........................................................................................ 182

2.5.13 WRFD-010696 DC-HSDPA ............................................................................................................. 183

2.5.14 WRFD-140203 HSPA+ Uplink 23 Mbit/s per User .......................................................................... 185

2.5.15 WRFD-140204 DC-HSUPA ............................................................................................................. 187

2.6 HSPA+ Performance Improvement .............................................................................................................. 189

2.6.1 WRFD-010688 Downlink Enhanced CELL-FACH ............................................................................ 189

2.6.2 WRFD-010700 Performance Improvement of MIMO and HSDPA Co-carrier .................................. 191

2.6.3 WRFD-010686 CPC - DTX / DRX .................................................................................................... 193

2.6.4 WRFD-010687 CPC - HS-SCCH less operation ................................................................................ 194

2.6.5 WRFD-010697 E-DPCCH Boosting .................................................................................................. 196

2.6.6 WRFD-010701 Uplink Enhanced CELL_FACH ................................................................................ 197

2.6.7 WRFD-010653 96 HSDPA Users per Cell .......................................................................................... 198

2.6.8 WRFD-010639 96 HSUPA Users per Cell .......................................................................................... 200

2.6.9 WRFD-010654 128 HSDPA Users per Cell ........................................................................................ 201

2.6.10 WRFD-010670 128 HSUPA Users per Cell ...................................................................................... 202

2.6.11 WRFD-010704 Flexible HSPA+ Technology Selection.................................................................... 203

2.6.12 WRFD-010713 Traffic-Based Activation and Deactivation of the Supplementary Carrier In

Multi-carrier ................................................................................................................................................. 204

2.6.13 WRFD-010702 Enhanced DRX ........................................................................................................ 205

Page 7: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 7 of 415

3 Smart MBB ................................................................................................................................. 207

3.1 Smart Phone Solution ................................................................................................................................... 207

3.1.1 WRFD-020500 Enhanced Fast Dormancy .......................................................................................... 207

3.1.2 WRFD-140205 iPhone Voice Experience Improvement ..................................................................... 209

3.1.3 WRFD-140206 Layered Paging in URA_PCH ................................................................................... 210

3.2 Smart Pipe .................................................................................................................................................... 212

3.2.1 WRFD-020132 Web Browsing Acceleration ...................................................................................... 212

3.2.2 WRFD-020133 P2P Downloading Rate Control during Busy Hour ................................................... 213

4 Green ........................................................................................................................................... 215

4.1 Power Consumption Saving ......................................................................................................................... 215

4.1.1 WRFD-020116 Dynamic Power Sharing in Multi-Carriers ................................................................ 215

4.1.2 WRFD-020117 Multi-Carrier Switch off Based on Traffic Load ....................................................... 216

4.1.3 WRFD-020118 Energy Efficiency Improved ...................................................................................... 217

4.1.4 WRFD-020119 Multi-Carrier Switch off Based on Power Backup .................................................... 219

4.1.5 WRFD-020122 Multi-Carrier Switch off Based on QoS .................................................................... 221

4.1.6 WRFD-020121 Intelligent Power Management .................................................................................. 223

5 Topology & Transmission ....................................................................................................... 225

5.1 RAN Sharing ................................................................................................................................................ 225

5.1.1 WRFD-021304 RAN Sharing Introduction Package .......................................................................... 225

5.1.2 WRFD-02130401 Dedicated Carrier for Each Operator ..................................................................... 227

5.1.3 WRFD-02130402 Flexible Network Architecture .............................................................................. 228

5.1.4 WRFD-02130403 Mobility Control and Service Differentiation ........................................................ 231

5.1.5 WRFD-02130404 Independent License Control ................................................................................. 233

5.1.6 WRFD-02130405 Independent Cell-level FM/PM/CM ...................................................................... 234

5.1.7 WRFD-02130406 Transmission Recourse Sharing on Iub/Iur Interface ............................................ 236

5.1.8 WRFD-021305 RAN Sharing Phase 2 ................................................................................................ 237

5.1.9 WRFD-02130501 Dedicated Iub Transmission Control ..................................................................... 238

5.1.10 WRFD-021303 IMSI Based Handover ............................................................................................. 242

5.1.11 WRFD-021311 MOCN Introduction Package .................................................................................. 243

5.1.12 WRFD-02131101 Carrier Sharing by Operators ............................................................................... 245

5.1.13 WRFD-02131102 Dedicated Node B/Cell for Operators .................................................................. 247

5.1.14 WRFD-02131103 MOCN Mobility Management ............................................................................ 248

5.1.15 WRFD-02131104 MOCN Load Balance .......................................................................................... 249

5.1.16 WRFD-02131105 MOCN Independent Performance Management ................................................. 250

5.1.17 WRFD-02131106 Routing Roaming UEs in Proportion ................................................................... 251

5.2 Topology Enhancement ................................................................................................................................ 253

5.2.1 WRFD-021200 HCS (Hierarchical Cell Structure) ............................................................................. 253

5.2.2 WRFD-020111 One Tunnel ................................................................................................................ 255

5.3 ATM Transimission ...................................................................................................................................... 256

5.3.1 WRFD-050405 Overbooking on ATM Transmission.......................................................................... 256

Page 8: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 8 of 415

5.3.2 WRFD-050105 ATM Switching Based Hub Node B .......................................................................... 259

5.3.3 WRFD-050106 AAL2 Switching Based Hub Node B ........................................................................ 261

5.3.4 WRFD-050406 ATM QoS Introduction on Hub Node B (Overbooking on Hub Node B Transmission)

..................................................................................................................................................................... 262

5.3.5 WRFD-050302 Fractional ATM Function on Iub Interface ................................................................ 264

5.4 IP Transmission ............................................................................................................................................ 266

5.4.1 WRFD-050402 IP Transmission Introduction on Iub Interface .......................................................... 266

5.4.2 WRFD-050411 Fractional IP Function on Iub Interface ..................................................................... 269

5.4.3 WRFD-050403 Hybrid Iub IP Transmission ....................................................................................... 271

5.4.4 WRFD-050404 ATM/IP Dual Stack Node B ...................................................................................... 272

5.4.5 WRFD-050409 IP Transmission Introduction on Iu Interface ............................................................ 274

5.4.6 WRFD-050410 IP Transmission Introduction on Iur Interface ........................................................... 276

5.4.7 WRFD-050420 FP MUX for IP Transmission ................................................................................. 278

5.4.8 WRFD-050422 Dynamic Bandwidth Control of Iub IP ...................................................................... 280

5.4.9 WRFD-050408 Overbooking on IP Transmission .............................................................................. 281

5.4.10 WRFD-050107 IP routing Based Hub Node B ................................................................................. 284

5.4.11 WRFD-011500 PDCP Header Compression (RFC2507) .................................................................. 286

5.4.12 WRFD-012001 RNC Offload (Trial) ................................................................................................ 287

5.4.13 WRFD-050412 UDP MUX for Iu-CS Transmission ........................................................................ 289

5.4.14 WRFD-140207 Iu/Iur Transmission Resource Pool in RNC ............................................................ 290

5.4.15 WRFD-140208 Iub Transmission Resource Pool in RNC ................................................................ 292

5.5 Satellite Transmission .................................................................................................................................. 294

5.5.1 WRFD-050104 Satellite Transmission on Iub Interface ..................................................................... 294

5.5.2 WRFD-050108 Satellite Transmission on Iu Interface ....................................................................... 295

5.6 Clock ............................................................................................................................................................ 296

5.6.1 WRFD-050501 Clock Sync on Ethernet in Node B ............................................................................ 296

5.6.2 WRFD-050502 Synchronous Ethernet ................................................................................................ 298

5.6.3 WRFD-050425 Ethernet OAM ........................................................................................................... 299

6 Network Security ...................................................................................................................... 302

6.1 Reliability ..................................................................................................................................................... 302

6.1.1 WRFD-040202 RNC Node Redundancy ............................................................................................ 302

6.1.2 WRFD-040203 RRU Redundancy ...................................................................................................... 303

6.1.3 WRFD-021302 Iu Flex ....................................................................................................................... 305

6.1.4 WRFD-021306 Iu Flex Load Distribution Management .................................................................... 308

6.1.5 WRFD-140209 NodeB Integrated IPSec ............................................................................................ 310

6.1.6 WRFD-140210 NodeB PKI Support ................................................................................................... 311

7 Network Performance .............................................................................................................. 313

7.1 Coverage Enhancement ................................................................................................................................ 313

7.1.1 WRFD-010203 Transmit Diversity ..................................................................................................... 313

7.1.2 WRFD-010209 4-Antenna Receive Diversity .................................................................................... 315

Page 9: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 9 of 415

7.1.3 WRFD-021308 Extended Cell Coverage up to 200km ....................................................................... 316

7.1.4 WRFD-021309 Improved Downlink Coverage .................................................................................. 317

7.1.5 WRFD-020138 HSUPA Coverage Enhancement at UE Power Limitation......................................... 318

7.2 Spectrum Efficiency Improvement............................................................................................................... 319

7.2.1 WRFD-021001 Flexible frequency bandwidth of UMTS carrier ....................................................... 319

7.3 High Speed Mobility .................................................................................................................................... 321

7.3.1 WRFD-010206 High Speed Access .................................................................................................... 321

7.3.2 WRFD-021350 Independent Demodulation of Signals from Multiple RRUs in One Cell ................. 322

7.4 Intra-system Mobility Management ............................................................................................................. 324

7.4.1 WRFD-020302 Inter Frequency Hard Handover Based on Coverage ................................................ 324

7.4.2 WRFD-020304 Inter Frequency Hard Handover Based on DL QoS .................................................. 326

7.4.3 WRFD-020605 SRNS Relocation Introduction Package .................................................................... 327

7.4.4 WRFD-02060501 SRNS Relocation (UE Not Involved) .................................................................... 328

7.4.5 WRFD-02060502 SRNS Relocation with Hard Handover ................................................................. 330

7.4.6 WRFD-02060503 SRNS Relocation with Cell/URA Update ............................................................. 331

7.4.7 WRFD-02060504 Lossless SRNS Relocation .................................................................................... 332

7.5 Intra-system Radio Resource Management .................................................................................................. 333

7.5.1 WRFD-010615 Multiple RAB Package (PS RAB ≥2) ..................................................................... 333

7.5.2 WRFD-01061501 Combination of Two PS Services .......................................................................... 334

7.5.3 WRFD-01061502 Combination of One CS Service and Two PS Services ......................................... 335

7.5.4 WRFD-01061503 Combination of Three PS Services ........................................................................ 336

7.5.5 WRFD-01061504 Combination of One CS Service and Three PS Services ....................................... 337

7.5.6 WRFD-01061505 Combination of Four PS Services ......................................................................... 338

7.5.7 WRFD-020103 Inter Frequency Load Balance ................................................................................... 339

7.5.8 WRFD-020114 Domain Specific Access Control (DSAC) ................................................................. 341

7.5.9 WRFD-020110 Multi Frequency Band Networking Management ..................................................... 342

7.5.10 WRFD-020160 Enhanced Multiband Management .......................................................................... 345

7.5.11 WRFD-020400 DRD Introduction Package ...................................................................................... 347

7.5.12 WRFD-02040001 Intra System Direct Retry .................................................................................... 348

7.5.13 WRFD-02040002 Inter System Direct Retry .................................................................................... 349

7.5.14 WRFD-02040003 Inter System Redirect .......................................................................................... 350

7.5.15 WRFD-02040004 Traffic Steering and Load Sharing During RAB Setup ....................................... 351

7.5.16 WRFD-020402 Measurement Based Direct Retry ............................................................................ 352

7.5.17 WRFD-020120 Service Steering and Load Sharing in RRC Connection Setup ............................... 354

7.5.18 WRFD-020124 Uplink Flow Control of User Plane ......................................................................... 355

7.5.19 WRFD-020104 Intra Frequency Load Balance ................................................................................. 356

7.5.20 WRFD-140211 Dynamic Target ROT Adjustment ........................................................................... 357

7.5.21 WRFD-140212 CE Overbooking ...................................................................................................... 359

7.5.22 WRFD-140213 Intelligent Access Class Control .............................................................................. 360

7.6 GSM and UMTS Radio Resource Management .......................................................................................... 362

7.6.1 WRFD-070004 Load Based GSM and UMTS Handover Enhancement Based on Iur-g .................... 362

Page 10: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 10 of 415

7.6.2 WRFD-070005 NACC Procedure Optimization Based on Iur-g ........................................................ 363

7.6.3 WRFD-070006 GSM and UMTS Load Balancing Based on Iur-g ..................................................... 365

7.6.4 WRFD-070007 GSM and UMTS Traffic Steering Based on Iur-g ..................................................... 368

7.6.5 WRFD-020303 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Coverage .................................................................. 370

7.6.6 WRFD-020309 Inter-RAT Handover Based on DL QoS .................................................................... 372

7.6.7 WRFD-020307 Video Telephony Fallback to Speech (AMR) for Inter-RAT HO .............................. 373

7.6.8 WRFD-020308 Inter-RAT Handover Phase 2 ..................................................................................... 375

7.6.9 WRFD-02030801 NACC(Network Assisted Cell Change) ................................................................ 376

7.6.10 WRFD-02030802 PS Handover Between UMTS and GPRS ........................................................... 378

7.6.11 WRFD-020305 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Service .................................................................... 379

7.6.12 WRFD-020306 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Load ....................................................................... 380

7.6.13 WRFD-020401 Inter-RAT Redirection Based on Distance ............................................................... 381

7.6.14 WRFD-020310 3G/2G Common Load Management ....................................................................... 382

7.7 UMTS and LTE Radio Resource Management ............................................................................................ 384

7.7.1 WRFD-020126 Mobility Between UMTS and LTE Phase1 ............................................................... 384

7.7.2 WRFD-020129 Service-Based PS Service Redirection from UMTS to LTE (Trial) .......................... 386

7.7.3 WRFD-140218 Service-Based PS Handover from UMTS to LTE ..................................................... 387

7.8 QoS............................................................................................................................................................... 388

7.8.1 WRFD-010505 Queuing and Pre-Emption ......................................................................................... 388

7.8.2 WRFD-021103 Access Class Restriction ............................................................................................ 390

7.8.3 WRFD-050424 Traffic Priority Mapping onto Transmission Resources ............................................ 393

7.8.4 WRFD-020806 Differentiated Service Based on SPI Weight ............................................................. 396

7.8.5 WRFD-020131 Optimization of R99 and HSUPA Users Fairness ..................................................... 398

7.8.6 WRFD-011502 Active Queue Management (AQM) ........................................................................... 400

7.8.7 WRFD-020128 Quality Improvement for Subscribed Service ........................................................... 401

7.8.8 WRFD-020123 TCP Accelerator ........................................................................................................ 402

7.8.9 WRFD-010507 Rate Negotiation at Admission Control ..................................................................... 404

7.8.10 WRFD-020130 Videophone Service Restriction .............................................................................. 407

7.8.11 WRFD-020135 Intelligent Inter-Carrier UE Layered Management .................................................. 408

8 O&M Experience ....................................................................................................................... 410

8.1 Advanced Planning ....................................................................................................................................... 410

8.1.1 WRFD-140219 Micro NodeB Self-Planning ...................................................................................... 410

9 Site Solution ............................................................................................................................... 411

9.1 Solution ........................................................................................................................................................ 411

9.1.1 WRFD-140220 Intelligent Battery Management ................................................................................ 411

10 Acronyms and Abbreviations ............................................................................................... 414

Page 11: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 11 of 415

1 Voice & Service

1.1 VoIP

1.1.1 WRFD-010617 VoIP over HSPA/HSPA+

Availability

VoIP over HSPA is available from RAN10.0.

VoIP over HSPA+ is available from RAN11.0.

Summary

VoIP over HSPA meets the requirements of growing VoIP users. Compared with CS voice

over DCH, VoIP over HSPA or HSPA+ provides larger capacity through high spectral

efficiency and capacity enhancement of HSPA or HSPA+. This feature is a trial feature in

RAN10.0.

Benefits

VoIP over HSPA/HSPA+ has the following advantages:

Support evolution to all-IP network and decrease in the investment and maintenance cost

Large voice capacity

Description

In the fixed network, VoIP has turned out to be an attractive and cost-effective solution to

support PS conversational services. The rapid growth of VoIP users prompts cellular operators

to use this feature for enhanced revenue generation. Moreover, from the viewpoint of

evolution, VoIP helps operators converge their networks into an all-IP network and decrease

the total OPEX accordingly.

VoIP services can be carried over DCH or HSPA. When it is set up on the DCH, the capacity

is not competitive because RTP/UDP/IP protocol head will consume more resource than CS

voice service. But HSPA has higher resource efficiency than DCH. Therefore, VoIP over

HSPA is a better choice. Moreover, Robust Header Compression (RoHC) is also introduced to

Page 12: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 12 of 415

improve the overhead efficiency. In addition, the Continuous Packet Connectivity (CPC)

technology in the HSPA+ helps expand the VoIP capacity.

Compared with traditional CS voice over DCH, the capacity gain of VoIP over HSPA (HSUPA

with 2ms TTI) is expected to reach 20%. With CPC, the capacity gain of VoIP over HSPA

(HSUPA with 2ms TTI) is expected to reach 45%.

Enhancement

In RAN12.0, coverage-based TTI dynamic switching of VoIP over HSUPA is introduced. The

coverage performance of the HSUPA 10 ms TTI is better than that in R99, whereas the

coverage performance of the HSUPA 2 ms TTI is worse than that in R99. The 2 ms TTI,

however, has a greater gain in capacity. Therefore, for VoIP users, smooth switching from the

2 ms TTI to the 10 ms TTI must be implemented according to the limitation on the uplink

transmit power of the UE. This ensures seamless coverage and maximizes cell capacity.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

UE should support VoIP.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

CN should support IP multimedia subsystem (IMS).

Dependency on Other Features

When VoIP is over HSPA, the following features are required:

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

WRFD-010636 SRB over HSUPA

WRFD-010652 SRB over HSDPA

When VoIP is over HSPA+, the following feature is required:

WRFD-010686 CPC-DTX/DRX

1.1.2 WRFD-01061701 RAB Mapping

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

Page 13: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 13 of 415

Summary

This feature enables a combination of multiple RABs to support rich service types.

Benefits

This feature enables VoIP over HSPA and more RAB combinations to be carried over HSPA

to enrich service combinations of the operator.

Description

This feature enables VoIP over HSDPA and VoIP over HSUPA 10/2 ms TTI. The following

RAB combinations are available:

1PS + 1CS

Conversational (VoIP)/UL: EUL[Maximum rate depends on UE category] DL:HSDPA

[Maximum rate depends on UE category] /PS RAB + UL: 3.4 kbit/s DL: 3.4 kbit/s

SRB for DCCH

2PS + 1CS

Conversational (VoIP)/UL: EUL DL: HSDPA/PS RAB + Interactive or

Background/UL: EUL [Maximum rate depends on UE category] DL: HSDPA

[Maximum rate depends on UE category] /PS RAB + UL: 3.4 kbit/s DL: DCCH. SRB

3.4 kbit/s.

3PS + 1CS

Conversational (VoIP) /UL: EUL [Maximum rate depends on UE category] DL:

HSDPA [Maximum rate depends on UE category] /PS RAB + Streaming/UL: EUL

[Maximum rate depends on UE category] DL: HSDPA [Maximum rate depends on UE

category] /PS RAB + Interactive or Background /UL:EUL [Maximum rate depends on

UE category] DL: HSDPA [Maximum rate depends on UE category] / PS RAB + UL:

3.4 kbit/s DL: DCCH. SRB 3.4 kbit/s.

"SRB + 1 VoIP over IMS + 1 PS" over HSPA

The typical configuration of VoIP is different in 3GPP R5 and R6. In TS34.108 and TR25.99,

3GPP defines some VoIP configurations and related combinations as reference. Huawei RAN

supports these services. As the RTP header is transmitted before RoHC is enabled, a higher

rate is required. After RoHC is enabled, a lower rate can be used. RAN10.0 does not support

the adjustment between a high rate and a low rate.

The operator can configure VoIP over DCH or HSPA on the cell side. That is, when HSPA is

preferentially selected as a bearer, VoIP is carried over HSPA as much as possible. If HSPA

operations fail (for example, admission control), the period timer starts to trigger the

configuration adjustment of HSPA operations.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Page 14: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 14 of 415

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

UE should support VoIP.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

CN should support IP multimedia subsystem (IMS).

Dependency on Other Features

When VoIP is over HSPA, the following features are required:

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

When VoIP is over HSPA+, the following feature is required:

WRFD-010686 CPC-DTX/DRX

1.1.3 WRFD-01061703 Optimized Scheduling for VoIP over HSPA

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

Summary

Based on the UL non-scheduling method and DL delay sensitive scheduling algorithm, this

feature can ensure the delay requirements of VoIP services and signaling carried over HSPA.

Benefits

This feature guarantees the delay requirement of VoIP services and enhances the user

experience when VoIP over HSPA is applied.

Description

In RAN10.0, VoIP over HSPA is supported. In order to guarantee the QoS of VoIP over HSPA,

non-scheduling method is used during HSUPA scheduling in the uplink. In the downlink,

delay sensitive (DS) algorithm as an optimized HSDPA scheduling scheme is provided.

VoIP service in 3G consists of two kinds of packets: SIP signaling and RTP packets. RTP and

RTCP can be born on a single RAB.

Page 15: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 15 of 415

UTRAN PS

Domain

IMS PS

Domain

UTRAN

)

UE UTRAN PS

Domain

IMS PS

Domain

UTRAN

Session control Signaling (SIP / SDP)

Media ( RTP)

UE UE UE

The preceding packets have different characteristics:

Packet Characteristics

SIP signaling Delay sensitive (call setup delay is affected).

RLC retransmission is triggered due to packet loss. The delay is affected.

VoIP-RTP Delay sensitive.

No RLC retransmission is triggered due to packet loss. The delay and user

experience are affected.

According to different characteristics, the MAC-hs scheduling algorithm should be enhanced

to guarantee the QoS, especially the delay.

DS scheduling algorithm for SRB and VoIP is always prior to scheduling algorithm for

streaming and BE. This feature is for the RAB which bares the RTP voice packet to guarantee

the delay in a certain range.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

UE should support VoIP.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

CN should support IP multimedia subsystem (IMS).

Dependency on Other Features

Page 16: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 16 of 415

VoIP over HSPA rely on:

WRFD-010611 HSDPA Enhanced Package

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

VoIP over HSPA+ rely on:

WRFD-010611 HSDPA Enhanced Package

WRFD-010686 CPC- DTX/DRX

1.1.4 WRFD-010618 IMS Signaling over HSPA

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R5.

Summary

IMS signaling over HSPA can shorten the setup delay of IMS services like VoIP to save

network resources for the operator.

Benefits Since IMS signaling is carried on HSPA, the utilization of code resource and

transmission resource can be improved, compared with those carried on the DCH.

Better performance (short time delay) and capacity of IMS services.

Description

The IP Multimedia Subsystem (IMS) is an open and standardized architectural framework for

delivering Internet Protocol (IP) multimedia to mobile users. With this feature, operators

provide network-controlled multimedia services by combining voice and data in a single

packet switched network.

IMS uses Session Initiation Protocol (SIP) as the key control protocol, and implements

service management in the UTRAN. Such SIP signaling will be indicated by the CN in the

RAB Assignment Request message. The RAB should be an interactive QoS class service.

Before RAN10.0, such IMS signaling service can only be carried on the DCH. With F-DPCH

supported in RAN10.0, the service can be carried on HSPA, which brings better performance

for IMS service.

The type of channels carrying IMS signaling is configurable separately on the downlink and

uplink at cell level. That is, when HSPA is chosen as the bearer with high priority, IMS

signaling will be set up on it as much as possible. If the setup is not successful, for example,

due to admission control, a periodical timer will be started to trigger the reconfiguration of the

HSPA procedure.

Enhancement

None.

Page 17: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 17 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

CN should support the signaling indication at Iu interface.

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

1.1.5 WRFD-011501 PDCP Header Compression (RoHC)

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R4.

Summary

PDCP header compression (RoHC) mainly applies to VoIP services and it can decrease the

overhead of IP data.

Benefits Decrease the IP data overhead greatly from more than 60% to 10%.

Saving air interface and backhaul bandwidth occupancy, saving CAPEX & OPEX

Description

Robust Header Compression (RoHC) is defined in RFC3095 (July, 2001). Such feature

provides the IP data header compression mechanism which aims to save the bandwidth of air

interface, which utilize less radio resources.

The motivation for IP header compression is based on the following facts:

The multimedia payload is typically compressed at the application layer.

The headers occupy a large portion of the packet for some services.

Page 18: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 18 of 415

The headers have significant redundancy.

The RoHC is implemented at the PDCP protocol layer between the RNC and UE; therefore,

the Iub bandwidth can be saved.

In RAN10.0, the following compress/uncompress profiles are supported:

RoHC Uncompressed

RoHC RTP: RTP/UDP/IP header

RoHC UDP: UDP/IP header

RoHC ESP: ESP/IP header

Generally, RTP/UDP/IP header is used in packet of VoIP, so RoHC Uncompressed or RoHC

RTP is used for VoIP. RoHC UDP and RoHC ESP are used in other scenarios when the hander

of packet is UDP/IP or ESP/IP.

Both IPV4 and IPV6 header compressions are supported.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

UE should support ROHC compression function.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010619 CS Voice over HSPA/HSPA+

1.1.6 WRFD-010619 CS voice over HSPA/HSPA+

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0. It is introduced in 3GPP R8.

Page 19: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 19 of 415

Summary

Compared with CS voice over DCH, CS voice over HSPA/HSPA+ provides a larger voice

capacity through high spectral efficiency and capacity enhancement of HSPA or HSPA+.

Benefits

The use of the high spectral efficiency and capacity enhancement features of HSPA or HSPA+

increases the capacity of CS voice services. Compared with VoIP over HSPA or HSPA+, CS

voice over HSPA/HSPA+ does not require the support of the IMS and its implementation is

easier.

Description

Generally, CS voice services are carried over DCH. CS voice over HSPA is introduced in

3GPP Release 8 specifications. That is, UL CS voice packets are carried over E-DCH, and DL

CS voice packets are carried over HS-DSCH.

CS voice over HSPA refers to the Circuit Switched voice service based on legacy CS domain

Core Network. Therefore, operators do not need to deploy the IMS for VoIP services. The

following figure shows the difference in call routing between CS voice over HSPA and VoIP

over HSPA/HSPA+.

To deploy CS voice over HSPA, the only needed update is the way of mapping for this service

on the RNC. No additional modification is needed on the MSC or Node B.

CS voice over HSPA improves the spectral efficiency and cell capacity. Moreover, the CPC

feature introduced in RAN11.0 HSPA+ package helps to extend the battery life of UEs

through UL DTX and DL DRX functions.

Compared with traditional CS over DCH, the capacity gain of CS over HSPA (HSUPA with

2ms TTI) is expected to reach 23%. With CPC, the capacity gain of VoIP over HSPA (HSUPA

with 2ms TTI) is expected to reach 48%.

Enhancement

In RAN12.0, coverage-based TTI dynamic switching of CS over HSUPA is introduced. The

coverage performance of the HSUPA 10 ms TTI is better than that in DCH, whereas the

coverage performance of the HSUPA 2 ms TTI is worse than that in DCH. The 2 ms TTI,

however, has greater gain in capacity. Therefore, for voice call over HSPA users, 2 ms TTI is

always configured to obtain high system capacity and smooth switching from the 2 ms TTI to

Page 20: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 20 of 415

the 10 ms TTI must be implemented according to the limitation on the uplink transmit power

of the UE and the high BLER. This ensures seamless coverage and maximizes cell capacity.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

The UE must be Release-8 (or later) and support CS voice over HSPA/HSPA+

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

When CS voice is over HSPA

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

RFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

WRFD-010636 SRB over HSUPA

WRFD-010652 SRB over HSDPA

When CS voice is over HSPA+

WRFD-010686 CPC DTX/DRX

1.2 Crystal Voice

1.2.1 WRFD-010613 AMR-WB (Adaptive Multi Rate Wide Band)

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R5.

Summary

This feature enables the operator to improve the quality of speech services if resources are

allowed.

Page 21: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 21 of 415

Benefits

The AMR-WB provides improved voice quality especially in terms of increased voice

naturalness.

Description

AMR-WB (Wide Band) is a new feature in 3GPP_REL 5 for the purpose to provide improved

voice quality especially in terms of increased voice naturalness.

This feature provides the AMR-WB service with the bit rate defined as follows:

Codec Mode Source Codec BitRate

AMR-WB_23.85 23.85 kbit/s

AMR-WB_15.85 15.85 kbit/s

AMR-WB_12.65 12.65 kbit/s

AMR-WB_8.85 8.85 kbit/s

AMR-WB_6.60 6.60 kbit/s

The system will set up the AMR service according to the service request from the core

network. The algorithm for AMR-WB is the same as that for the AMR service with narrow

band.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

The UE must have the corresponding support capability.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

The CN must have the corresponding support capability.

Dependency on Other Features

Page 22: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 22 of 415

NA

1.2.2 WRFD-020701 AMR/WB-AMR Speech Rates Control

Availability

This feature is available from RAN2.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R99.

Summary

This feature enables the adjustment of AMR/AMR-WB speech rates triggered by multiple

factors. This feature can ensure a continuous service, expand the service coverage, and reduce

the cell load.

Benefits

For the same transmit power, a lower-rate AMR codec can provide wider uplink coverage.

When the radio environment is good, a high-rate codec can provide better speech quality than

a low-rate codec. When the radio environment is poor, a low-rate codec can provide better

speech quality than a high-rate codec. Thus, the rate of the AMR codec should be adjusted in

real time to ensure high-quality speech services.

Description

The AMR Mode Control (AMRC) is a feature that enables the RNC to control 8 types of

speech rates, namely 12.2 kbit/s, 10.2 kbit/s, 7.95 kbit/s, 7.4 kbit/s, 6.7 kbit/s, 5.9 kbit/s, 5.15

kbit/s, 4.75 kbit/s, and wide band AMR 6.60 kbit/s, 8.85 kbit/s, 12.65 kbit/s, 15.85 kbit/s, and

23.85 kbit/s. This improves speech quality and enlarges uplink coverage and reduces system

load level.

Before RAN5.0, the decision of adjusting the AMR rate considers the downlink transmitted

power for DL and UE transmitted power for UL. If the transmit power exceeds the

pre-defined threshold, it indicates that the link quality is poor.

In RAN5.1, cell load is used for AMRC trigger, where RNC will monitor the cell loading

continuously and dynamically to adjust the user’s speech code rate according to the change of

the cell loading. When the loading is heavy, low bit rate of AMR speech CODEC is used to

decrease the cell loading and when the cell loading is light, high bit rates of AMR speech

CODEC is used to provide higher voice quality for users.

The AMRC is one action to be done during the load reshuffling (LDR) procedure. The LDR is

one of the congestion control mechanisms triggered when Node B Common Measurement

(TCP, Transmitted Carrier Power) for DL, and Node B Common Measurement (RTWP) for

UL, exceed the LDR threshold. The system will enter ‘basic congestion’ status. After the LDR

is triggered, the AMRC serves as a method to decease the system load. The RNC will select

the candidate AMR user according to the ARP and current user rate. Low ARP user will be

selected first to adjust the rate and if ARP is the same, the user with high voice rate will be

firstly selected to adjust the rate.

Page 23: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 23 of 415

After the user voice rate is degraded, it depends on the downlink transmitted power for DL

and UE transmitted power for UL for rate increase, as the mechanism used for RAN5.0.

Enhancement

In RAN5.1, the AMRC is added as an action in basic feature WRFD-020106 Load

Reshuffling.

In RAN6.0, this feature can also be used to AMR-WB service which requires the optional

feature WRFD-010603 AMR-WB (Adaptive Multi Rate Wide Band).

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

UE should support the processing of TFC control procedure.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

If this feature is to be applied to the AMR-WB, then the Dependency is:

WRFD-010613 AMR-WB (Adaptive Multi Rate Wide Band)

Overbooking on ATM Transmission

1.2.3 WRFD-011600 TFO/TrFO

Availability

This feature is available from RAN3.0

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R4.

Summary

This feature enables the identification and processing of the IUUP V2 CN to support the

TFO/TrFO service.

Page 24: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 24 of 415

Benefits

This feature can prevent degradation of the speech quality introduced by the interpretation

between different codecs. The TrFO can also save the transmission resources.

Description

TFO/TrFO features are introduced in Release 4 and used to prevent degradation of the speech

quality. This degradation is produced by the interpretation between the different codecs and is

usually more noticeable when the speech CODECs are operating at low rates and in noisy

conditions.

Tandem Free Operation (TFO) removes the double speech encoding/decoding done in the

TRAUs in MS-to-MS calls by “tunneling” the “compressed” speech through the 64 kbit/s

PCM (Pulse Code Modulation) links of the core network. NO transmission resource will be

saved.

For Transcoder Free Operation (TrFO), there is no constraint to use PCM link on the Nb

interface; therefore, in addition of the advantages proposed by TFO, it can also save the

transmission resources. TrFO can also be used in mobile-to-fix calls.

On the access network side, the RNC cannot really identify the TFO/TrFO service. The RNC

can, however, identify the CN IUUP version and perform related processing of the IUUP V2

to support the TFO/TrFO service.

Enhancement

In RAN5.0, AMRC under TFO/TrFO is supported.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

The UE must have the corresponding support capability.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

The CN node needs to support the feature at the same time.

Dependency on Other Features

NA

Page 25: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 25 of 415

1.2.4 WRFD-140201 AMR Voice Quality Improvement Based on PLVA

Availability

This feature is available from RAN14.0.

Summary

This feature improves adaptive multi-rate (AMR) voice quality by using Huawei Parallel List

Viterbi Algorithm (PLVA) algorithm to decode convolutional codes, reducing the proportion

of low and medium mean opinion scores (MOSs). The AMR voice quality improvement is

especially useful in weak coverage areas.

Benefits

This feature noticeably improves the quality of voice services, which in turn improves user

experience. In simulations, the MOS of AMR voice services increases by about 0.35 when the

block error rate (BLER) is greater than 10%.

Description

AMR is a speech coding standard widely used in GSM and UMTS communications systems.

In UMTS, convolutional codes are used to perform channel encoding and a power control

mechanism is used to ensure voice quality.

Figure 1-2-4-1 Channel encoding and power control for AMR voice services in the uplink in

UMTS

Uu

UE NodeB RNC CN

AMR Speech

Codec

Iub Iu

CC Encoder

Inner-Loop

Power Control

Outer-Loop

Power Control

CC Decoder

AMR Speech

Codec

Decoded Data

CRCI

Target

SINR

Power

Transmitter

Measured

SINR

Power

Commander

Currently, most vendors use the Viterbi algorithm to decode convolutional codes. The Viterbi

algorithm selects the optimal path based on the maximum likelihood theory and exports the

data decoded on the optimal path. If the data decoded on the optimal path fails the cyclic

redundancy check (CRC), the AMR speech codec usually discards the data, and voice quality

deteriorates as a result.

Page 26: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 26 of 415

Huawei uses the PLVA algorithm to decode convolutional codes. The PLVA algorithm is an

enhanced. CRC-assisted Viterbi algorithm. Instead of only selecting the top 1 optimal path,

the PLVA algorithm selects the top N optimal paths and performs CRC on the data decoded on

these paths. The PLVA algorithm only exports data that passes the CRC. If data decoded on

these paths fails the CRC, the NodeB exports the data decoded on the optimal path. In

simulations where the PLVA algorithm selects four paths, signal-to-noise ratio (SNR) is 0.2 to

0.8 dB better than that produced by the Viterbi algorithm.

This feature increases the MOS of AMR voice services, including narrowband and wideband

AMR voice services. Take 12.2 kbit/s AMR voice services as an example. If the BLER is 1%,

the MOS is increased by 0.08. If the BLER is greater than 10%, the MOS is increased by

about 0.35. (The BLER increase is generally caused by UE power limitation, fast channel

change, or strong interference.) Generally, the MOS increase produced by the PLVA algorithm

is directly proportional to the BLER. In addition, MOS increase is generally the same under

different channel fading conditions.

Figure 1-2-4-2 Different MOSs for 12.2 kbit/s AMR voice services on TU50 channels with

different BLERs

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

None

Dependency on NodeB

The BTS3812E, BTS3812A, and BTS3812AE must be configured with the EULPd

board.

The BBU3806 must be configured with the EBBCd board.

The BBU3900 must be configured with the WBBPd or WBBPf board.

Dependency on the UE

None

Page 27: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 27 of 415

Dependency on other NEs

None

Dependency on the CN

None

Dependency on other RAN features

None

1.3 CBS

1.3.1 WRFD-011000 Cell Broadcast Service

Availability

This feature is available from RAN3.0

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R99.

Summary

This feature supports the standard cell broadcast procedure as stipulated in protocols to assist

the CBC for the cell broadcast service.

Benefits

The users can use the new services based on the CBS.

Description

The CBS service is analogous to the Teletex service offered on television, in that like Teletex,

it permits a number of unacknowledged general CBS messages to be broadcast to all receivers

within a particular region. CBS messages are broadcast to defined geographical areas known

as cell broadcast areas. These areas may comprise of one or more cells, or may comprise the

entire PLMN.

The Iu BC interface connects the RNC in UTRAN with the broadcast domain of the Core

Network, namely with the Cell Broadcast Centre. It is used to define the Cell Broadcast

information that is transmitted to the mobile user via the Cell Broadcast Service. The cell

broadcast center (CBC) is part of core network in UMTS and up to 4 CBCs can connect to

RNC via a routing node like WCDMA SGSN.

Enhancement

RAN6.0 supports four CBCs instead of one CBC of the previous versions.

Page 28: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 28 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

UE should have the capability to receive cell broadcast messages.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

1.3.2 WRFD-011001 Simplified Cell Broadcast

Availability

This feature is introduced in RAN11.1.

Summary

This feature offers a solution to broadcast some simple message to the UE while there is no

Simplified cell broadcast is a function implemented in RNC that allows using SMSCB (Short

Message Service Cell Broadcast) without the necessity of having a Cell Broadcast Center.

Benefits

With this feature, the most commonly used cell broadcast services are supported through a

simple command in RNC. Which avoids investing in a Cell Broadcast Center and contributes

to CAPEX saving.

Description

The Short Message Service Cell Broadcast (SMSCB) function enables the broadcast of short

messages to all MSs in one or several cells, or even the entire PLMN. The MSs can receive

the broadcast messages continuously or discontinuously according to the system

configuration.

Usually there is a Cell Broadcast Center (CBC) responsible for managing and scheduling the

SMSCB.

Huawei Simplified Cell Broadcast function performs through a built-in cell broadcast

processing module in the RNC without CBC, and thus reduces equipment costs.

Page 29: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 29 of 415

Huawei simplified cell broadcast function enables the broadcast of messages, such as the cell

name, weather forecast, and social commonweal messages. The following describes the

details of these functions:

Information broadcast function: broadcasting messages such as the Node B name, cell

name, weather forecast, or any character string. The maximum length is 100 ASC

symbols. The messages are input manually by MML command.

Information timing broadcast function: sending cell broadcast messages at specified

intervals.

Information management function: On the M2000 MML client, you can use the MML

commands to start or stop sending the broadcast messages in specified cells or all cells,

and stop sending a specified cell broadcast message. In addition, you can use the MML

commands to query the cell broadcast status.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

Only BSC6900 supports this feature.

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

UE should have the capability to receive cell broadcast messages.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

The Huawei simplified cell broadcast function cannot be used simultaneously with

WRFD-011000 CBC cell broadcast function.

1.3.3 WRFD-020127 Warning of Disaster

Availability

This feature is available from RAN12.0.

Summary

The RNC can send a disaster notification to all the UEs in a cell through the simple cell

broadcast function right after a disaster occurs.

Page 30: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 30 of 415

Benefits

This feature enables the RNC to quickly (within four seconds) send the disaster information to

all the UEs, thus reducing the impact of the disaster.

Description

When a disaster (such as earthquake or tsunami) occurs, a disaster pre-warning notification

can help reduce the casualty and losses.

Huawei RNC can perform simple cell broadcast through the built-in CBC. If no external CBC

is deployed, Huawei RNC can run an OM command to inform all the UEs in the cell of the

disaster information as soon as possible. The RNC can originate, modify, and release

broadcast messages. The RNC can also predefine a broadcasting area. All the broadcast

messages are triggered manually. When the RNC OM personnel know the disaster

information, the personnel must send a broadcast command and the broadcast information is

immediately sent to the RNC through an OM terminal. In RAN12.0, Huawei RNC shortens

the delay of each channel in the system to ensure that all the UEs within the RNC are

informed of the disaster information within a short period of time, generally four seconds.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-011001 Simplified Cell Broadcast

Page 31: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 31 of 415

1.4 MBMS

1.4.1 WRFD-010616 MBMS Introduction Package

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R6.

Summary

This feature provides basic MBMS functions to meet the requirements of the operator for

MBMS applications.

Benefits

This feature improves the network resource utilization, especially the utilization of resources

on the Uu interface. It is an efficient way for the operators to deploy the point-to-multipoint

services, such mobile TV.

Description

The multimedia broadcast and multicast service (MBMS) is a new important feature for the

3GPP Release 6 specifications. It is a point-to-multipoint service in which the data is

transmitted from a single source entity to multiple recipients. Transmitting the same data to

multiple recipients allows the network resources to be shared.

The MBMS bearer service offers two modes:

Broadcast mode;

Multicast mode.( Not supported by Huawei RNC)

The MBMS architecture enables the efficient use of the radio network and core network

resources, with an emphasis on the radio interface efficiency. For one MBMS service, there is

only one copy of data on the Iu interface, and the RNS distributes the data to all associated

UEs.

The MBMS is realized by a number of additional new capabilities in the existing functional

entities and additional new functional entities. The whole MBMS architecture is as follows:

Page 32: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 32 of 415

UE SGSN

UE GERAN

UTRAN

HLR

GGSN

TPFBM - SC

ContentProvider /MulticastBroadcastSource

Uu Iu

Iu /Gb

Um

Gr

Gn /Gp

Gi

PDN

(e .g . Internet )

Gmb

ContentProvider /MulticastBroadcastSource

The introduction of the MBMS has the following impacts on the RAN:

Some new signaling procedures are added on the Iub/Uu/Iur/Iu interface.

New physical channels (MICH) are added.

New logical channels (MCCH/MTCH/MSCH) are added.

MAC-c/sh is changed to MAC-c/sh/m in order to add the MAC-m to the MBMS.

Soft/selective combination function of the common channels is introduced.

The common channels may be used over the air interface, and the UE may receive the service

in idle mode. So the number of UEs is not limited in a cell and a group.

The UE may receive the same MBMS service in the common channels from different cells.

And by soft/selective combination, less power is needed for the common channels.

The BSC6800 supports the MBMS services with the total traffic of up to 4096 kbit/s on the Iu

interface and 64 sessions can be supported simultaneously.

The BSC6900 supports the MBMS services with the total traffic of up to 8192 kbit/s on the Iu

interface and 256 sessions can be supported simultaneously.

Enhancement

In the RAN10.0, the MBMS introduction package is enhanced. For details, please refer to the

enhancements of the features in the package.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Page 33: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 33 of 415

Dependency on UE

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

The existing PS Domain functional entities (GGSN, SGSN, UTRAN, GERAN and UE)

need to be enhanced to provide the MBMS bearer service.

A new functional entity, the broadcast multicast service centre (BM-SC) is added to

provide a set of functions for the MBMS users Services.

Dependency on Other Features

NA

1.4.2 WRFD-01061601 MBMS Broadcast Mode

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

In MBMS broadcast mode, MBMS information is transmitted through common channels of a

cell.

Benefits

With this feature, the operators can deploy rich multimedia services, such as mobile TV.

Description

The MBMS bearer service offers two modes:

Broadcast mode

Multicast mode

The broadcast mode is the unidirectional point-to-multipoint transmission of multimedia data

(such as text, audio, picture, video) from a single source entity to all users in the broadcast

service area. It is expected that charging data for the end user will not be generated for this

mode at the MBMS transport service layer. Charging data related to security procedures for

the end user at the MBMS user service layer may be generated.

The multicast mode allows the unidirectional point-to-multipoint transmission of multimedia

data (such as text, audio, picture, video) from a single source entity to a multicast group in the

multicast service area. Unlike the broadcast mode, the multicast mode generally requires a

subscription to the multicast subscription group and the users joining in the corresponding

multicast group. It is expected that charging data for the end user will be generated for this

mode at the MBMS transport service layer.

Page 34: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 34 of 415

When receiving the MBMS services in the broadcast mode, the UE may stay in the

URA_PCH/CELL_PCH/CELL_FACH and idle mode. If the capability allowed, the UE can

receive the MBMS service even on the CELL_DCH.

Huawei UMTS RAN6.0 only supports the broadcast mode.

Enhancement

In RAN10.0, the UE in URA_PCH, CELL_PCH, FACH, or idle mode supports the MBMS

service.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010616 MBMS Introduction Package

1.4.3 WRFD-01061602 MBMS Admission Control

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

This feature is related to admission control for the MBMS service.

Benefits

The cell power is allocated preferentially to the MBMS broadcast service with higher priority.

Description

Like the admission control for the R99 services, the following factors will be taken into

account:

Cell available code resources

Page 35: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 35 of 415

Cell available power resources

Node B resource state, that is, Node B credits

Available Iub transport layer resources

Only when all of these resources above are available can a MBMS service be admitted.

The MBMS broadcast service is established (PTM bearer) on the common channel. Two

power levels (upper and lower levels) are defined for the MBMS broadcast service.

When there is enough power resources in the cell, the upper power level will be used;

When the cell is in the basic congestion, the upper power level will be used for the

MBMS service whose priority is higher than or equal to a configured priority threshold

and the lower power level will be used for the MBMS service whose priority is lower

than the configured priority threshold;

When the cell load recovers from the congestion to normal, the RNC will automatically

adjust the power level to the upper one for that MBMS service.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010616 MBMS Introduction Package

1.4.4 WRFD-01061603 MBMS Load Control

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

This feature is related to load control for the MBMS service.

Page 36: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 36 of 415

Benefits

The feature helps to decrease the cell load when the cell enters the congestion state and

ensures the system stability.

Description

When the cell is in the basic congestion, reduction of the MBMS service power may be

triggered when the downlink congestion is detected. The details are as follows:

The RNC selects all the MBMS broadcast services with priority lower than the

configurable threshold named the MBMS priority threshold and sort them in the

ascending order;

When the cell is in the congestion, the RNC will check them one by one. If there is one

service that is using the upper power level threshold, the RNC can move it to the lower

power level threshold by common transport channel reconfiguration procedure. Then the

action ends.

If all the MBMS broadcast mode services are using the lower power level threshold, the

action ends.

When the cell is in the congestion, the RNC can trigger the release of the MBMS broadcast

mode service. Some MBMS services with the lowest priority will be released first. After that,

a periodic reestablishment attempt timer for each service will be started.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010616 MBMS Introduction Package

Page 37: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 37 of 415

1.4.5 WRFD-01061604 MBMS Soft/Selective Combining

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

This feature is related to soft combination and selective combination for the PTM MBMS

service.

Benefits

With this feature, the power of the S-CCPCH that bears the MBMS services can be saved.

Description

The common channel soft combination is a function introduced for the MBMS. It means that

the UE receiver combines the signal from the multiple cells either in the RAKE receiver or

after the RAKE receiver in the receiver chain prior to the decoding of the soft combination

transport channel. The maximum time difference between the S-CCPCHs carrying the same

service in different cells should be less than 1TTI+1slot.

The soft combination normally improves the UE reception gain by 5 - 7 dB.

The selective combination (SC) is an enhancement for the Release 6 PtM MBMS. The

network is to simulcast the PtM MBMS contents on the S-CCPCH, and the UE receives and

decodes the MBMS data from multiple radio links simultaneously. The selection of the radio

link is to be performed on a transport block basis at the RLC, based on the CRC results and

sequence numbers.

The selective combination normally improves the UE reception gain by 3 - 5 dB.

The RNC should ensure that the services data sent to the UE from different cells are

synchronized.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

Page 38: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 38 of 415

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010616 MBMS Introduction Package

1.4.6 WRFD-01061605 MBMS Transport Resource Management

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

This feature is related to the transport resource management for the MBMS service.

Benefits

It is an essential feature to deploy MBMS broadcast mode services.

Description

For the same MBMS session in the same Node B, a separate Iub transport bearer is

established for each cell. An example is shown in the following figure assuming 3 cells in one

Node B. Three copies of exact same MBMS session data are sent through the Iub from the

CRNC to the Node B.

CRNC Node B

MBMS stream

broad

CN

Iub transport bearers

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Page 39: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 39 of 415

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010616 MBMS Introduction Package

1.4.7 WRFD-01061606 Streaming Service on MBMS

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

This feature enables the MBMS service to be carried on the PS streaming class, thus ensuring

QoS.

Benefits

The feature can meet the QoS requirements of the service applications borne by the streaming

class.

Description

Compared with the point-to-point bearer services, the following limitations for the MBMS

services exist:

For the traffic class, only the background and streaming classes can be supported;

For the SDU error ratio, only higher values are supported, such as the values describing

higher numbers of the lost or corrupted SDUs (actual values for the background and

streaming classes are 10-2

and 10-1

);

For guaranteed bit rates of the streaming traffic class: it depends on the radio resource

usage by other services, some cells of the MBMS service area may not have sufficient

resources available for a MBMS session. The RAN may decide not to establish the RB in

the cells where requested resources are not available.

The MBMS bearer of the background class is most suitable for the transport of the MBMS

user services such as messaging or downloading. The MBMS bearer of streaming class is

most suitable for the transport of the MBMS user services such as mobile TV. The main

difference between the background and streaming classes for the MBMS is the support of a

guaranteed bit rate in the streaming case. The MBMS user services that normally use the

background class may however decide to use a streaming class if the MBMS user service

cannot cope with the high packet loss.

The RAN 6.1 only supports the streaming class MBMS service.

Page 40: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 40 of 415

Enhancement

In the RAN 10.0, a maximum of 2 PTP streaming RBs for the MBMS service can be

established for the UE in enhanced broadcast mode.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010616 MBMS Introduction Package

1.4.8 WRFD-01061607 MBMS 2 Channels per Cell

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

With this feature, each cell supports up to two channels for the MBMS service.

Benefits

The feature is an essential function for the deployment of the MBMS service application.

Description

The MBMS two channels per cell are supported.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

Page 41: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 41 of 415

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010616 MBMS Introduction Package

1.4.9 WRFD-01061608 16/32/64/128Kbit/s Channel Rate on MBMS

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

This feature is related to four MBMS channel rates: 16kbit/s, 32kbit/s, 64kbit/s, and 128kbit/s.

Benefits

The feature enables different channel rates and thus provides operators with more flexibility

to deploy the MBMS services.

Description

The MBMS broadcast mode service bit rate can be 64kbit/s or 128kbit/s. The TTI for 64kbit/s

is 80 ms and the TTI for 128kbit/s can be 40 ms or 80 ms.

Enhancement

In the RAN10.0, 16 kbit/s or 32kbit/s can also be supported for which only 80 ms is used by

the TTI.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Page 42: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 42 of 415

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010616 MBMS Introduction Package

1.4.10 WRFD-010660 MBMS Phase 2

Availability

This feature is available from RAN 10.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R6.

Summary

This feature supports the enhanced MBMS (PTP/PTM) to save cell resources.

Benefits

Compared with the broadcast mode, MBMS Phase 2 can effectively implement PTM services,

for example, mobile TV. In PTP/PTM mode, cell resources can be saved.

Description

MBMS Phase 2 refers to enhanced broadcast mode introduced in 2006/09 3GPP

specifications. Compared with broadcast mode, the main differences include:

The “Counting/re-counting” function used for multicast mode is introduced for enhanced

broadcast. During the counting/re-counting procedure, the UE reports its selected

services to the RNC directly over the Uu interface.

Based on “Counting/re-counting” result, RNC can select optimum transfer mode: PTM

(Point To Multipoint) or PTP (Point To Point). In PTM mode, FACH/SCCPCH is used to

bear the MBMS services; in PTP mode, DCH or HSDPA is used to bear the MBMS

services. If in a cell there is no user interested in one specific MBMS service, RAN can

decide to cancel it.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

Page 43: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 43 of 415

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

UE should support the corresponding enhanced MBMS functions.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010616 MBMS Introduction Package

1.4.11 WRFD-01066001 MBMS Enhanced Broadcast Mode

Availability

This feature is available from RAN 10.0.

Summary

This feature is related to the enhanced broadcast mode for the MBMS service.

Benefits

Compared to broadcast mode, it is a more efficient way to deploy the point-to-multipoint

services, such mobile TV.

Description

MBMS enhanced broadcast mode is very similar to multicast mode on RAN side, but much

modification on CN side and NAS procedures are avoided by introducing

“counting/re-counting” function. To support it, the following functions on enhanced broadcast

mode are introduced:

Counting/Re-counting. In “MBMS Modified Services Information” message RNC

indicates UE to initiate counting/re-counting response and in “MBMS Access

Information” message RNC gives the “Access probability factor” to UEs in Idle mode.

For UEs in connected mode, it will report to RNC its selected services by “MBMS

Modification Request” message. So RNC will get the number of UEs which are

interested in one specific MBMS service.

In addition, in order to simplify the counting/re-counting procedure, RNC keeps X UEs

in the connected mode.

The dynamic switch between PTP and PTM transfer mode for one MBMS service. When

deciding the optimum transfer mode for one service in a cell, some factors are taken into

account: the load of cell, the number of UE, and the status of the MBMS neighboring

cells.

Page 44: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 44 of 415

The mobility management for UE.

− From a PTM cell to another PTM cell. In this scenario, UE will select to receive the

MBMS services in the new cell.

− From a PTM cell to a PTP cell. In this scenario, PTP RB will be established for UE.

− From a PTP cell to a PTM cell. In this scenario, if PTM mode is used in the UEs’ best

cell, PTP RB will be released.

− From a PTP cell to another PTP cell. Handover will be supported.

The combination of MBMS service and non-MBMS services for UE.

− When the MBMS service is in PTM mode, UE can decide whether to receive this

service according to its capability;

− When MBMS service is in PTP mode, RNC will establish the separate PTP RB for

every UE and treat it as an ordinary PS RB. And multiple RAB will be supported.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010616 MBMS Introduction Package

1.4.12 WRFD-01066002 MBMS P2P over HSDPA

Availability

This feature is available from RAN 10.0.

Summary

This feature enables MBMS P2P services to be carried on the HS-DSCH, thus saving cell

resources.

Page 45: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 45 of 415

Benefits

By HSDPA, the cell capacity will be improved.

Description

In enhanced broadcast mode, PTP and PTM mode can be selected to transport MBMS

services. If PTP mode is adopted, RNC will establish the separate PTP RB for every UE. Like

the non-MBMS service, HSDPA can be used to bear PTP MBMS RB and multiple RAB such

as combination of P2P MBMS streaming and I/B PS over HSDPA.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010616 MBMS Introduction Package

1.4.13 WRFD-01066003 MBMS Admission Enhancement

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

Summary

This feature provides different admission policies for PTM and PTP MBMS services.

Benefits

MBMS PTM bearers should be treated differently so that they do not occupy too many

resources to block non-MBMS connection admission. In addition, some resources should be reserved for the use of MBMS PTM.

Page 46: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 46 of 415

Description

Besides PTM bearer, MBMS enhanced broadcast also supports PTP bearer, which can be

carried on DCH or HS-DSCH. For MBMS PTP users, same admission, pre-emption and

congestion criteria are applied as with normal non-MBMS HSDPA users.

When performing pre-emption, all types of bearer are taken into account including MBMS

PTM bearer, MBMS PTP bearer, normal non-MBMS bearer, which means every bearer type

can pre-empt each other. Whether MBMS PTM bearer is allowed to pre-empt other services

are controlled by parameter settings.

In case PTM bearer is allowed to pre-empt other services, the following QoS rules are

possible by parameter settings:

PTM streaming bearer can pre-empt other MBMS or non-MBMS services with traffic

class interactive/background and less or equal ARP priority.

PTM background bearer can pre-empt other MBMS or non-MBMS services with traffic

background and less ARP priority.

No services are allowed to pre-empt PTM with streaming traffic class.

PTP or Non-MBMS guaranteed services are allowed to pre-empt PTM with background

traffic class and lower ARP priority.

PTP or Non-MBMS background services are allowed to pre-empt PTM with background

traffic class and lower ARP priority.

While MBMS PTM bearer consumes less resource but serves for more subscribers, some

special strategies are developed for it. 2 specific thresholds are introduced for only Power and

Code: Treserved, Tmax.

When all the resources occupied by all MBMS PTM bearers in a cell are below Treserved,

PTM bearers can NOT be pre-empted by non PTM bearers (i.e. MBMS PTP bearers or

normal non-MBMS bearers).

When any resource occupied by all PTM bearers in a cell is above Tmax, PTM bearers are

rejected by admission control and they can NOT pre-empted non PTM bearers (i.e.

MBMS PTP bearers or normal non-MBMS bearers). At this moment, they can only

pre-empt other low priority PTM bearers.

Other cases, the general pre-emption rules will be applied. When all the other priorities

are the same, the final prioritization is: MBMS PTM bearer > non-MBMS bearer >

MBMS PTP bearer.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

Page 47: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 47 of 415

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010616 MBMS Introduction Package

1.4.14 WRFD-01066004 Inter-Frequency Neighboring Cell Selection for MBMS PTP Users

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

Summary

This feature enables the filtering and handover of a target cell based on the MBMS channel

resources in the inter-frequency neighboring cells, thus ensuring the continuity of the MBMS

service.

Benefits

With this feature, the neighboring cells which are not suitable for MBMS PTP users will be

filtered. This maintains the service continuity of MBMS in a more reasonable and intelligent

way.

Description

This function is applied when multi-carriers and single carriers are neighboring carriers. For

MBMS PTP users, inter-frequency handover may interrupt MBMS services; therefore, service

interruption should be avoided to ensure service continuity. This function is not intended for

MBMS PTM users or PTP users with other services accompanied.

Page 48: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 48 of 415

As shown in the figure above, the f3 cell has inter-frequency neighboring cells f1 and f2. At

the border between the f1 or f2 cell and the f3 cell, when an MBMS PTP user handover from

the f3 cell to the f1 or f2 cell, the RNC shall select from the inter-frequency neighboring cell

list according to the current service received by the user. If the currently received service is

from channel 3, the RNC removes the f2 cell from the list; if the currently received service is

from channel 1 or 2, the RNC keeps the f1 and f2 cells in the list.

There can be more complicated cases.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010616 MBMS Introduction Package

WRFD-010660 MBMS Phase 2

1.4.15 WRFD-010627 FACH Transmission Sharing for MBMS

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.1.

Summary

This feature enables the FACH carrying the same MBMS service on the Iub interface to share

a transmission resource, thus saving the Iub bandwidth.

Benefits

This feature can save Iub transmission resources when the MBMS service is deployed.

Page 49: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 49 of 415

Description

This feature improves efficient Iub transport for MBMS. In previous 3GPP Rel-6, for the

same MBMS session in the same Node B, a separate Iub transport bearer has to be set up for

each cell. An example is shown in the following figure assuming 3 cells in one Node B. Three

copies of exact same MBMS session data are sent via Iub from CRNC to Node B, which is a

big waste of Iub bandwidth.

CRNC Node B

MBMS stream

broad

CN

Iub transport bearers

To maximize saving of Iub bandwidth, the latest 3GPP Rel-6 provide FACH transmission

sharing for MBMS solution to share transport bearers. RNC transports only single FACH data.

Node B transport module performs data duplication and distributes them to different FACH

Channels, as shown in the following figure, where the common transport bearer is shared over

Iub. Obviously, two-third of Iub bandwidth is saved by the improved Iub transport.

CRNC Node B

MBMS stream

broad

CN

Iub transport bearer

The feature has optimization in the control plane. Bearer multiplexing information is carried

by newly introduced NBAP signaling IEs. The advantage of this solution is that current

MBMS FP structure is kept unchanged. However, due to lack of knowledge of Node B’s

capability to share transport bearer, CRNC always sends message of bearer multiplexing

request to Node B no matter whether Node B can/will share transport bearer or not. For Node

B which can not or would not like to share, non-shared transmission bearer will be setup as in

the original way.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

Page 50: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 50 of 415

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010616 MBMS Introduction Package

1.4.16 WRFD-010626 MBMS FLC(Frequency Layer Convergence)/FLD(Frequency Layer Dispersion)

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R6.

Summary

This feature supports the reselection procedure of the MBMS frequency layer initiated by the

UE.

Benefits

With FLC, the user can acquire the information about MBMS services in time.

With FLD, the cell load can be reduced when the MBMS session is stopped.

Description

Frequency Layer Convergence denotes the process where the UTRAN requests UEs to

preferentially re-select to the frequency layer on which the MBMS service is intended to be

transmitted. This layer preference could be done by an additional MBMS session related

Layer Convergence Information (LCI) such as offset and target frequency. The FLC is

supported by specifications for both networks utilizing HCS and for networks not utilizing

HCS.

Frequency Layer Dispersion (FLD) denotes the process where the UTRAN redistributes UEs

across the frequencies. UTRAN can use FLD per MBMS session.

When FLD is applied, the UE stores the frequency where it was camped previously. Upon

session stop, the UE attempts to return to that frequency.

Enhancement

None.

Page 51: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 51 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

UE should support this function.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010616 MBMS Introduction Package

1.4.17 WRFD-010624 MBMS 8 Channels per Cell

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

With this feature, each cell supports up to eight channels for the MBMS service.

Benefits

It provides the operator the flexibility to deploy more MBMS services in a cell.

Description

In RAN6.0, up to 8 channels are supported per cell if only the total bit rate of all channels is

no more than 1024 kbit/s. The MBMS channel bit rate can be 16, 32, 64, 128, or 256kbit/s.

Enhancement

In RAN10.0, up to 8 channels can be supported per cell if only the total bit rate of all channels

is no more than 1792kbit/s. The MBMS channel bit rate can be 16, 32, 64, 128, or 256kbit/s.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

Page 52: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 52 of 415

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010616 MBMS Introduction Package

Enhanced MBMS

1.4.18 WRFD-010625 256Kbit/s Channel Rate on MBMS

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

With this feature, Huawei RAN can support an MBMS channel rate of 256kbit/s.

Benefits

The operator can deploy high bit-rate services to provide better user experience.

Description

In RAN6.0, 256kbit/s MBMS Broadcast Mode service is supported and one cell can support 4

such services. The TTI for 256kbit/s service is 40ms.

Enhancement

In RAN 10.0, the maximum number of 256kbit/s channels is enhanced from 4 to 7 per cell.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Page 53: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 53 of 415

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010616 MBMS Introduction Package

1.4.19 WRFD-010628 MBMS 16 Channels per Cell

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

Summary

With this feature, each cell supports up to 16 channels for the MBMS service.

Benefits

It provides the operator the flexibility to deploy more MBMS services in a cell.

Description

In RAN10.0, up to 16 channels can be supported per cell if only the total bit rate of all

channels is no more than 1792 kbit/s. The MBMS channel bit rate can be 16, 32, 64, 128, or

256kbit/s.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Page 54: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 54 of 415

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010616 MBMS Introduction Package

1.4.20 WRFD-010661 MBMS over Iur

Availability

This feature is available from RAN 10.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R6.

Summary

This feature supports the MBMS service crossing the Iur interface to extend the application

scope of the MBMS service.

Benefits

This feature provides completed functions of MBMS over Iur and keeps the MBMS service

continuity and improves user perception.

Description When CELL_PCH/CELL_FACH/URA_PCH UE moves into DRNC and Iur interface

exists:

− if there is no non-MBMS services established for this UE, SRNC will indicate UE to

release the RRC connection;

− If there has been non-MBMS services established for this UE, SRNS relocation with

CELL/URA update will be triggered.

When CELL_DCH UE moves into DRNC and Iur interface exists, Iur soft handover will

be triggered.

When UE moves into DRNC and Iur interface does not exist, DRNC will indicate UE to

release the RRC connection.

DRNC informs SRNC through Direct Information Transfer:

The MBMS service transfer mode in the cell during Session setup;

The MBMS service transfer mode change in the cell during session transferring;

The Preferred Frequency Layer information of MBMS service;

The Iur interface mobility management is enhanced in RAN11.0. For example, when the UE

which has MBMS service in PTP mode in CELL_DCH state moves to DRNC from SRNC, it

will setup a new RL through Iur interface. But if the cell in DRNC is transferring the MBMS

service through PTM mode, and the UE just has MBMS service, the UE will get the MBMS

service through PTM mode in DRNC to save transmission resources.

Enhancement

In RAN11.0, the DRNC informs the SRNC about more MBMS service control information

through the Direct Information Transfer message.

Page 55: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 55 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

The neighboring RNC should support MBMS Iur function.

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010660 MBMS Phase 2

1.4.21 WRFD-010662 Dynamic Power Estimation for MTCH

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

Summary

This feature enables the dynamic adjustment of the transmit power of the MTCH based on the

number of neighboring cells in PTM mode.

Benefits

Cell power can be saved by making use of soft combining gain with neighbors.

Description

To guarantee the QoS at the cell boundary, power setting for MTCH (PTM bearer) is high in

general, which means power waste. Simulation also shows that soft combining can provide

quite high gain (4.6~6.6dB), so it’s possible to set power dynamically.

Dynamic Power Setting in PTM mode:

If more than a certain portion (operator accessible parameter) of neighbours adopt PTM

mode, the power setting for the serving cell can be decreased by a specific offset

(operator accessible parameter).

If less than a certain portion of neighbours adopt PTM mode, the power setting for the

serving cell would be recovered to the original one.

Page 56: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 56 of 415

This feature will not conflict with the two power levels (Upper and Lower) defined for

MBMS Broadcast Service. Furthermore, this feature takes effect on the base of the latter

feature because it only introduced a power OFFSET.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010660 MBMS Phase 2

1.4.22 WRFD-010663 MSCH Scheduling

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

Summary

This feature enables the UE to perform DRX on the MTCH based on MSCH scheduling, thus

saving the power consumption of the UE.

Benefits

MSCH enables the UE to perform DRX on the MTCH and thus saves power consumption of

the UE.

Description

The RNC can send the MBMS scheduling information to the UE on the MSCH, which

enables the UE in PTM reception mode to implement Discontinuous Reception (DRX) on the

MTCH instead of continuous reception on the MTCH. This effectively reduces power consumption of the UE. The MBMS scheduling information is sent periodically and the

Page 57: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 57 of 415

period is called "MSCH reception cycle". The MSCH reception cycle and its offset

information are transmitted on the MCCH. When the MSCH is used, each S-CCPCH bearing

the MTCH/FACH should carry an MSCH/FACH. The channel mapping is shown below:

RAN11.0 supports the MSCH as follows: One cell supports up to 8 MSCHs (in the case of 16

MTCHs and 8 S-CCPCHs)

Restriction: If one S-CCPCH bears only one MTCH, then the MSCH should not be used.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010616 MBMS Introduction Package

Page 58: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 58 of 415

1.4.23 WRFD-010665 MBMS Channel Audience Rating Statistics

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

Summary

This feature enables the statistics of the information on MBMS channels to help the operator

obtain the audience rating of the MBMS channels.

Benefits

With this feature, the operator can obtain the audience rating statistics on MBMS channels

and their occupation in system resources.

Description

This function takes traffic statistics based on MBMS channels. Up to five channels to be

measured can be set on the M2000, then the channels ID will be sent to the corresponding

RNC. The RNC takes statistics of the following counters:

Average number of users in PTP mode

Average number of users in PTM mode

Time for channels remaining in PTM mode

Time for channels remaining in PTP mode

Based on the previous counters, the average time for each online user of the channel can be

calculated.

Enhancement

Currently, general counters are measured on the basis of a cell.

As the operator has a strong desire to obtain the counters based on MBMS channels, this

feature is a very important function.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Page 59: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 59 of 415

Dependency on CN

The BMSC on the CN side shall identify the channels with a fixed TMGI when delivering the

program source.

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010616 MBMS Introduction Package

Domain Specific Access Control (DSAC)

1.5 LCS

1.5.1 WRFD-020801 Cell ID + RTT Function Based LCS

Availability

This feature is available from RAN3.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R99.

Summary

With this feature, Huawei RAN supports location services based on Cell ID + RTT.

Benefits

This feature provides a location service for operators.

Description

Huawei RAN supports location service based on Cell-Id + RTT which locates the UE

(CELL-DCH) position by computing the TOA. (Time of Arrive).

Page 60: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 60 of 415

The TOA can be derived by the Node B RTT (Round Trip Time) measurement and the UE

Rx-Tx time difference Type 2 measurement.

NodeB

UE

RTT Measurement

UE Rx-Tx time difference Type2 Measurement

In the CELLID+RTT positioning method, the simplest solution is to take the geometrical

center of the reference cell coverage area as the positioning result. This solution requires no

positioning-related measurement and provides the shortest response time.

If the CN requires a positioning of high accuracy, the CELLID+RTT method must employ

more measurements as follows:

The RNC asks all cells in the active set to perform the RTT measurement.

The RNC asks the UE to perform the UE Rx-Tx type 2 measurement of the

corresponding cell. If the UE does not support the UE Rx-Tx type 2 measurements, the

RNC will ask the UE to perform the UE Rx-Tx type 1 measurement.

When the cell is located in the different RNC, the location over Iur is supported.

Page 61: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 61 of 415

Enhancement

Location over Iur interface is supported in RAN5.1.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

UE is needed to report the relevant measurement results.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

CN is needed to trigger the location request.

Dependency on Other Features

NA

1.5.2 WRFD-020802 OTDOA Based LCS

Availability

This feature is available from RAN3.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R99.

Summary

With this feature, Huawei RAN supports IPDL-OTDOA location services.

Benefits

This feature provides a location service for operators.

Description

Huawei supports the IPDL-OTDOA location services. In this feature, the RNC initiates and

keeps tracing the GPS timing of cell frame measurements from the Node Bs, which are

installed with a GPS card and support the GPS timing of cell frame measurement. In addition,

the RNC initiates and keeps tracing the SFN-SFN observed time difference measurement

from LMUs deployed in the network. By taking advantage of the latest measurement reports

RNC can calculate the latest RTD (Relative Time difference) of cells that are involved in a

positioning procedure.

Page 62: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 62 of 415

When RNC receives a LOCATON REPORT CONTROL message and the IPDL-OTDOA

method is selected, it requests SFN-SFN observed time difference measurement from UE, and

it calculates the UE's position after it receives the corresponding measurement report. To

assist the position calculation, RNC may request RTT measurements from Node B and

relative Rx-Tx time difference measurements from UE.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

The corresponding Node Bs should be equipped USCU card with GPS function.

Dependency on UE

UE is needed to report the relevant measurement results.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

CN is needed to trigger the location request.

Dependency on Other Features

NA

1.5.3 WRFD-020803 A-GPS Based LCS

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R99.

Summary

With this feature, Huawei RAN supports network-assisted GPS location services.

Benefits

This feature provides a highest accuracy location service.

Description

Huawei supports the UE-based and UE-assisted location services. To support this method,

RNC may deploy a GPS reference receiver to keep tracking the latest GPS data including

Page 63: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 63 of 415

ephemeris, almanac, DGPS data, etc, and calculates the fresh GPS assistance data for UE

according to the latest GPS data and the UE's reference position.

When RNC receives a LOCATON REPORT CONTROL message and the A-GPS method is

selected, it sends a GPS measurement request to UE with the GPS assistance data calculated,

and calculates the position of UE when it receives the GPS measurement report. For

UE-based A-GPS method, RNC directly forwards the location estimate from UE to

MSC/SGSN.

When the cell locates in the different RNC, the location over Iur is supported.

Enhancement

RAN5.1 supports the positioning through the Iur interface.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

If GPS receiver is located at RNC, BSC6800 should be equipped with receiver unit, BSC6900

needs clock board such as GCGa to support this feature.

Dependency on Node B

If GPS receiver is located at Node B, Node B should be equipped with USCU card with GPS

function.

Dependency on UE

UE is needed to report the relevant measurement results.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

CN is needed to trigger the location request.

Dependency on Other Features

NA

1.5.4 WRFD-020804 LCS Classified Zones

Availability

This feature is available from RAN3.0

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R99.

Page 64: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 64 of 415

Summary

This feature enables a classified zone set on the OAM to be mapped to a specific service area.

When a classified zone of the UE is changed, the RNC sends a location report to the CN.

Benefits

The operator can provide the information and service for the subscriber actively according to

the location of the subscriber. The subscriber in movement can obtain its location information

quickly.

Description

The RNC supports mapping a classified zone set by OAM to a specific Service Area. When a

mobile enters or leaves a classified zone, the RNC will generate a location report and send the

location report to corresponding CN through Location Report procedure. In LOCATION

REPORT message, the Service Area of the UE in the Area Identity IE will be included. The

CN shall react to the LOCATION REPORT message with service vendor specific actions.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

CN node must support this feature simultaneously.

Dependency on Other Features

NA

1.5.5 WRFD-020805 LCS over Iur

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.1.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R99.

Page 65: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 65 of 415

Summary

With this feature, Huawei RAN can provide location services through the Iur interface to

extend the positioning area.

Benefits

As enhancement to location service, the positioning area is widely extended, and more

reliable and precise positioning capability is achieved.

Description

Location service over Iur is supported for CELL ID+RTT and A-GPS positioning.

CELL ID+RTT

CELL ID+RTT positioning is based on the cell position information and TOA (Time of

Arrival), for which RTT (Round Trip Time), UE RxTx time difference measurements are

needed. In case (illustrated in figure below ) inter-RNC handover happened during the

positioning with CELL ID+RTT, CELL ID+RTT positioning over Iur should be

performed, including Iur interface dedicated measurement for RTT and information

exchange for neighbor RNC cell reference position (Geographical Coordinates ).

Dedicated measurement over Iur for RTT

Iur dedicated measurement procedure for acquisition of RTT is illustrated in figure below.

DS-RTx

.

DS-NoUrgent

DS-Urgent

DS-PQ

Acquisition of RTT over Iur

SRNC

Site 2

Site 1

DRNC

MSC

Page 66: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 66 of 415

Information exchange over Iur for cell reference position

To get the neighbor RNC cell reference position, information exchange procedure should be

performed, with “Information Type” IE set to “UTRAN Access Point Position”, illustrated in

figure below.

A-GPS

GPS information is required by A-GPS positioning. RNC maintains the updated GPS data

from itself or neighboring RNCs. After the reference GPS receiver is configured, the GPS

data should be obtained from neighboring RNCs and the information exchange procedure

over Iub should be performed.

During the positioning, if reference cell is located in DRNC, then GPS data from DRNC will

be preferred, and information exchange over Iur for reference cell geographical position will

be triggered.

Information exchange over Iur for GPS information

Information exchange procedure for neighboring RNC’s GPS information (with “Information

Type” IE set to “GPS Information”) is illustrated in figure below. To get the updated

information, periodic information reporting is applied.

DRNC SRNC

INFORMATION EXCHANGE INITIATION REQUEST

(Information Type: UTRAN Access Point Position)

INFORMATION EXCHANGE INITIATION RESPONSE

(Geographical Coordinates)

DRNC SRNC

DEDICATED MEASUREMENT INITIATION REQUEST

(Measurement Type: RTT)

DEDICATED MEASUREMENT INITIATION RESPONSE

DEDICATED MEASUREMENT REPORT

(Measurement Value: RTT)

Page 67: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 67 of 415

Information exchange over Iur for reference cell geographical position

To get geographical position of reference cell, information exchange procedure is triggered on

demand, for every positioning.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

DRNC SRNC

INFORMATION EXCHANGE INITIATION REQUEST

(Information Type: UTRAN Access Point Position)

INFORMATION EXCHANGE INITIATION RESPONSE

RNC 2 RNC 1

INFORMATION EXCHANGE INITIATION REQUEST

(Information Type: GPS Information)

INFORMATION EXCHANGE INITIATION RESPONSE

INFORMATION REPORT

Page 68: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 68 of 415

The neighbouring RNC should support the information exchanging and related procedures.

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-020801 Cell ID + RTT Function Based LCS

WRFD-020803 A-GPS Based LCS

1.5.6 WRFD-020807 Iupc Interface for LCS service

Availability

This feature is available from RAN12.0.

Summary

This feature supports to connect RNC and SAS (Stand-Alone SMLC) with Iupc interface

which is fully compliant with 3GPP. In this way the LCS function is working under

SAS-centric mode. This feature is usually employed when one SAS connects with many

RNCs.

Benefits

This feature offers a SAS centric Position Service mode. The merits of SAS centric mode are:

The deployed LCS algorithm and the accuracy for a certain LCS procedure are controlled by

the SAS. The operator can conveniently do the LCS service maintenance without the

technical support of RNC vendors.

In SAS-centric mode, the SAS calculate the location data. In this way, the RNC does not need

to reserve resource for LCS services.

Description

3GPP protocol offers SAS-centric mode and RNC-centric mode LCS functions.

When it works in SAS-centric mode, SAS can receive location request via RNC from CN, it

will initiate measurement request to RNC, RNC will trigger UE measurement and send the

measure result to SAS, SAS calculate the location and send the location result to CN via

RNC.

The SAS-centric mode is illustrated in the network diagram below:

Page 69: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 69 of 415

Huawei supports to connect RNC and SAS with Iupc interface. The Iupc interface is fully

compliant with the 3GPP protocol. The Iupc interface is available with IP connection. All the

IP interface boards for Iu/Iur interface in RNC support Iupc with SCCP connection.

Huawei RNC supports the following functions:

SAS-centric mode: LCS algorithm and process are controlled by SAS, the RNC only offers

LCS measurement;

In SAS-centric mode, RNC supports A-GPS and CELLID+RTT LCS method;

If the operator needs to use other LCS algorithm or process, the RNC-centric mode is

recommended.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

IP interface boards of BSC6900 support this feature.

BSC6800 cannot support this feature.

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

R

N

C

(

S

M

L

C

)

I

u

U

E

R

N

C

U

E

U

E

S

A

S

L

C

S

C

l

i

e

n

t

G

M

L

C

M

S

C

I

u

S

A

S

I

u

P

C

I

u

b

U

u

R

N

C

R

N

C

I

u

r

S

G

S

N

N

o

d

e

B

N

o

d

e

B

U

E

G

P

S

n

e

t

w

o

r

k

,

f

o

r

e

x

a

m

p

l

e

:

W

A

R

N

Page 70: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 70 of 415

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

When the operator employs Cell ID+RTT algorithm, the feature WRFD-020801 Cell ID

+ RTT Function Based LCS is needed.

When the operator employs A-GPS algorithm, the feature WRFD-020803 A-GPS Based

LCS is needed.

1.6 PTT

1.6.1 WRFD-020134 Push to Talk

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0.

Summary

This feature is a part of end-to-end PTT solution. PTT needs support from the UE, RAN, CN,

and PTT server. In this feature, the RAN identifies PTT services and implements technologies

to reduce the delay of PTT services.

Benefits

This feature supports PTT solution from RAN side. By reducing the delay of PTT service, this

feature can also help to improve user satisfaction.

Description

PTT is a service option of conversing on half-duplex and point-to-point or point-to-multipoint

communication lines. A PTT connection connects instantly without ringing after a subscriber

simply presses a key. In addition, a caller can speak to a group of persons with a single button

press. Therefore, PTT is characterized by quick call establishment and convenient team

communication. The following figure shows an application of PTT in a UMTS network.

Page 71: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 71 of 415

PTT services consist of start-up process and call setup process:

Start-up process

After a UE starts the PTT client, the startup process begins. The process includes the

following actions:

PTT UE registration

In this process, UE registers itself in PTT server by message exchange.

PTT UE identification

In this process, RNC will identify the PTT UE when receiving a RAB Assignment with

special QoS parameters and then keep the UE in CELL_PCH/URA_PCH state.

Call setup process

After a subscriber presses the PTT button, the call setup process begins. The network will

setup channel for the PTT service.

The delay of PTT call establishment should be short. To reduce the end-to-end delay, the

following technologies are used in the call setup process.

Always On: RNC retains the UE in CELL_PCH/URA_PCH state when there is no data

activity, that is, the UE is always on in RNC. CN also has mechanism to keep UE always on.

The Always On state allows when the UE has traffic, it need not to re-setup the RRC

connection and perform activation procedure.

P2D direct state transition: A PTT UE directly transfers its state from the

CELL_PCH/URA_PCH state to the CELL_DCH state. This is to reduce the PTT transmission

delay and thus improve the PTT call setup performance.

Preferred paging: The RNC prioritizes PTT paging over paging of other lower priority

applications to improve PTT call setup delay performance.

Early Reception and Transmission: RAN supports the reception of PTT user data on E-DCH

before receiving the Cell Update Confirm Response message from the PTT UE; RAN also

supports transmit message to the PTT UE over the HS-DSCH channel without waiting for the

Cell Update Confirm Response to reduce the delay.

Page 72: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 72 of 415

Fast L1 synchronization: The TS 25.331 in 3GPP Release 6 introduces the “Post-verification

period” IE to indicate whether a UE uses fast L1 synchronization. This IE is included in the

Radio Bearer Reconfiguration and Cell Update Confirm messages. Fast L1 synchronization

allows PTT UEs to perform uplink and downlink L1 synchronization concurrently, thus

reduces the PTT call setup delay for PTT UEs in CELL_PCH/URA_PCH state at the start of

the call.

Scheduling: PTT services are carried on the HSPA, NodeB schedules PTT as VoIP in the

downlink, and NodeB applies non-scheduling policy for PTT in the uplink.

Enhanced CELL-PCH: With E-PCH function, PCCH can be mapped to HS-DSCH when UE

in URA_PCH state, PCCH/DCCH/DTCH can be mapped to HS-DSCH when UE is in

CELL_PCH state, UE can directly receive data on HS-DSCH without any state transfer, so

the data transmission delay will be reduced.

With these technologies, the PTT call setup time can be reduced to about 1.1-1.3s.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

None

Dependency on NodeB hardware

None

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

WRFD-010688 Downlink Enhanced CELL_FACH

WRFD-010636 SRB over HSUPA

Dependency on other NEs

The UE, CN should support the PTT solution.

Page 73: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 73 of 415

2 MBB

2.1 HSUPA Prime Service

2.1.1 WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R6.

Summary

This feature package enables the system to process HSUPA services, thus improving the

uplink rate and system throughput. This feature package provides basic functions of HSUPA

to meet the basic requirements for operation of HSUPA services.

Benefits

HSUPA improves the performance of UMTS network by providing higher rate and higher

throughput for the uplink as well as higher capacity for the system.

Description

High Speed Uplink Packet Access (HSUPA) is an important feature introduced in 3GPP

Release 6. A new uplink transport channel, E-DCH, is introduced. Like what is done for

HSDPA, HSUPA improves the system capacity and throughout for uplink by maximizing

power utilization and adjusting the uplink bit rate according to channel quality.

The key functions used in HSUPA for maximizing resource utilization include 2 ms/10 ms

TTI, Hybrid Automatic Repeat Request (HARQ), and fast scheduling at the Node B.

The basic principle behind HARQ for HSUPA is the same as that for HSDPA. After each

transmitted TTI, the Node B informs the transmitting UE of whether the uplink data was

received correctly or not. The UE retransmits the packet if incorrect reception occurs. HSUPA

HARQ either uses chase combing where each retransmission is the exact copy of the initial

data or incremental redundancy where the retransmission only contains the redundancy bits.

The fast scheduling algorithm at the Node B enables the system to make scheduling decision

with the minimum latency as close to the radio interface as possible. Even though the Node B

Page 74: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 74 of 415

makes the scheduling decision, it is the UE that decides the transmitted power and the

transmit format.

In RAN6.0, only 10 ms TTI is supported and the maximum uplink rate is 1.44 Mbit/s (MAC

layer) per user. Each cell can support up to 20 HSUPA users.

Enhancement

In RAN10.0, HSUPA Introduction Package is enhanced. For details, refer to the enhancement

of the features in the package.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NBBI and NULP board can not support this feature.

Dependency on UE

UE should have HSUPA capability.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

2.1.2 WRFD-01061201 HSUPA UE Category Support

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

This feature enables Huawei Node B to support UEs of category 1 to category 7 defined in

3GPP.

Benefits

This feature supports HSUPA services for seven categories of UE so as to provide high bit

rate services for different categories of UEs. The maximum bit rate that can be achieved by

the UE depends on the UE specification.

Page 75: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 75 of 415

Description

In order to provide services of multiple bit rates, seven HSUPA UE categories are defined in

3GPP specifications. The maximum number of codes over the E-DCH supported varies with

the UE category. That is, different UE categories support different maximum bit rates.

For example, in the following table, UE of category 3 supports two SF4 codes and the

maximum data rate can be 1.44 Mbit/s.

E-DCH Category

Max. Capability Combination

E-DCH TTI Max. Data Rate (Mbit/s)

MAC Layer

10 ms TTI

MAC Layer

2 ms TTI

Air Interface

Category 1 1 x SF4 10 ms only 0.71 – 0.96

Category 2 2 x SF4 10 ms and 2 ms 1.44 1.40 1.92

Category 3 2 x SF4 10 ms only 1.44 – 1.92

Category 4 2 x SF2 10 ms and 2 ms 2.0 2.89 3.84

Category 5 2 x SF2 10 ms only 2.0 – 3.84

Category 6 2 x SF4 + 2 xS

F2

10 ms and 2 ms 2.0 5.74 5.76

Category 7 2 x SF4 + 2 xS

F2

10 ms and 2 ms 2.0 11.50 11.52

RAN10.0 supports SF2 and 2 ms TTI.

Enhancement

RAN6.0 supports only SF4 and TTI of only 10 ms. Therefore, UEs of categories 2, 4, 5, and 6

can support TTI of only 10 ms in RAN6.0.

RAN10.0 supports SF2 and 2 ms TTI of categories 1~6.

RAN12.0 supports UEs of categories 7.

RAN14.0 supports UEs of categories 1 to 9.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Page 76: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 76 of 415

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA introduction package

2.1.3 WRFD-01061209 HSUPA HARQ and Fast UL Scheduling in Node B

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

The operator can set different QoS parameters such as user priority, scheduling weight, and

GBR. Based on the QoS parameters, this feature can ensure that different users enjoy

differentiated QoS experience and higher cell throughput.

Benefits

HARQ scheme improves the data transmission effeciency and reduces the delay, thereby

enhancing the users service perception.

The MAC-e scheduling algorithm improves the UL throughput of the UE and increases the

CE resource utilization in view of the limitations on the CE resources.

The combination of the MAC-e scheduling and flow control algorithms further increases the

bandwidth efficiency for each UE.

Description

High Speed Uplink Packet Access (HSUPA) is an important feature introduced in 3GPP

Release 6. HSUPA improves the system capacity and throughput for the uplink by

maximizing power utilization and adjusting the uplink bit rate according to the channel

quality.

The key functions used in HSUPA for maximizing resource utilization include 2 ms/10 ms

TTI, Hybrid Automatic Repeat Request (HARQ), and fast scheduling in the Node B.

The basic principle of HSUPA HARQ is the same as that of HSDPA HARQ. In each TTI, the

Node B informs the transmitting UE of whether the uplink data is received correctly or not.

The UE retransmits the packet if the uplink data is not correctly received. HSUPA HARQ

either uses chase combining where each retransmission is the exact copy of the initial data or

uses incremental redundancy where the retransmission contains the additional redundant

informtion for correct decoding.

Page 77: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 77 of 415

The fast scheduling algorithm in the Node B enables the system to make the scheduling

decision with the minimum latency as close to the radio interface as possible. Even though the

Node B makes the scheduling decision, the UE shall decide the transmit power and the

transmit format.

RAN6.0 supports only 10 ms TTI and the maximum uplink rate of 1.44 Mbit/s per user (at the

MAC layer). Each cell supports up to 20 HSUPA users.

RAN10.0 supports 2 ms TTI and the maximum uplink rate of 5.74 Mbit/s per user (at the

MAC layer). Each cell supports up to 60 HSUPA users.

The users can also be categorized into three levels: gold, silver, and copper, which are mapped

from the ALLOCATION / RETENTION PRIORITY. The mapping is configurable. Moreover,

the DL/UL GBR is also a user-defined parameter for each priority level and is used for

HSUPA scheduler algorithm. This feature also improves the mechanism for ensuring the QoS

of HSUPA.

Enhancement

RAN10.0 supports 2 ms TTI.

In RAN10.0, the MAC-e scheduling algorithm considers the limitation on CE resources

during scheduling.

In RAN11.0, the MAC-e scheduling algorithm is optimized by combining the flow control

algorithm. Flow control determines each UE's primary rate and authorization indication

according to the buffer status of the UE and the congestion indication from the RNC. The

MAC-e scheduling algorithm performs scheduling based on the primary rate and

authorization indication.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package.

Page 78: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 78 of 415

2.1.4 WRFD-01061202 HSUPA Admission Control

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

This feature enables HSUPA and R99 services to simultaneously access the network by using

the remaining uplink cell load and other resources, thus improving the utilization of system

resources and ensuring QoS.

Benefits

This feature enables HSUPA services to properly utilize the system resources and enable

HSUPA service and R99 service to exist in the same cell. The system resources such as the

Iub transport resources, cell load resources, and user number resources can be reserved to

provide high bit rate services for users.

Description

HSUPA service admission control enables HSUPA services to access the network with other

R99 services by using the remaining uplink cell load as well as other resources. It can fully

utilize the system resources.

In the HSUPA admission control procedure, the HSUPA users per Node B and per cell are

determined by the configuration on the RNC side.

Besides the limitation of total HSUPA user number for best effort and streaming services, the

sum of uplink cell radio load resources for both DCH and E-DCH should also be considered.

The following two algorithms are available for uplink cell radio load:

Algorithm 1: uplink cell radio load admission decision based on Equivalent Number of

Users (ENU)

Based on the current equivalent number of users (including existing R99 and HSUPA

users) and the access request, the RNC decides whether the equivalent number of users

exceeds the threshold or not and whether to admit a new call. GBR is used to calculate

the ENU of HSUPA services.

Algorithm 2: uplink cell radio load admission decision based on Provided Bit Rate (PBR)

and power

The RNC performs a check to ensure that the aggregated traffic at the provided bit rate

exceeds the sum of all GBRs for existing traffic multiplied by a configurable threshold.

If the condition of PBR is not fulfilled, RNC further performs a check of the power

resource on the basis of Received Total Wideband Power (RTWP) and Received

Scheduled E-DCH Power Share (RSEPS) measurement.

Both Iub resources and Node B credit resources should be checked during the admission

control to enable the HSUPA services and other R99 services to be admitted under a certain

guaranteed QoS.

During the admission control, the RNC decides whether the service is mapped to E-DCH or

not by setting service rate thresholds. The thresholds include a UL streaming service HSUPA

Page 79: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 79 of 415

threshold and a UL BE service HSUPA threshold. Only when the requested bit rate of the

incoming call is higher than the threshold can the call be mapped on HSUPA.

Queuing and pre-emption are considered for HSUPA if admission control fails due to

limitation of user number or equivalent user number.

Enhancement

In RAN10.0, Received Scheduled E-DCH Power Share (RSEPS) measurement is supported,

and algorithm 2 is available.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

2.1.5 WRFD-01061203 HSUPA Power Control

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

With the introduction of new physical channels, this feature can improve the power efficiency

of the system, reduce UL and DL interference, and increase the system capacity.

Benefits

This feature enables the system to provide reliable quality for HSUPA-related channels. It

increases system capacity and reduces uplink interference and downlink power output.

Page 80: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 80 of 415

Description

When HSUPA service is introduced, the E-DCH transport channel is used. Five new physical

channels, namely, E-DPDCH, E-DPCCH, E-HICH, E-RGCH and E-AGCH are used.

E-DPDCH is used to carry the E-DCH transport channel, and E-DPCCH is used to transmit

control information related to the E-DCH.

An E-DPCCH power offset related to the DPCCH is used to perform the power control on

E-DPCCH. The power of DPCCH is adjusted by inner loop power control, and thus the

E-DPCCH power is also controlled by the inner loop power control. The power offset can be

set at the RNC. The scheme of inner loop power control is introduced in WRFD-020504.

For the E-DPDCH, another power offset related to DPCCH is used and the same power

control method as that of the E-DPCCH is used. The power offset is also configurable at the

RNC.

For the E-HICH and E-RGCH, there are two methods to control the transmit power: constant

transmit power and DPCH-based dynamic power control. When a constant transmit power is

used, the transmit power of E-RGCH and E-HICH is given by a power offset related to the

transmit power on the P-CPICH. When DPCH-based dynamic power control is used, three

different power offsets related to the DPCCH are used.

For the E-AGCH, the methods of constant transmit power and DPCH-based dynamic power

control can also be used.

For the E-DCH, the initial power is controlled by open loop power control.

On the uplink, outer loop power control for the E-DCH is also used to control link quality.

E-DCH SIR target is adjusted by the E-DCH OLPC scheme, which is the same as that of the

DCH. The DCH OLPC scheme is introduced in WRFD-020503.

In addition, the reference E-TFCI power offset and HARQ power offset can also be adjusted

by the E-DCH OLPC scheme through a reconfiguration procedure.

Enhancement

In RAN 6.0, the E-DCH OLPC algorithm is performed based on NHR and PROB. NHR is

defined as the number of HARQ retransmissions, and PROB is defined as the probability of

receiving packets whose retransmission times are more than the NHR target.

In RAN10.0, the E-DCH OLPC algorithm based on residual BLER instead of PROB is

provided. It is applicable to zero retransmission and delay-sensitive services.

In RAN10.0, the E-DCH supports dynamic power control based on CQI and HS-SCCH. In

addition, the E-DCH can also use the constant transmit power and DPCH-based dynamic

power control in RAN6.0.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Page 81: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 81 of 415

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

2.1.6 WRFD-01061204 HSUPA Mobility Management

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

This feature is related to HSUPA mobility management. This feature can ensure that HSUPA

services are continuous.

Benefits

This feature reduces user data interruption and improves perceived data transfer quality when

UE moves with HSUPA services. It also provides a method to ensure the service continuity

between R99 cells and HSUPA cells.

Description

HSUPA mobility management function enables the handover for an HSUPA user to an R99

cell or another HSUPA cell when HSUPA user is moving. The feature also enables the

HSUPA user to change a cell with less chance of service interruption.

The E-DCH can perform soft/softer handover on the uplink while the HS-DSCH can not.

Soft handover of the E-DCH is the HSUPA user mobility solution. The handover of the

E-DCH and DCH are very similar. Both are based on the measurement report of the UE and

are controlled by the network. If the downlink channel is DCH, soft handover is also used on

the downlink as stipulated in Release 99.

If the UE has both HSDPA and HSUPA, the HS-DSCH cell change procedure is used for the

downlink. As the uplink and downlink are independent, the measurement and the handover

decision are made separately.

Compared with DCH, the maximum E-DCH active set size is 4, but the maximum DCH

active set size is 6. Therefore, the Active Set (AS) of E-DCH is independent of the AS of

DCH.

UL channel type selection is determined by whether the best cell in DCH AS can support

HSUPA or not.

Page 82: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 82 of 415

For intra-frequency cells, soft/softer handover occurs when the HSUPA connection is moved

from one HSUPA cell to another HSUPA cell. The target HSUPA cell could be added into

Active Set triggered by 1a, 1c, and 1d event report, or removed from Active Set trigged by 1b

event report.

The active set of E-DCH is independent of the AS of DCH. 1J event report is supported. A

non-active E-DCH but active DCH primary CPICH becomes better than an active E-DCH

primary CPICH. This non-active E-DCH cell is added into the AS of E-DCH.

For inter-frequency neighboring cells, inter-frequency hard handover between HSUPA cells is

triggered. The service is changed to E-DCH of target cell. The hard handover depends on the

UE measurement.

Handover from an HSUPA Cell to an R99 Cell

When the UE is moving from an HSUPA cell to an R99 cell (intra-frequency) and 1a

event is triggered, the HSUPA connection between UE and HSUPA cell is not changed

unless this R99 cell becomes the best cell. Then, this R99 cell is added into the active set

of DCH because the active set of E-DCH is independent of the active set of DCH.

If the neighboring cell of HSUPA cell is an inter-frequency cell and doesn’t support

HSUPA, hard handover, together with a channel switch from E-DCH to DCH, is

performed. The HSUPA handover decision is based on the measurement report of the

pilot channels of neighboring cells.

Handover from an R99 Cell to an HSUPA Cell

When an HSUPA-capable UE accesses an R99 cell, only the DCH channel is used to

carry the services. When the UE moves from an R99 cell to an HSUPA cell:

If the R99 cell and the HSDPA cell are intra-frequency cells, this HSUPA cell is added to

the AS of E-DCH since the active set of E-DCH is independent of the AS of DCH.

If the R99 cell and the HSDPA cell are inter-frequency cells, inter-frequency hard

handover is triggered when the quality of the signals of HSUPA cell becomes better. The

UE changes from the R99 cell to the HSUPA cell and the PS services are switched from

the DCH to the E-DCH.

Handover from an HSUPA Cell to a 2G Cell

The handover from an HSUPA cell to a 2G cell is triggered by normal inter-RAT

handover. See features of inter-RAT handover for detailed information.

Inter-RNC Handover for HSUPA

For cell change between RNCs, inter-RNC soft handover over Iur for HSUPA is

available.

Compressed mode measurement for HSUPA

Compressed mode measurement is available for E-DCH with TTI of 10 ms or 2ms in the

case of inter-frequency and inter-RAT handover.

Enhancement

In RAN10.0, the AS of E-DCH is independent of the AS of DCH and 1J event report is

supported.

The 2ms TTI of the E-DCH can be measured in compressed mode.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

Page 83: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 83 of 415

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

2.1.7 WRFD-01061208 HSUPA DCCC

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

HSUPA DCCC can dynamically adjust the minimum SF code of HSUPA based on the user

throughput and flexibly switch the UE state based on the user traffic, thus improving the

utilization of CE resources and system efficiency.

Benefits

This feature can improve the utilization of CE resources and make it possible for the UE to

enjoy the high-speed service. When the UE is in inactive state, this feature enables the UE to

be handed over to the CELL_FACH to save system resources.

Description

HSUPA DCCC is comprised of rate re-allocation and UE state transition functions:

Rate re-allocation

Rate re-allocation of HSUPA DCCC is based on traffic volume. According to traffic

volume measurement report received from the RNC, rate re-allocation increases or

decreases the uplink data rate for the best effort (BE) services (i.e. interactive and

background services) to a proper value to improve the CE resource utilization.

UE state transition

With the introduction of HSUPA, a new RRC state of CELL_DCH (E-DCH) is provided,

which means that the UE is in the CELL_DCH state with services mapping on the

E-DCH channel.

Channel Switching Between CELL_DCH (E-DCH) and CELL_FACH

Page 84: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 84 of 415

If the E-DCH is carrying BE service or streaming service and there is no data to be sent for a

long time, the transition from CELL_DCH (E-DCH) to CELL_FACH is triggered. Actually,

this feature is supported in the same way as the state transition from CELL_DCH to

CELL_FACH.

The switch from CELL_FACH to CELL_DCH (E-DCH) is triggered by a request for higher

bit rates on uplink.

Channel Switching Between CELL_DCH (E-DCH) and CELL_DCH

The channel switching between e-DCH and DCH is mainly triggered by mobility

management. The transition from CELL_DCH to CELL_DCH (E-DCH) can be triggered by

periodical retries and the traffic volume.

The mobility trigger is described in WRFD-01061204 HSUPA mobility management feature.

Traffic volume measurement report indicates that a higher bit service needs to be transferred.

The UE in CELL_FACH is transferred to CELL_DCH (E-DCH) if it is in a HSUPA capable

cell and the UE has HSUPA capabilities. This feature enables the UE to be served with high

speed service.

If a service of the HSUPA-capable UE is set up on the DCH due to some reasons, for example,

admission to E-DCH fails, the periodical retry mechanism takes action, allowing the UE state

to be transferred to CELL_DCH (E-DCH). The retry time is configurable.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

Page 85: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 85 of 415

2.1.8 WRFD-01061207 HSUPA Transport Resource Management

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

This feature covers the mapping and allocation of differentiated transmission resources for

different HSUPA users and the admission control and congestion control of transmission

resources. These algorithms implement QoS classification and differentiation in end-to-end,

seamless mapping. This feature can greatly improve the utilization of Iub resources and

ensure QoS and differentiation.

Benefits

Differentiated service is implemented by different traffic being carried on different paths, and

thus optimizes the QoS and network performance. This feature improves transport resource

usage efficiency and saves OPEX on Iub transmission.

Description

With HSUPA feature introduced, the throughput over Iub interface may be increased and

varied greatly. This feature is used to optimize usage of Iub transport resources for the

HSUPA services. The following features are concerned.

Differentiated services mapping

Transport resource load control

I. Differentiated services mapping

The PS streaming and best effort services can be set up on HSUPA. Different services have

different QoS requirements, and the Iub transport will be IP and/or ATM. Therefore, the traffic

categories such as ATMHURT, ATMHUNRT, IPHURT, and IPHUNRT are added accordingly.

Traffic Categories

Traffic Type

ATMHURT HSUPA streaming services

ATMHUNRT HSUPA interactive services and HSUPA background services

IPHURT HSUPA streaming services

IPHUNRT HSUPA interactive services and HSDPA background services

Moreover, differentiated transmission must be applied according to the QoS requirements of

services. The following table describes the mapping relationship.

AAL2 Path Type Service Type of ATM Traffic

ATMHURT, HSPA CBR, RTVBR

Page 86: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 86 of 415

ATMHUNRT HSPA NRTVBR, UBR

The mapping between traffic categories and path types is configurable. The following table

provides an example on an ATM-based network.

Traffic Category Primary Path Type Secondary Path Type

HSUPA streaming ATMHURT None

HSUPA interactive ATMHUNRT None

HSUPA background ATMHUNRT None

The secondary path type configuration can be used as mutual backup of transmission

resources especially in ATM and IP hybrid transmission solutions, that is, when IP

transmission fails, the service can be mapped to the secondary ATM path to keep the services

available, or vice verse. The following table describes such configurations.

Traffic Category Primary Path Type Secondary Path Type

HSUPA streaming ATMHURT IPHURT

HSUPA interactive ATMHUNRT IPHURT

HSUPA background ATMHUNRT IPHURT

By using this feature, different services are carried on corresponding paths, and the

differentiated service is implemented.

II. Transmission resource load control

Transmission resource load control refers to admission control and congestion control.

For the admission control, Guaranteed Bit Rate (GBR) is considered for HSUPA service

admission, and it belongs to the optional feature WRFD-01061202 HSUPA Admission

Control.

For the congestion control, the load reshuffling strategy is applied in scenarios such as

inter-RAT handover. This feature belongs to the optional feature WRFD-020306 Inter-RAT

Handover Based on Load.

Enhancement

In RAN6.1, each traffic class mapping to transmission resource can be configured separately.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Page 87: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 87 of 415

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

Optional feature WRFD-050402 IP Transmission (Iub interface), WRFD-050403 Hybrid

IP Transmission, and WRFD-050404 ATM/IP Dual Stack Node B should be required

when the transmission resource management feature is applied for IP transmission

resources in those scenarios.

2.1.9 WRFD-01061206 Interactive and Background Traffic Class on HSUPA

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

This feature enables interactive and background services to be mapped to the E-DCH to

obtain a higher service rate and enhance user experience.

Benefits

This feature enables the system to support a higher speed RAB of the PS interactive and

background services.

Description

This feature enables the best effort (interactive and background) services to be mapped on the

E-DCH if a UE is HSUPA capable. The system sets a switch to enable or disable the feature

that BE traffic is mapped on to E-DCH. A service rate threshold is also set so that the

requested service can be mapped on E-DCH only when the requested service bit rate is higher

than the threshold. Otherwise, the requested service is mapped on the DCH. The service rate

threshold is configurable by the operator.

When the best effort service is carried on the E-DCH, the maximum uplink bit rate is 5.74

Mbit/s (MAC layer).

Page 88: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 88 of 415

When a UE has BE service on E-DCH, it can use another DCH CS RAB or another DCH PS

RAB simultaneously. If the UE capability is allowed, the UE can be served by two HSUPA

RABs.

GBR of HSUPA BE traffic is set and used to estimate whether the maximum available

resource for HSUPA can satisfy the requirements of streaming services and BE services in

admission control. The GBR of HSUPA BE traffic is configurable by operator.

The HSUPA schedule algorithm also considers the configured GBR information of HSUPA

BE traffic.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

2.1.10 WRFD-01061210 HSUPA 1.44Mbit/s per User

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0

Summary

This feature enables the HSUPA rate per user to reach a maximum of 1.44 Mbit/s.

Benefits

This feature provides a higher peak bit rate and enhances the user experience.

Page 89: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 89 of 415

Description

High Speed Uplink Packet Access (HSUPA) is an important feature of 3GPP Release 6 that

provides high speed service for uplink. With this feature, the UE with interactive or

background services on the E-DCH can reach the peak bit rate of 1.44 Mbit/s (MAC Layer).

Thus, user experience is greatly enhanced.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

UE should have the capability of HSDPA Category 3(or later)

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

CN support the uplink speed of 1.44Mbit/s (or more)

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

2.1.11 WRFD-01061211 20 HSUPA Users per Cell

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

This feature enables a single HSUPA cell to simultaneously support 20 HSUPA users. If the

number of HSUPA users exceeds 20, the DCH is attempted for service provisioning.

Benefits

This feature provides HSUPA services at a higher peak bit rate for up to 20 users per cell.

Description

Up to 20 HSUPA users can be admitted to a HSUPA cell.

Page 90: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 90 of 415

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

2.1.12 WRFD-010614 HSUPA Phase 2

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R6.

Summary

HSUPA Phase2 is an enhanced HSUPA feature that supports 2ms transmission time interval

(TTI).

Compared with 10ms TTI provided in the HSUPA introduction package, this feature can

provide a higher uplink rate and lower delay. This feature provides a series of enhanced

HSUPA functions to meet the commercial requirements of HSUPA services.

Benefits

HSUPA improves the performance of UMTS network by providing higher rate and higher

throughput for the uplink and higher capacity for the system.

Description

High Speed Uplink Packet Access (HSUPA) is an important feature introduced in 3GPP

Release 6.

Page 91: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 91 of 415

In RAN6.0, only 10 ms TTI is supported and the maximum uplink rate is1.44 Mbit/s (MAC

layer) /1.92 Mbit/s (physical layer) per user. Each cell supports up to 20 HSUPA users.

In RAN10.0, the 2 ms TTI is supported, the maximum uplink rate is 5.74 Mbit/s (MAC

layer)/5.76 Mbit/s (physical layer).

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

The BTS3812E, BTS3812A and BTS3812AE need to configure EBBI board,EBOI board,

EDLP or EDLPd board.

The BBU3806 need to configure EBBC/EBBCd board; the BBU3806C need to configure

EBBM board.

The BBU3900 need to configure WBBPb/WBBPd board.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

The software dependency is described in each sub functions.

2.1.13 WRFD-01061401 HSUPA E-AGCH Power Control (Based on CQI or HS-SCCH)

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

Summary

This feature enables the UE to report the CQI and HS-SCCH as a reference, thus effectively

reducing the power consumption of the E-AGCH.

Page 92: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 92 of 415

Benefits

E-AGCH power control based on CQI or HS-SCCH makes it more efficient to adjust the

power of E-AGCH under the condition that HSDPA co-exists with HSUPA.

By using E-AGCH power control based on CQI or HS-SCCH, the following advantages are

introduced:

Less power consumption of E-AGCH

Flexible power control for E-AGCH

Description

In 3GPP specifications, the serving cell of HSUPA should be the same with that of HSDPA.

Meanwhile, E-AGCH belongs to the serving cell of HSUPA, so the power control of E-

AGCH can take advantage of the information of HSDPA, such as CQI and HS-SCCH, which

can reflect the quality of transmission in the serving cell.

The power control of E-AGCH is enhanced in HSUPA phase II when HSUPA coexists with

HSDPA. At this time, CQI or HS-SCCH information is used to adjust the power offset of

E-AGCH. Consequently, it can spare more power for the downlink transmission.

CQI reflects the channel quality of the serving cell. When the CQI information is

available, it can be used to adjust the power offset of E-AGCH.

The demodulation error probability of HS-SCCH can be adjusted by modification of the

transmission power of HS-SCCH. Since the demodulation requirements for E- AGCH

are similar to those for HS-SCCH, power offset of E-AGCH can be modified based on

that of HS-SCCH.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

Page 93: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 93 of 415

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

2.1.14 WRFD-01061402 Enhanced Fast UL Scheduling

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

Summary

This feature enables comprehensive considerations of system resources and QoS parameters

preset for different users to ensure accurate differentiated user experience and improve cell

throughput.

Benefits

Enhanced UL scheduling makes it more efficient to accommodate different scenarios, such as

hub Node B, IP convergence, and RAN sharing.

This feature enables more efficient usage of uplink resource by maximizing the uplink

throughput of the cell under the condition that the QoS requirements of all UEs are met.

This feature provides better fairness among users. If there are users with the same priority, the

uplink resources allocated to them are similar.

This feature provides flexible priorities among users. If a UE has a higher priority, it can

obtain more uplink resources.

Description

In HSUPA phase II, the 2 ms TTI is supported. The UL scheduling is enhanced based on the

shorter TTI.

The Proportional Fair (PF) scheduling algorithm is enhanced in HSUPA phase II. PF is based

on uplink load factor and takes advantage of downlink control channels (E-AGCH/E-RGCH)

to influence the E-TFCI that the UE may use. Consequently, it can tightly control the uplink

interference.

When the scheduling period arrives, the PF scheduling algorithm performs the following

operations:

Queue the HSUPA users based on the scheduling priority indicator, GBR, and data rate.

Consider the CE resources and Iub transport resources.

Assign absolute grant according to the Scheduling Information (SI) sent by the UE,

which can control the maximum rate the UE may use.

Assign relative grant according to the happy bit on the E-DPCCH.

Shorter TTI means more efficient schedule process.

High Speed Uplink Packet Access (HSUPA) is an important feature of 3GPP Release 6 that

provides high speed service for the uplink. In order to provide multiple bit rate services, six

UE categories are defined in 3GPP. Different UE categories support different maximum codes

for E-DCH, which means that different maximum bit rates can be achieved.

Page 94: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 94 of 415

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

WRFD-010638 Dynamic CE Resource Management

2.1.15 WRFD-01061403 HSUPA 2ms TTI

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

Summary

The 2ms TTI of HSUPA enables a single user to obtain a higher UL throughput and shorter

delay.

Benefits

By using a shorter TTI on the Uu interface, HSUPA has the following advantages:

Faster data scheduling

Higher UL peak data rate

Lower latency

Description

There are two Transmission Time Intervals (TTIs) defined in the 3GPP protocol for HSUPA.

10 ms TTI is mandatory for all HSUPA capable UEs while 2 ms TTI is optional. Switching

between the two TTIs is performed by UTRAN through L3 signaling.

Page 95: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 95 of 415

In RAN10.0, 2 ms TTI is supported. Thus, all UEs of the six categories can be supported.

E-DCH Category

Max. Capability Combination

E-DCH TTI Max. Data Rate (Mbit/s)

MAC Layer

10 ms TTI

MAC Layer

2 ms TTI

Air Interface

Category 1 1 x SF4 10 ms only 0.71 – 0.96

Category 2 2 x SF4 10 ms and 2 ms 1.45 1.40 1.92

Category 3 2 x SF4 10 ms only 1.45 – 1.92

Category 4 2 x SF2 10 ms and 2 ms 2.0 2.89 3.84

Category 5 2 x SF2 10 ms only 2.0 – 3.84

Category 6 2 x SF4 + 2 x

SF2

10 ms and 2 ms 2.0 5.74 5.76

Category 7 2 x SF4 + 2 x

SF2

10 ms and 2 ms 2.0 11.498 11.52

Compressed mode measurement is available for E-DCH 2 ms in the case of inter-frequency

and inter-RAT handover.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

The BTS3812E, BTS3812A and BTS3812AE need to configure EBBI board, EBOI

board, EDLP or EDLPd board.

The BBU3806 need to configure EBBC/EBBCd board; the BBU3806C need to configure

EBBM board.

The BBU3900 need to configure WBBPb/WBBPd board.

Dependency on UE

UE should have the capability of HSDPA Category 2, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Page 96: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 96 of 415

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

2.1.16 WRFD-01061404 HSUPA 2ms/10ms TTI Handover

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

Summary

As 2 ms TTI capable cells and 10 ms TTI capable cells coexist in the network and different

TTIs are required for different throughputs, the handover between 2 ms TTI and 10 ms TTI is

necessary. This feature can ensure that HSUPA users smoothly move between different cells

and resources are allocated for throughput requirements.

Benefits

This feature supports mobility between 2 ms TTI capable cell and non-2 ms-scheduling

capable cell.

This feature maximizes the possibility for 2 ms TTI capable UE to get the best performance

by using 2 ms scheduling feature.

Description

Both 10 ms and 2 ms TTI are defined in the 3GPP protocol for HSUPA. In the HSUPA

network, when UE moves between cells that support HSUPA 2 ms TTI and those does not, the

switching schedule between 10 ms and 2 ms TTIs is needed. Such switching generally occurs

in the handover scenario as described below.

When the soft handover happens to an UE using HSUPA 2 ms TTI and the target cell

doesn’t support 2 ms TTI, the RNC first reconfigures the UE to 10 ms TTI and then

performs the handover procedure.

When the hard handover happens to an UE using HSUPA 2 ms TTI and the target cell

doesn’t support 2 ms TTI, the RNC performs the handover and reconfigures the UE to 10

ms TTI at the same time.

When all the cells in active set using HSUPA 10 ms TTI support 2 ms TTI, a periodical

retry to reconfigure to 2 ms TTI is implemented to make it possible to get better

performance. On the other hand, a configurable bit rate threshold is triggered by such

retry procedure, that is, when the RAB maximum bit rate assigned is lower than the

threshold, it is unnecessary to use 2 ms TTI.

The RNC gets the 2 ms TTI capability from the audit message sent by the Node B. For the

neighboring cells that are not controlled by the RNC, such capability can be configured by the

operator.

Page 97: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 97 of 415

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

The BTS3812E, BTS3812A and BTS3812AE need to configure EBBI board,EBOI board,

EDLP or EDLPd board.

The BBU3806 need to configure EBBC/EBBCd board; the BBU3806C need to configure

EBBM board.

The BBU3900 need to configure WBBPb/WBBPd board.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010614 HSUPA Phase 2

2.1.17 WRFD-01061405 HSUPA 5.74Mbit/s per User

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

Summary

This feature enables the HSUPA rate per user at MAC layer to reach a maximum of 5.74

Mbit/s. The rate is a peak rate defined in 3GPP specifications.

Benefits

This feature greatly enhances user experience.

Description

Based on the 2 ms TTI and enhanced fast UL schedule, with 2 SF4 and 2 SF2 codes

combination, the UE can reach the peak rate of 5.74 Mbit/s at MAC layer.

Page 98: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 98 of 415

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

The BTS3812E, BTS3812A, and BTS3812AE should be configured with the EULP,

EBBI, EBOI, EULPd board.

The BBU3806 should be configured with the EBBC, EBBCd board; the BBU3806C

should be configured with the EBBM board.

The BBU3900 should be configured with the WBBPb, WBBPd board.

Dependency on UE

UE should have the capability of HSDPA Category 6,7,8,9

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

CN support the uplink speed of 5.74Mbit/s (or more)

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010636 SRB over HSUPA

2.1.18 WRFD-010632 Streaming Traffic Class on HSUPA

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R6.

Summary

This feature enables the streaming service to be mapped onto the E-DCH, thus improving the

utilization of cell resources.

Benefits

This feature enables the system to support higher speed RAB of the PS streaming traffic.

Description

This feature enables the streaming service to be mapped on the E-DCH if a UE is HSUPA

capable. The system sets a switch to enable or disable the feature by which the streaming

Page 99: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 99 of 415

traffic can be mapped on the E-DCH. And a service rate threshold is also need to be set so that

only when the requested service bit rate is higher than the threshold, the request service can be

mapped on the E-DCH. Otherwise, the requested service will be mapped on the DCH. The

service rate threshold can be set by the operators too.

When the streaming service is carried on the E-DCH, the maximum uplink bit rate can reach

up to 384 kbit/s.

The UE with the streaming service on the E-DCH can use another CS RAB or another PS

RAB simultaneously. One HSUPA BE RAB and one HSUPA streaming RAB can be served

on one UE simultaneously if the capability of the UE is allowed.

The GBR of the streaming traffic is used to estimate whether the maximum available resource

for the HSUPA can satisfy the requirement of the streaming service in the admission control.

The HSUPA schedule algorithm also considers the GBR information of the streaming traffic

so that in all HSUPA streaming services that the bit rate is not less than the GBR can be

guaranteed.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

2.1.19 WRFD-010635 HSUPA over Iur

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R6.

Page 100: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 100 of 415

Summary

This feature enables HSUPA services to be carried on the Iur interface and provides

continuous HSUPA services for UEs moving between RNCs.

Benefits

The HSUPA over the Iur provides continuous HSUPA services for mobile users moving

between the RNCs. It enlarges the range of the HSUPA services to the RNCs which have the

Iur connections with a certain RNC.

Description

The HSUPA over the Iur is the scenario that the DRNC cell is in the HSUPA E-DCH active

state. The feature comprises the HSUPA service management over the Iur, the HSUPA

mobility management over the Iur, and so on. The HSUPA capability of the DRNC cell is

configurable.

HSUPA service management over Iur

The HSUPA service management over the Iur includes the HSUPA service setup,

modification, release, and the dynamic channel configuration control (DCCC).

When the UE is in CELL_DCH state and the DRNC cell is in the E-DCH active state or

the UE is in CELL_FACH state and the camps in the DRNC cell, the HSUPA service can

be set up, modified and released over the Iur.

The HSUPA DCCC over the Iur is similar to the WRFD-01061208 HSUPA DCCC and

the difference is that some of the cells are in the DRNC.

HSUPA mobility management over Iur

The HSUPA mobility management over the Iur includes the soft handover, hard

handover, cell update (because of radio link failure), and serving cell change.

The process is similar to the corresponding mobility management described in the

WRFD-01061204 HSUPA Mobility Management and the difference is that the cells

change between the RNCs.

HSUPA static relocation

If the HSUPA service is over the Iur and the radio links are provided only by the target

RNC, the static relocation can be triggered by the Iur congestion.

HSUPA service pre-emption in DRNC

When the new HSUPA service is not admitted to access the network, the CRNC may

trigger the preemption of other HSUPA services with lower priorities. If the CRNC is the

DRNC, it will send the radio link preemption required indication to the SRNC and the

SRNC will release the HSUPA services indicated in the radio link preemption required

indication.

The other functions of this feature are the HSUPA E-DCH power offset adjustment over

the Iur, and so on. The process is similar to that on the Iub interface.

Enhancement

None.

Page 101: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 101 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

The neighbouring RNC must support HSUPA over Iur too.

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

2.1.20 WRFD-010640 Uplink Macro Diversity Intelligent Receiving

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

Summary

Based on the resource occupation, this feature enables the dynamic selection of different

macro diversity combination modes for high-speed non-real-time services (UL) and

low-speed real-time services (SRB and VoIP). This feature can save Iub/Iur transmission

resources and CE resources, affect the preemption policy, and improve the investment return.

Benefits

This feature can greatly save CE resources and transmission resources, improve the resource

utilization, enhance the network performance, and reduce the TCO.

Description

The WCDMA system supports soft handover to control the power of the UE in the overlapped

handover area and provides the MDC gain. The uplink receiving and processing resources and

transmission resources, however, are consumed. With the introduction of HSPA+ in 3GPP R7,

resources are further consumed. This feature can be used to preempt the resources on

non-serving links for serving links to greatly improve the resource utilization and reduce

CAPEX and OPEX.

If some users in the Node B require a higher rate, and Iub transmission resources or CE

demodulation resources are insufficient, the Node B can dynamically preempt the Iub

Page 102: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 102 of 415

transmission resources or CE demodulation resources occupied by non-serving links and then

allocate them to the serving links requiring a higher rate. This feature can increase the total

effective throughput and improve the utilization of Iub transmission resources or CE

demodulation resources.

To ensure normal uplink signaling transmission and power control, the Node B dynamically

preempts the CE demodulation resources and Iub transmission resources on only the data

channels instead of those required by the uplink control channels on non-serving links.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-01061212 HSUPA Iub Flow Control in Case of Iub Congestion

WRFD-010638 Dynamic CE Resource Management

2.1.21 WRFD-010690 TTI Switch for BE Services Based on Coverage

Availability

This feature is available since RAN12.0.

Summary

With this feature, the transmit power and the actual throughput of the HSUPA-based BE

services are monitored. When the transmit power is insufficient, the Transmission Time

Interval (TTI) is switched from 2 ms to 10 ms to reduce the requirements on transmit power.

This ensures continuous network coverage.

Page 103: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 103 of 415

Benefits

Generally, the TTI of the HSUPA-based BE services that require high transmission rate is set

to 2 ms to ensure a high transmission rate in areas with good coverage; however, call drops

are likely to occur at the edge of the cell. With this feature, the call drop rate of these services

is greatly reduced in the areas with weak coverage.

Description

When the TTI is set to 2ms, the peak rate supported by a UE is higher than that when the TTI

is set to 10 ms. Therefore, the TTI of the HSUPA-based BE services that require high

transmission rate is generally set to 2 ms.

When the UE is in an area with weak coverage, the transmit power of the HSUPA-based BE

service with a 2 ms TTI is likely to be insufficient. This will increase the call drop rate. The

reason for this is analyzed as follows: Data is sent in the RLC PDU form. If the size of one

RLC PDU is 336 bits, for example, then the minimum transmission rates in the case of 10 ms

and 2 ms TTIs are 32 kbit/s and 168 kbit/s respectively. Obviously, the minimum transmission

rate in the case of a 2 ms TTI is greater than that in the case of a 10 ms TTI. Accordingly, the

minimum transmit power required in the case of a 2 ms TTI is greater than that in the case of

a 10 ms TTI. As a result, when the TTI is set to 2 ms, call drop is likely to occur due to

insufficient transmit power in the area with weak coverage. In this case, the TTI should be

switched to 10 ms to reduce the required transmission power, thus ensuring the network

coverage.

After this feature is enabled, the RNC monitors the uplink transmit power and the

transmission rate of the HSUPA-based BE services with 2 ms TTI. When the uplink

transmit-power is insufficient, the RNC switches the TTI to 10 ms to reduce the required

transmit power, thus avoiding call drops.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

UE should support HSUPA 2ms TTI

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

Page 104: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 104 of 415

WRFD-010614 HSUPA Phase 2

2.2 HSUPA Performance Improvement

2.2.1 WRFD-010641 HSUPA Adaptive Transmission

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

Summary

With comprehensive considerations of cell uplink power load, CE resources, and limited

uplink coverage, this feature enables the adaptive adjustment of the number of target uplink

retransmissions to improve the throughput per user and cell uplink capacity.

Benefits In a limited uplink coverage scenario, a user’s uplink cell edge throughput can be

increased, in order to enhance user experience. According to simulation results, single

user throughput has been show to increase by 15%-60%.

In a scenario where the cell uplink power load is limited, increasing the retransmission

number can improve cell throughput and cell uplink capacity. Simulation results have

shown an increase of 53% in cell throughput under multi-user scenarios.

Description

HARQ retransmission number is used as the target value of HSUPA uplink outer loop power

control. When UE signal quality is good and uplink transmission power is not limited, a small

retransmission can improve single user throughput. However, when capacity is limited and

cell uplink power becomes a bottleneck, increasing retransmission number can improve cell

throughput. Increasing retransmission number can also boost user cell edge throughput, where

UE uplink power is limited. Therefore there’s a need to realize the adaptive adjustment of

retransmission number.

This feature is only effective in BE traffic. If a user, only has BE traffic (with the exception of

SRB) on E-DCH, then dynamic adjustment of the target retransmission number is allowed.

Adjusting the users target retransmission number to a relatively smaller value is permitted

when the uplink power of all the cells belonging to the serving RLS is smaller than a certain

threshold and the UE uplink power is not limited and/or uplink CE’s are limited. When the

uplink power of any cell belonging to the serving RLS experiences congestion or UE’s uplink

power is limited, then setting the users target retransmission number to a relatively higher

value is permitted, as long as the uplink CE resources are sufficient.

Enhancement

None.

Page 105: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 105 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

BTS3812E/BTS3812AE must be configured with the EBBI/EBOI/EULP/EULPd board

BBU3806 must be configured with EBBC/EBBCd, BBU3806c must be configured with

EBBM

BBU3900 must be configured with WBBPb/WBBPd

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

2.2.2 WRFD-010638 Dynamic CE Resource Management

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

Summary

To improve the efficiency of CE resources, Huawei RAN introduces the dynamic CE resource

management feature. Based on the GBR and actual rate, this feature enables the fast

adjustment of CE allocation. When CE resources are preempted, this feature enables the

proper allocation of CE resources to ensure the preemption fairness.

Benefits

The dynamic CE allocation can call back the CE resources in time when the user’s throughput

decreases, saving the CE resources.

Description

A channel element (CE) is defined as the baseband resources required in the Node B to

provide capacity for 12.2 k AMR voice, including 3.4 k DCCH. The HSUPA shares the CE

resource with the R99 services.

The HSUPA aims at improving the uplink in terms of reducing delays, increasing data rates and increasing the capacity, but it requires a large CE consumption.

Page 106: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 106 of 415

If there is no dynamic CE resource management, the RNC will assign a maximum set of

E-DPDCHs for every user when the radio link is set up or reconfigured, which is the

maximum data rate that the UE supports.

Accordingly the Node B will allocate the CE resources according to the maximum set of

E-DPDCHs, even if the user’s actual traffic is very low. So the utility of the CE resource is

inefficient.

Huawei adopts the dynamic CE resource management to save the CE resources. Each TTI,

Node B can call back the CE resources if the user’s throughput decreases, allocate the CE

resources during the radio link setup or reconfiguration, allocate the CE resources for the

AG(Absolute Grant) ‘UP’ users, and preempt the CE resources for the RG(Relative

Grant )‘UP’ users. The dynamic CE resource management process is described in the

following figure.

For example, one user has the maximum bit rate at1.45 Mbit/s, but the actual throughput is

always changed. With the dynamic CE resource management, the CE consumption is

dynamically changed with the bit rates (blue line), not allocated according to the maximum

set of the E-DPDCHs (red line).

0

500

1000

1500

2000

0 20 40 60 80 100 120 140

Time (s)

Throughput (kbps)

Throughput (kbps)

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

Page 107: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 107 of 415

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

2.2.3 WRFD-01061212 HSUPA Iub Flow Control in Case of Iub Congestion

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R6.

Summary

This feature enables the monitoring of Iub transmission resources to dynamically adjust the

uplink Uu throughput, thus greatly improving the resource utilization.

Benefits

This feature can improve the transport resource usage efficiency greatly and reduce the

throughput fluctuation in the case of the Iub congestion.

Description

The UL Uu throughput is controlled by the scheduler according to the UL load resource and

the Iub bandwidth resource simultaneously. The schedule algorithm estimates the influence on

the load resource and the Iub resource of the change of the serving grant (SG) and decides

whether to assign the absolute grant (AG) or relative grant (RG) to UEs.

The flow control algorithm maintains the Iub available bandwidth resource on the following

principles:

1. The Iub buffer occupancy status:

If the Iub buffer occupancy ratio increases, the available bandwidth may be reduced by a

step.

If the Iub buffer occupancy ratio decreases, the available bandwidth may be increased by

a step.

2. The transmission network congestion status (the Node B detects it according to the

transmission network layer (TNL)) indicator is indicated by the RNC:

If the transmission network is congested, the available bandwidth may be reduced by a

step.

If the transmission network is not-congested, the available bandwidth may be increased

by a step.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

Page 108: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 108 of 415

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

2.2.4 WRFD-010692 HSUPA FDE

Availability

This feature is available from RAN12.0.

Summary

HSUPA frequency domain equalization (HSUPA FDE) is performed to equalize the spectrum

in the frequency domain on the HSUPA E-DPDCH through the UL receiver of the Node B to

suppress the inter-path interference on the E-DPDCH. Thus, the SNR on the E-DPDCH and

the UL capacity of the HSUPA network are increased. The rate of HSUPA services initiated

by UEs of categories 6 and 7 is also increased in the multi-path environment.

Benefits

This feature can suppress UL inter-path interference on HSUPA users and help HSUPA users

get higher peak rate. In the case of multi-path, the higher the rate is, the larger the inter-path

interference and the harder the rate increasing. HSUPA FDE can suppress the inter-path

interference and help the real HSUPA peak rate closer to the theoretic value. HSUPA FDE can

increase the real peak rate up to 20%.

Description

HSUPA is an important feature as defined in 3GPP Release 6 to provide UL high-rate services.

Six categories of UEs that support services at several rates are defined in the 3GPP

specifications. UE category 7, which supports the 16QAM mode and a UL peak rate of up to

11.5 Mbit/s in theory, is introduced in 3GPP Release 7.

Multi-path effect is a major feature of the UMTS. The traditional RAKE receiver combines all

searched paths through multi-path effect to obtain multi-path combination gain. It also

increases the system throughput by improving the SNR of UL services.

The inter-path interference, however, is lower than the gain caused by multi-path combination

because the inter-path interference is insignificant when the UE moves at a low speed.

Page 109: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 109 of 415

Therefore, the traditional RAKE receiver can be used to obtain the gain. In contrast, when the

UE moves at a high speed, the inter-path interference is significant, and inter-path interference

increases with the UL service rate. In a specified channel environment, the peak rate of a user

is limited by the inter-path interference and thus cannot be increased.

HSUPA FDE is performed to equalize the spectrum in the frequency domain on the HSUPA

E-DPDCH through the UL receiver of the Node B. After the FDE, the inter-path interference

on the E-DPDCH is suppressed, and thus the SNR on the E-DPDCH is increased.

When supporting FDE feature, NodeB can not support 4 Rx diversity feature.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

The BTS3812E/BTS3812AE must be configured with the EULPd board.

The DBS3800 must be configured with the EBBCd board.

The 3900 series base stations must be configured with the WBBPd board.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

2.2.5 WRFD-010712 Adaptive Configuration of Traffic Channel Power offset for HSUPA

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0.

Summary

This feature is applicable to the HSUPA 10 ms Best Effort (BE) service. When an HSUPA 10

ms Transmission Timing Interval (TTI) UE is in the small retransmission state, this feature dynamically configures an optimal power offset for the data channel based on the changes in

Page 110: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 110 of 415

uplink load and throughput. This feature helps maintain the power of such UE on the uplink

DPCCH at an optimal level, thereby increasing the capacity of an HSUPA cell with multiple

HSUPA 10 ms TTI UEs.

Benefits

This feature significantly improves the capacity of HSUPA cells in a live network, where the

feature WRFD-010641 HSUPA Adaptive Transmission is unavailable or UEs cannot enter the

large retransmission state due to CE limitation.

This feature significantly increases the HSUPA capacity of cells where a large number of

HSUPA UEs are processing low-speed uplink services. When there are twenty to thirty 10 ms

TTI UEs processing data services in hot spots in busy hours, this feature improves the HSUPA

capacity of the cell by 5% to 20%, without increasing the cell load. This capacity

improvement is indicated by the increase in average cell throughput, in the number of UEs

that can simultaneously perform data transmission in the uplink, or in the decrease in

Received Total Wideband Power (RTWP).

This feature is not applicable to 2 ms TTI UEs. The reason is that 10 ms TTI UEs account for

the majority of HSUPA users in a commercial network, and 2 ms TTI UEs will be changed to

10 ms TTI UEs during heavy cell load.

Description

The offset of E-DPDCH power relative to DPCCH power is one of the major factors that

determine DPCCH power in the uplink. For an HSUPA 10 ms TTI UE in the small

retransmission state, if the data rate is low, a high offset can be configured for the E-DPDCH.

This decreases the power on the DPCCH and reduces the load on the uplink control channel.

After the load is reduced, UEs can transmit more data in the uplink, thereby increasing the

capacity of HSUPA cells. If the data rate is high, a low offset can be configured for the

E-DPDCH. This increases the power on the DPCCH, thereby meeting the power requirements

of multipath searching and channel estimation and ensuring the performance of HSUPA

services.

When the feature WRFD-010641 HSUPA Adaptive Transmission is enabled, the offset of the

E-DPDCH power relative to the DPCCH power is not adjusted. In such a case, the gain of the

HSUPA Adaptive Transmission feature is not affected. Because the feature WRFD-010641

HSUPA Adaptive Transmission enables HSUPA 10 ms TTI UEs to adjust to the large

retransmission state, the capacity of the cell will be greatly increased, but with more CE

consumption.

This feature is independent from the feature WRFD-010641 HSUPA Adaptive Transmission,

but these two features can be enabled together. Using these features together further increases

the uplink capacity of the cell.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

None

Page 111: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 111 of 415

Dependency on NodeB hardware

None

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

Dependency on other NEs

None

2.2.6 WRFD-020136 Anti-Interference Scheduling for HSUPA

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0.

Summary

Sites in a commercial network experience strong and random external uplink interference.

This interference significantly reduces the HSUPA throughput in cells of the site and

negatively affects user experience.

This feature counteracts this interference, thereby ensuring high HSUPA throughput and

improving user experience.

Benefits

This feature ensures high HSUPA throughput in the cells of sites that experience strong uplink

interference from external sources. Under optimal conditions, applying this feature can raise

the HSUPA throughput in a cell with strong external interference to the level of a cell with no

interference.

Description

When a site in a commercial network experiences strong uplink interference from external

sources, the Received Total Wideband Power (RTWP) of cells of the site will increase

significantly. Before the introduction of this feature, the HSUPA scheduling algorithm

performs scheduling based on only the RTWP of the cell. As the interference reduces the load

margin available for use, the HSUPA throughput in cells of the site drops significantly.

With this feature, scheduling is performed on HSUPA UEs based on not only the RTWP of the

cell but also the traffic volume of the R99 and HSUPA UEs in the cell with strong uplink

interference. As long as the traffic volume is lower than the predefined threshold, sufficient

resources can be ensured for the R99 and HSUPA UEs even if the RTWP of the cell increases

to a very high value. This ensures high HSUPA throughput for the cell. The actual throughput

improvement due to this feature depends on the strength of the interference and parameter

configuration.

Enhancement

None

Page 112: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 112 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

None

Dependency on NodeB hardware

The BTS3812E and BTS3812AE should be configured with the HBBI, EBBI, HULP,

EBOI, EULP or EULPd board, the downlink services can only be set up on EBBI, EBOI,

EDLP.

For BBU3806, the downlink services can only be set up on EBBC or EBBCd board; For

BBU3806C, the downlink services can only be set up on EBBM board.

The BBU3900 should be configured with the WBBPb or WBBPd board..

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

Dependency on other NEs

None

2.2.7 WRFD-020137 Dual-Threshold Scheduling with HSUPA Interference Cancellation

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0.

Summary

This feature is applicable to cells enabled with the WRFD-010691 HSUPA UL Interference

Cancellation feature. With this feature, scheduling is based on the RTWP thresholds before

and after HSUPA UL interference cancellation. This feature also raises the RTWP target value

before interference cancellation. This can increase the HSUPA throughput of the cell.

Benefits

This feature further increases the HSUPA throughput of cells enabled with the HSUPA UL

Interference Cancellation feature by around 5%-15%.

Description

In a cell enabled with the HSUPA UL Interference Cancellation feature, the RTWP after the

interference cancellation is always lower than that before the interference cancellation.

This feature dynamically raises the RTWP target value of the cell before interference

cancellation while keeping the RTWP after interference cancellation lower than or equal to

the RTWP target value of the cell with the feature not enabled. In this manner, the HSUPA

throughput of the cell can be increased without compromising coverage or network KPIs such

as call completion rate and call drop rate.

Page 113: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 113 of 415

To minimize the impact on neighboring cells, this feature adopts a predefined upper threshold

for the increased RTWP target value before interference cancellation is performed.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

None

Dependency on NodeB hardware

The BTS3812E/AE must be configured with EULPd baord, and all users of the cell

should be estabilished in one EULPd board.

The DBS3800 must be configured with the EBBCd board.

The 3900 series base stations must be configured with the WBBPd board in the UL

resource pool which support IC feature, and slot 2 or 3 needs to be configured with at

least one WBBPd board.

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

WRFD-010691 HSUPA UL Interference Cancellation

Dependency on other NEs

HSUPA FDE

2.2.8 WRFD-010634 60 HSUPA Users per Cell

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

Summary

This feature enables a single HSUPA cell to simultaneously support 60 HSUPA users. If the

number of HSUPA users exceeds 60, the DCH is attempted for service provisioning.

Benefits

Compared with the HSUPA introduction package, more HSUPA users are available in one

cell.

Description

Up to 60 HSUPA users can be admitted to a HSUPA capable cell.

Page 114: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 114 of 415

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

WRFD-010614 HSUPA phase 2

2.2.9 WRFD-010210 Control Channel Parallel Interference Cancellation (CCPIC)

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

Summary

The self interference in the WCDMA system greatly affects its capacity and coverage. This

feature can effectively reduce UL interference and improve network performance.

Benefits

It can improve capacity so that the CAPEX is reduced.

Description

The control channels are always on and they are a substantial source of interference especially

with lower data rate and lower activity services.

CCPIC is a simplified and practical application of MUD technology for base station receivers.

It cancels the uplink control channel signal, decreases uplink interference to improve the

performance.

Page 115: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 115 of 415

The DPCCH demodulation is performed first. According to all valid paths’ time delay and

fading information of received users, the received DPCCH signal can be reconstructed. All

users’ data channels such as DPDCH, E-DPCCH, and E-DPDCH can be demodulated after

the received DPCCH signal is subtracted from baseband signal.

In the case of the urban macro cell, TU3 channel, and AMR12.2k user with a 50% load, the

CCPIC will bring 11% capacity improvement; with a 75% load, the capacity improvement is

18%.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

The CCPIC depends on the EBBC board or EBBI, EBOI, EULP, EBBM, EBBCd,

EULPd.

The BBU3900 needs to configure WBBPb or WBBPd board.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

2.2.10 WRFD-140202 Control Channel Parallel Interference Cancellation (Phase 2)

Availability

This feature is available from RAN14.0.

Summary

This feature improves the efficiency of Control Channel Parallel Interference Cancellation

(CCPIC) by using the advanced regeneration cancellation algorithm. In addition, the benefits

of CCPIC are shared across baseband boards.

Page 116: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 116 of 415

Benefits

This feature significantly increases the uplink system capacity. When the DPCCH uses a large

proportion of received total wideband power (RTWP) in a cell, this feature increases system

capacity by up to 20%. This gain is possible when, for example, the uplink throughput is not

high but there are a large number of UEs in the cell.

Description

This feature introduces the advanced regeneration cancellation algorithm, which makes

DPCCH regeneration more accurate and improves CCPIC efficiency as a result.

In addition, this feature allows the benefits of CCPIC to be shared across baseband boards.

When multiple baseband boards form a resource pool, CCPIC gain for UEs carried on one

board benefits UEs carried on other boards. Similarly, UEs carried on one board benefit from

the CCPIC gain of UEs carried on another board.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

None

Dependency on NodeB

Only 3900 series base stations support this feature.

At least one WBBPd1, WBBPd2, WBBPd3, WBBPf1, WBBPf12, WBBPf3, or WBBPf4

must be configured.

Dependency on the UE

None

Dependency on other NEs

None

Dependency on the CN

None

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-010210 Control Channel Parallel Interference Cancellation (CCPIC)

2.2.11 WRFD-010691 HSUPA UL Interference Cancellation

Availability

This feature is available from RAN12.0.

Page 117: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 117 of 415

Summary

HSUPA UL interference cancellation (IC) is performed to offset the interference caused by the

UL high rate E-DPDCH data of other users, thus improving the demodulation signal-to-noise

ratio (SNR) and increasing the UL capacity of the UMTS system.

Benefits

The IC technology significantly decreases the UL interference and improves the UL capacity

of the cell. In some scenarios, the gain of the IC technology is significant. For example, if in a

cell there is a small number of HSUPA users with high throughput and a large number of

HSUPA users with low throughput at the same time, IC technology allows cancelling the high

interference generated by high rate HSUPA users. If IC technology isn’t available, the cell

might suffer from reduced capacity of low rate users, such as VoIP users, or/and decreased

rate of high rate services.

Description

HSUPA is an important feature as defined in 3GPP Release 6 to provide UL high-rate services.

Six categories of UEs that support services at several rates are defined in the 3GPP

specifications. The maximum number of E-DCH codes varies depending on the UE’s category.

That is, UEs support different peak rates, even up to 5.74 Mbit/s. UE category 7, which

supports the 16QAM mode and an UL peak rate of up to 11.5 Mbit/s in theory, is introduced

in 3GPP Release 7.

Based on the wideband code division multiple access technology, the UMTS is a

self-interfering system. With the increase of the HSUPA rate, the UL interference becomes

more and more heavy. The UL interference is a major factor affecting the UL capacity of the

UMTS.

The IC technology supports different types of HSUPA users, including UEs of categories 1 to

7. The principle of the IC technology is as follows: The UMTS is a self-interfering system.

The interference to a user comes mainly from signals of other users and from the background

noise in the cell. Without the IC technology, signal demodulation is performed in high

interference. Thus, the capacity of the cell is highly reduced. With the IC technology, the

signals over E-DPDCH from IC-enabled users are analyzed and reconstructed. Then, the

interference from the reconstructed signals is subtracted from the total interference. As a

result, the total interference of the cell is reduced and the system capacity increases.

The IC feature of Huawei Node B has the following benefits:

IC can be performed to the HSUPA services at 2 ms TTI and 10 ms TTI simultaneously.

The IC feature does not consume extra CE resources.

The IC gain can be shared by all the UEs in a cell, including the IC-enabled UEs and

IC-disabled UEs.

During HSUPA scheduling, the actual load of the cell and the load of the cell after

interference cancellation can be managed at the same time. While the stable operation of the

system is ensured, the system capacity can be maximized.

In addition, Huawei Node B sets up an IC resource pool, which enables IC result to be shared

between boards. The IC resource pool has the following functions:

IC result is shared between IC-capable boards. That is, when multiple IC-capable boards exist

in a Node B, these boards can share the signals after interference cancellation. Therefore, each

Page 118: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 118 of 415

UE finally is demodulated from the signals whose interferences of E-DPDCHs from other

users are cancelled, thus maximizing the system capacity.

IC result can be shared by IC-incapable boards. That is, when the IC-capable boards and

IC-incapable boards coexist in a Node B, the IC-capable boards transmit signals after

interference cancellation to the IC-incapable boards. Thus, UEs carried by IC-incapable

boards are also demodulated from signals whose interference is reduced rather than original

signals. In this way, the demodulation performance of IC-incapable boards is improved and

thus the IC gain maximized..

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

The BTS3812E or BTS3812AE must be configured with the EULPd board, the downlink

service cannot be estabilished on HBBI/HDLP/NDLP, and the IC effect cannot be shared

between BB boards.

The DBS3800 must be configured with the EBBCd board and the IC effect can be shared

between the BB boards.

The 3900 series base stations must be configured with the WBBPd board, and only if slot

2 or 3 is configured with at least one WBBPd board, IC effect can be shared between the

BB boards.

WBBPd is needed for 3900 series NodeB to support HSUPA UL Interference

Cancellation. If the inter-board sharing IC need to be supported, the WBBPd should be

configured in the UL resource pool which used for inter-board sharing IC, and at least 1

WBBPd should be configured in slot 2 or 3.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

Page 119: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 119 of 415

2.2.12 WRFD-010636 SRB over HSUPA

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R6.

Summary

This feature enables UL SRBs to be carried over HSUPA. This feature can obtain a lower call

delay and save transmission resources.

Benefits

This feature provides higher signaling rate and reduces the call process delay. Since the SRB

is carried on the HSUPA, the transmission resource can be saved, compared with that is

carried on the DCH.

Description

The signaling over the SRB is delay sensitive and irregular. Compared with the DCH, it is

more appropriate to set up the SRB over the HSUPA. The SRB over the HSUPA can be

applied during the RRC connection setup or other procedures such as the mobility

management.

If the SRB is set up over the DCH, it can be reconfigured to be mapped on the HSUPA in

some cases such as the target cell of the handover supports the HSUPA while the source cell

does not. Inversely, the SRB mapping on the HSUPA can also be reconfigured to be mapped

on the DCH if the target cell of the handover does not support the HSUPA.

The SRB over the HSUPA is configurable. The operator can enable/disable the SRB over

HSUPA function.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

The 38XX series Node B supports this feature, and the EBBI, EBOI, EULP, EULPd,

EBBC, EBBCd or EBBM is required.

The 3900 series Node B supports this feature, and the WBBPb or WBBPd is required.

Dependency on UE

NA

Page 120: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 120 of 415

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

2.3 HSDPA Prime Service

2.3.1 WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R5.

Summary

High Speed Downlink Packet Access (HSDPA) is one of the important features defined in

3GPP specifications. HSDPA can greatly increase the peak rate per user, shorten the round trip

delay, and improve the system capacity. This feature package provides the basic functions of

HSDPA to meet the requirements for test or trial operations of HSDPA services.

Benefits

HSDPA improves the performance of the UMTS network in the following aspects:

Providing high rate throughput

Shorter round trip time

Higher system capacity

Description

High Speed Downlink Packet Access (HSDPA) is an important feature of 3GPP Release 5.

The maximum downlink throughput is achieved by sharing CE resources, power resources,

and code resources with new physical channels and downlink shared transport channel for

HSDPA. The physical channels are HS-SCCH, HS-PDSCH, and HS-DPCCH, and the

transport channel is HS-DSCH. HD-PDSCH (SF = 16) will utilize the remaining TX power

and codes in a cell, which enables the resource to be dynamically shared among users.

Some key functions are also used in HSDPA for maximizing resource utilization, including 2

ms TTI, hybrid ARQ with soft combining (HARQ), Adaptive Modulation and Coding (AMC),

and fast scheduling algorithm.

The application of 2 ms TTI greatly reduces the round trip time. At the same time, some

functions are moved down to the Node B that also contributes to reducing the round trip time.

Page 121: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 121 of 415

When compared with RLC re-transmission, HARQ provides a more highly efficient

re-transmission mechanism. The UE can request for retransmission of only erroneously

received data immediately and combine the retransmission data with original transmission

data through soft combining.

AMC enables the system to decide the Transport Block (TB) size and the modulation mode

according to estimated channel condition indicated by the UE. When the UE is in favorable

radio environment, the transmission can adopt 16 QAM modulation mode and large transport

blocks to increase the capacity and data rate.

The fast scheduling algorithm includes Max C/I, Round Robin, Proportional Fair (PF), and

Enhanced Proportional Fair (EPF). EPF is based on the PF algorithm which can provide users

with Guaranteed Bit Rate service for I/B services.

HSDPA is mainly used for packet services and can bear the interactive, background, and

streaming services. The HSDPA traffic can use a dedicated carrier or a shared carrier with

R99. The system should be capable of handling both cases.

The system should consider the mobility management of the HSDPA services, such as the

intra-RNC handover, inter-RNC handover, and soft handover for the DCH.

Enhancement

In RAN5.1, RAN6.0, and RAN10.0, HSDPA Introduction Package is enhanced. For details,

see the enhancements of the sub-features in the HSDPA Introduction Package.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NBBI and NDLP do not support this feature.

Dependency on UE

UE should have the HSDPA capability.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

Page 122: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 122 of 415

2.3.2 WRFD-01061017 QPSK Modulation

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.0.

Summary

This feature is related to QPSK modulation. QPSK modulation is a basic downlink data

modulation function that is used after HSDPA is introduced.

Benefits

This feature provides higher service bit rate to enhance the user experience.

Description

Quaternary Phase Shift Keying (QPSK)

The HS-PDSCH is used to carry the HS-DSCH data. HS-PDSCH can use QPSK or 16QAM

modulation symbols.

When the UE is in the unfavorable radio environment, the transmission can adopt the low

order QPSK modulation mode and small transport blocks to ensure communication quality.

When the UE is in the favorable radio environment, the transmission can adopt the high order

16QAM modulation mode and large transport blocks to reach a high peak rate.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

Page 123: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 123 of 415

2.3.3 WRFD-01061001 15 Codes per Cell

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.0.

Summary

This feature provides code resources occupied by Huawei HSDPA services. The HS-PDSCHs

can use up to 15 codes in a cell.

Benefits

HSDPA with 15 codes makes it possible to introduce higher bit rate service from day one and

improve system capacity.

Description

High Speed Downlink Packet Access (HSDPA) is an important feature of 3GPP Release 5,

which provides high speed downlink services. A new downlink shared transport channel,

HS-DSCH, is introduced for carrying services. The transport channel HS-DSCH is mapped on

one or several High-Speed Physical Downlink Shared Channels (HS-PDSCHs) which are

simultaneously received by the UE. In the 3GPP standard, there are up to 15 HS-PDSCHs per

cell with the spreading factor fixed to 16. The number of HS-PDSCHs per Node B is

configurable and depending on the license, the Node B can dynamically share codes license to

HS-PDSCH between cells in Node B.

The HS-PDSCHs can use up to 15 codes in one cell by which the supported peak rate of air

interface can reach up to 14.4 Mbit/s. The system capacity is improved by supporting 15

codes.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

Page 124: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 124 of 415

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

2.3.4 WRFD-01061018 Time and HS-PDSCH Codes Multiplex

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.0.

Summary

This feature enables the allocation of different codes in the same TTI to different users or the

time division multiplexing of the same code in different TTIs for different users to provide the

utilization of code resources and the system throughput.

Benefits

This feature improves the efficiency and performance of HSDPA service.

Description

The parallel data transmission of multiple users over HS-DSCH requires more HS-SCCH

codes and HS-PDSCH codes within a single TTI. Code multiplexing is adopted and is found

useful when the Node B has more HS-PDSCH codes for allocation than those supported by

the UE. For instance, the UE supports 5 codes and the Node B has 10 codes available in a

single TTI. The code multiplexing can increase the resource utilization and system

throughput.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

Page 125: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 125 of 415

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

2.3.5 WRFD-01061009 HSDPA H-ARQ & Scheduling (MAX C/I, RR and PF)

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.0.

Summary

This feature is related to hybrid automatic repeat request (HARQ) and HSDPA scheduling

algorithms. Huawei provides multiple HSDPA scheduling algorithms such as Max C/I, RR,

PF, and EPF.

Benefits

This feature provides the flexibility for the operator to select the scheduling algorithm, after

considering the system capacity and fairness among the users.

Description

HARQ

For the HSDPA services at the physical layer, if errors occur in decoding, the HARQ reserves

the data before the decoding and combines it with the retransmitted data.

Compared with R99, HARQ retransmission is faster and more efficient than RLC

retransmission. In this sense, the HARQ can be called a new technology and a combination of

the Forward Error Correction (FEC) and ARQ. HARQ has a higher downlink performance

gain.

At every TTI (2 ms), the scheduling algorithm enables the system to decide the UEs for data

transmission. This feature provides different HSDPA schedule algorithms, considering the

tradeoff between system capacity and fairness among the users.

Four scheduling algorithms are provided and the operator decides which algorithm to choose.

Max C/I

RR (round Robin)

PF (proportional fair)

During the scheduling procedure, the several aspects to be considered include CQI, user

priority, channel quality, service bit rate, and re-transmission. All scheduling algorithms

support the retransmission priority rule. If a UE requires retransmission at a certain

scheduling time, the UE is scheduled at a higher priority.

In addition, two factors may affect the accuracy of the CQI reported by the UE:

Page 126: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 126 of 415

Channel environment of the UE

Measurement error of a specific UE

If the CQI reported by the UE does not reflect the actual radio conditions, this will lead to the

decrease of HS-DSCH transmission efficiency, because both scheduling and TFRC selection

are performed on the basis of the reported CQI.

To avoid the negative impact on the system caused by inaccurate CQI reports, the CQI

adjustment algorithm can revise the reported CQI according to the ACK or NACK of initial

transmission and the initial BLER target. The adjusted CQI is used for MAC-hs scheduling

and TFRC selection.

Enhancement

In RAN10.0, the functionality of compressed mode tracing during scheduling is supported.

That is, if a TTI is overlapped with a UE’s compression mode gap, this UE should not be

scheduled in this TTI.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

2.3.6 WRFD-01061005 HSDPA Static Code Allocation and RNC-Controlled Dynamic Code Allocation

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.0.

Page 127: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 127 of 415

Summary

This feature is related to HSDPA static code allocation and RNC-controlled dynamic code

allocation. When R99 and HSDPA services co-exist, this feature enables full use of

channelized code resources to improve the efficiency and system capacity.

Benefits

The HSPDA static code allocation function helps to improve the system throughput of

HSDPA service and achieve high code utilization. R99 service and HSDPA service can

co-exist with less conflict of resources.

Description

Before the Node B starts to transmit data on the HS-DSCH, the RNC shall allocate the

channelization code for HS-SCCH with an SF of 128 and for HS-PDSCH with an SF of 16.

Generally, the RNC allocates as many HS-PDSCH codes to the Node B as possible to

improve the system capacity and spectral efficiency. On the other hand, the channelization

codes reserved for HS-PDSCH transmission cannot be simultaneously used for transmission

of the R99 channel, and hence the allocation of many HS-PDSCH codes might eventually

result in blocking of R99 users. Therefore, it is important for the RNC and Node B to properly

utilize the channelization code resources to improve both efficiency and system capacity.

There are two strategies for allocating HS-PDSCH codes: static allocation and dynamic

allocation. The two strategies have different effects on the HSDPA service.

There defined two types of code strategy for HS-PDSCH code allocation, which can take

different effects on the HSDPA service, static allocation, and dynamic allocation.

Static allocation is generally used at the initial HSDPA deployment stage because there are

less HSDPA users and more R99 users at this stage. The RNC reserves some codes for the

HS-PDSCH and the DPCH while other common channels use the rest codes. The number of

reserved codes for the HS-PDSCH is configurable.

Code reserved for

common channel and

HS-SCCH Codes reserved for

HS-PDSCH

SF=16

Codes available

for DPCH

With the increasing demand for the HSDPA service, dynamic HS-PDSCH code allocation is

needed to increase code utilization efficiency. According to the code allocation controller, the

code allocation is of two types, namely the RNC-controlled dynamic HS-PDSCH code

allocation and the Node B-controlled dynamic HS-PDSCH code allocation.

In the RNC-controlled dynamic HS-PDSCH code allocation, the RNC determines the

maximum number and minimum number of HS-PDSCH codes that Node B can use and then

informs the Node B about the code information through the Physical Shared Channel

Reconfigure Request signaling message. The code resources between the maximum number

of codes and the minimum number of codes are shared codes. If the shared codes are available

for HSDPA, the RNC increases the minimum number of HS-PDSCH codes and informs the

Node B about this information. The RNC is in charge of the code management.

Page 128: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 128 of 415

Shared codes

Max numberof codes

Min numberof codes

SF=16

Codes available for DPCH Codes reserved for HS- PDSCH

Code reserved for

common channel and

HS-SCCH

Enhancement

In RAN5.1, the RNC-controlled dynamic HS-PDSCH code allocation is introduced.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

2.3.7 WRFD-01061004 HSDPA Power Control

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.0.

Summary

This feature enables the operator to properly configure the power control mode of the

HS-SCCH, thus improving the power efficiency and obtaining higher system capacity and

user experience.

Page 129: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 129 of 415

Benefits

This feature enables the system to provide reliable reception quality for the HS-SCCH. It can

increase system capacity and reduce the Node B power output for the HS-SCCH, thus raising

the total transmission power utilization.

Description

When the HSDPA service is introduced, the total transmit DL power resource per cell is

divided into three parts, namely, common channel power, DPCH power, and HSDPA physical

channel power (HS-PDSCH and HS-SCCH).

In order to achieve high HSDPA performance, the power resource, except for those reserved

for common channel, is dynamically allocated between DPCH and HSDPA physical channel.

In the case of the R99 service, the power of DPCH is adjusted through inner and outer loop

power control. The power of HSDPA channel is allocated and adjusted dynamically among

users through the Node B scheduling algorithm.

With dynamical power allocation, the Node B estimates the power available for the entire

HSDPA channel per TTI by using the following formula:

P(hs) = P(total) - P(margin) - P(non-hsdpa).

The P(total) is the maximum downlink transmission power for the cell that is configured in

the RNC. The P(non-hsdpa) is the total transmitted carrier power of all codes not used for

HS-PDSCH and HS-SCCH. P(margin) is a configurable value which is used for the power

increase caused by R99 power control at every 2 ms TTI.

The Node B then adjusts the power between HS-SCCH and HS-PDSCH. Normally, there are

two types of power control methods for the HS-SCCH:

Fixed transmitting power of the HS-SCCH

Based on CQI report

In the Node B, the fixed transmit power of the HS-SCCH can be configured by the operator.

For the power control based on CQI report, the HS-SCCH transmit power is adjusted on the

basis of the CQI report received from the user.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

Page 130: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 130 of 415

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

2.3.8 WRFD-01061003 HSDPA Admission Control

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.0.

Summary

This feature implements admission control over HSDPA users in the aspects such as the

number of HSDPA users, remaining power resources, Iub interface resources, and service rate

thresholds. This feature can ensure QoS of the existing HSDPA users while fully utilizing the

resources.

Benefits

This feature enables HSDPA service to properly utilize system resources and enable HSDPA

service and R99 service to exist in the same cell. The system resource can be reserved in

terms of the Iub transport resource, power resources, and user number resources to provide

high bit rate service for users.

Description

HSDPA service admission control enables HSDPA service to access the network with other

R99 services by using the remaining power resource as well as other resources. It can utilize

the system resources greatly.

In the HSDPA admission control procedure, the maximum number of HSDPA users per Node

B and per cell is dependent on the configuration.

If the downlink carrier power is dynamically allocated between R99 and HSDPA channels, the

admission control will involve not only the limitation of total HSDPA user number for best

effort services, but also the sum of downlink code transmission power for both DPCH and

HS-PDSCH carrying streaming service.

Iub interface resources check is performed during the admission control to allow HSDPA

service and other R99 services to be admitted under a certain ensured QoS.

During the admission control, the RNC will decide whether to map the service onto the

HS-DSCH by setting service rate thresholds in the RNC. The thresholds include a DL

streaming service HSDPA threshold and a DL BE service HSDPA threshold. The call can be

mapped on HSDPA only when the requested bit rate of the incoming call is greater than the

threshold.

Page 131: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 131 of 415

Enhancement

In RAN5.1, GBR for BE (interactive/background) over HSPA can be configured, so the

minimum throughput for BE over HSPA should be guaranteed. GBR is used to estimate

whether the maximum available power for HSDPA can satisfy the requirement of

interactive/background service in RAN5.1.

In RAN5.1, the power available for HSDPA GBR services shall be guaranteed during the

admission control. This part of the power shall not be pre-empted by R99 services, although

the power is shared between R99 and HSDPA.

In RAN6.0, queuing and pre-emption are considered for HSDPA if admission control fails.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

2.3.9 WRFD-01061020 Improvement of User Experience in Low Traffic Service

Availability

This feature is available from RAN12.0.

Summary

This feature is implemented in the following procedure: Node B identifies the characteristics

of services carried on the HSPA channel to find the low traffic services, such as gaming

service and chat service (MSN messenger for example), which have a small number of data to

transmit each time. Then, improve the capability of services to obtain resources on the basis

of the scheduling and flow control principles of HSPA, thus improving the low traffic service

delay experience.

Page 132: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 132 of 415

Benefits

UEs can obtain good delay experience when they use the services with burst low traffic.

Description

The HSPA provides higher bandwidth and supports more services.

However, UMTS network is a radio network whose radio resources are shared by all the UEs

in a cell. When the traffic volume in a cell is high, the QoS of low traffic services is easily

impacted by other services, such as ping, gaming and chating. This feature identifies a burst

service based on the traffic features, and then reallocates much higher bandwidth to it. Thus, a

larger bandwidth is available for the data transmission of the low traffic service, and the UE

obtains better service delay experience.

The priority of the UE can be considered in the feature to provide differentiated services to

low traffic services.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

Only BSC6900 support this feature.

Dependency on Node B

The BTS3812E, BTS3812A, and BTS3812AE should be configured with the EULP,

EBBI, EBOI or EULPd board.

The BBU3806 should be configured with the EBBC or EBBCd board; the BBU3806C

should be configured with the EBBM board.

The BBU3900 should be configured with the WBBPb or WBBPd board.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package or

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

Page 133: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 133 of 415

2.3.10 WRFD-01061019 HSDPA Dynamic Power Allocation

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.0.

Summary

This feature enables R99 and HSDPA services to share the cell power. This feature can ensure

the requirements of R99 users and make HSDPA users obtain a higher throughput, thus

greatly improving the power efficiency.

Benefits

This feature enables HSDPA service to properly utilize system resources and enable HSDPA

service and R99 service to exist in the same cell. The system resource can be reserved in

terms of the Iub transport resource, power resources, and user number resources to provide

high bit rate service for users.

Description

The cell total transmit power is the constant resource. The DL power consists of the following

three parts:

Power of the HSDPA DL physical channel (HS-SCCH and HS-PDSCH)

Common channel power

DPCH power

Among the three parts, the second is reserved and the first is allocated by the Node B.

Except those reserved for the common channels, the remaining power resources of the cell are

allocated dynamically between the DPCH and the HSDPA DL physical channels. The DPCH

assumes higher priority with regard to using the remaining power resources.

Flexible scheme

Power for CCH

Power for DPCH

Power for HSDPA

F

u

l

l

u

s

a

g

e

o

f

p

o

w

e

r

Total Power

Time

Page 134: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 134 of 415

As shown in the figure above, the Node B detects the R99 power load every 2 ms to

determine the available power for HSDPA. In this way, the cell load is more stable.

To obtain the available power for HSDPA, a power margin must be set aside to handle the

power increase caused by R99 power control every 2 ms.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

2.3.11 WRFD-01061010 HSDPA Flow Control

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.0.

Summary

This feature enables the resource information interaction between the RNC and Node B to

ensure that the data to be transmitted by the UE matches the scheduled one. In addition, this

feature can minimize the buffer size and buffer time of the Node B to avoid data loss probably

caused by overtime data buffering.

Benefits

This feature can prevent packet loss and maximize the utilization of power and code resources.

It enables the service scheduling and re-transmission functions in the Node B and reduces the

data transmission latency.

Page 135: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 135 of 415

Description

HSDPA flow control ensures that the Node B queue has enough data to be transmitted for a

UE when this UE is scheduled. At the same time, flow control feature can minimize the buffer

size and buffer time in the Node B in order to avoid data loss probably caused by overtime

data buffering.

The RNC sends CAPACITY REQUEST control frame to the Node B through the Iub

interface. The Node B will monitor the buffer status and measure the throughput when the UE

is scheduled. Meanwhile, the Node B considers the Iub interface throughput as well as the Iub

bandwidth. A CAPACITY ALLOCATION message will be sent to the RNC after the Node B

decides how much data to send.

The Node B can also initiate the update of capacity allocation towards the RNC based on the

buffer size of the queue and the available bandwidth on the Iub interface.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

2.3.12 WRFD-01061006 HSDPA Mobility Management

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.0.

Page 136: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 136 of 415

Summary

This feature is related to HSDPA mobility management in different scenarios. This feature

ensures that the HSDPA services are continuous.

Benefits

This feature reduces the service disruption of the UE in movement when performing the

HSDPA service, thus enhancing user experience. In addition, this feature ensures that the

services between R99 and HSDPA cells are continuous.

Description

The HSDPA mobility management function enables an HSDPA user to change the cell to an

R99 cell or another HSDPA cell when the HSDPA user is in movement. The mobility feature

also enables an HSDPA user to change the servicing cell with less service interruption.

The difference in mobility handling is that the HS-DSCH cannot perform soft handover

compared with the DCH. In addition, there is only one serving HSDPA cell or HSDPA

connection for the HSDPA user. The HSDPA cell change procedure is used for the HSDPA

user mobility solution. The associated DCH can undergo soft handover and maintain the

Active Set as described in Release 99.

The similarity in mobility handling is that both HS-DSCH and DCH handovers are based on

the measurement report of the UE and controlled by the network. If the UE has both the

HSDPA and the DPCH connections, the measurement and the handover decision are made

separately.

Handover from HSDPA Cell to R99 Cell

When the UE is moving from an HSDPA cell to a R99 cell (intra-frequency) and event

1B, 1C or 1D is triggered, the HSDPA connection between UE and HSDPA cell will be

changed to the DCH connection between UE and R99 cell through DCH soft handover

and HS-DSCH radio link reconfiguration. The HSDPA cell is no longer the best cell in

the Active Set and the target cell does not support HSDPA. Therefore, the current

HS-DSCH cell will be replaced or removed from the Active Set and the service will be

changed to the DCH instead of the HS-DSCH for service continuity.

If the neighboring cell of HSDPA cell is an inter-frequency cell and does not support

HSDPA, a hard handover will be performed. The HSDPA handover decision is based on

the measurement report of the pilot channels of neighboring cells.

Handover from R99 Cell to HSDPA Cell

When an HSDPA capable UE with interactive/background/streaming service accesses the

R99 cell, only the DCH is used to carry these services. And when the UE is moving from

R99 cell to HSDPA cell (intra-frequency or inter-frequency), the system can change the

service to HS-DSCH channel.

For intra-frequency cell, the DPCH connection between UE and HSDPA cell will be set

up first due to event 1A. When the HSDPA cell becomes the best cell and event 1D is

triggered, the service will be switched from the DPCH to the HS-PDSCH of the HSDPA

cell carrying the PS service.

For inter-frequency cell, when the UE moves, an inter-frequency handover is triggered if

the quality of the signals of HSDPA cell improves. The UE changes from R99 cell to

HSDPA cell and the PS service will be switched from the DPCH to the HS-PDSCH.

Handover Among HSDPA Cells

Page 137: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 137 of 415

For intra-frequency cell, cell change takes place when the HSDPA connection is moved

from one HSDPA cell to another. The source HSDPA cell is removed from the Active Set

trigged by event 1D and target HSDPA cell is added to the Active Set as a best cell.

For inter-frequency cell, an inter-frequency handover between HSDPA cells is triggered.

The service will be changed to the HS-DSCH of the target cell. The hard handover

depends on the UE measurement.

Handover from HSDPA Cell to 2G cell

The handover from HSDPA cell to 2G cell is triggered by normal inter-RAT handover.

For details, refer to the features of inter-RAT handover. Whether to downgrade the

HSDPA service to the R99 service before handover can be configured by the operator.

Inter RNC mobility for HSDPA

For cell change between RNCs, the Directed Signaling Connection Re-establishment

(DSCR) and SRNC relocation procedure will be used. The DSCR is used for the UE

moving between RNCs without the Iur interface. The procedure is trigged by the UE

which sends the RRC CONNECTION SETUP REQUEST message in the DRNC. At this

time, the UE moves to the cell of the DRNC and no handover or relocation occurs.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

2.3.13 WRFD-01061014 HSDPA Transport Resource Management

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.0

Page 138: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 138 of 415

Summary

This feature enables different HSDPA services to be mapped to different paths for classified

management, thus optimizing the utilization of Iub transmission resources for the HSDPA

services.

Benefits

Differentiated service is implemented on different paths and thus the QoS and network

performance are optimized. Improve the transport resource utilization and save OPEX for Iub

transmission.

Description

With the introduction of the HSDPA feature, the throughput over the Iub interface may be

increased and varied greatly. This feature is used to optimize the usage of Iub transport

resources for the HSDPA services. The features concerned are as follows:

Differentiated services mapping

Transport resource load control

I. Differentiated services mapping

The CS conversational, PS conversational, PS streaming and best effort services can be set up

on HSDPA. Different services have different QoS requirements, in RAN11.0 HSDPA services

are considered unified with common channel and R99 services in Transmission Resource

Mapping. The details of unified Transmission Resource Mapping belongs to optional feature

WRFD-050424 Traffic Priority Mapping onto Transmission Resources. By using this feature,

different services are carried on corresponding paths and then the differentiated service is

implemented.

II. Transmission resource load control

Transmission resource load control includes admission control and congestion control.

For the admission control, the Guaranteed Bit Rate (GBR) will be considered in the HSDPA

service admission procedure. The GBR belongs to the optional feature WRFD-01061003

HSDPA Admission Control.

For the congestion control, the load reshuffling strategies will be applied to inter-RAT

handover which belongs to the optional feature WRFD-020306 Inter-RAT Handover Based on

Load.

Enhancement

In RAN6.1, each traffic class mapped onto transmission resource can be configured

separately.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

Page 139: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 139 of 415

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

Optional feature WRFD-050402 IP Transmission (Iub interface), WRFD-050403 Hybrid IP

Transmission, and WRFD-050404 ATM/IP Dual Stack Node B should be required when the

transmission resource management feature applied for IP transmission resources in those

scenarios.

2.3.14 WRFD-01061008 Interactive and Background Traffic Class on HSDPA

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.0.

Summary

This feature enables interactive and background services to be mapped to the HS-DSCH to

obtain a higher service rate and enhance user experience.

Benefits

This feature enables the system to support a higher speed RAB of PS background and

interactive service.

Description

This feature enables the best effort service (interactive and background) to be mapped onto

the HS-DSCH as long as the UE supports HSDPA. The system can set the service rate

threshold and only when the requested service bit rate is higher than the threshold, the request

service can be mapped onto the HS-DSCH. Otherwise, the requested service will be mapped

onto the DCH. The service rate threshold can be configured by the operator. When the best

effort service is carried on the HS-DSCH, the maximum downlink bit rate can be up to 1.8

Mbit/s (MAC layer).

When a UE is performing interactive or background service, it can use another CS RAB or

another PS RAB. If allowed, the UE can use two HSDPA BE RABs simultaneously.

Page 140: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 140 of 415

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

2.3.15 WRFD-01061002 HSDPA UE Category 1 to 28

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.0.

Summary

This feature can provide suitable HSDPA services for the UEs of category 1 to category 28.

Benefits

This feature supports HSDPA services for 28 categories of UE so as to provide high bit rate

service for different categories of UEs. The maximum bit rate that can be achieved by the UE

depends on the UE specification.

Description

High Speed Downlink Packet Access (HSDPA) is an important feature of 3GPP Release 5

which can provide high speed service for the downlink. In order to provide multiple bit rate

services, 28 UE categories are defined in 3GPP. Different UE categories can support different

maximum codes for the HS-DSCH, which means that different maximum bit rates can be

achieved.

Page 141: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 141 of 415

HS-DSCH Category

Maximum Number of HS-DSCH Codes Received

Minimum Inter-TTI Interval

Maximum Number of Bits

Maximum Bit Rate

(Mbit/s)

Category 1 5 3 7,298 3.649

Category 2 5 3 7,298 3.649

Category 3 5 2 7,298 3.649

Category 4 5 2 7,298 3.649

Category 5 5 1 7,298 3.649

Category 6 5 1 7,298 3.649

Category 7 10 1 14,411 7.2055

Category 8 10 1 14,411 7.2055

Category 9 15 1 20,251 10.1255

Category 10 15 1 27,952 13.976

Category 11 5 2 3,630 1.815

Category 12 5 1 3,630 1.815

Category 13 15 1 35,280 17.64

Category 14 15 1 42,192 21.096

Category 15 15 1 23,370 23.37

Category 16 15 1 27,952 27.952

Category 17 15 1 35,280 17.64

23,370 23.37

Category 18 15 1 42,192 21.096

27,952 27.952

Category 19 15 1 35,280 35.280

Category 20 15 1 42,192 42.192

Category 21 15 1 23,370 23.370

Category 22 15 1 27,952 27.952

Category 23 15 1 35,280 35.280

Category 24 15 1 42,192 42.192

Category 25 15 1 23,370 46.740

Category 26 15 1 27,952 55.904

Page 142: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 142 of 415

HS-DSCH Category

Maximum Number of HS-DSCH Codes Received

Minimum Inter-TTI Interval

Maximum Number of Bits

Maximum Bit Rate

(Mbit/s)

Category 27 15 1 35,280 70.560

Category 28 15 1 42,192 84.384

Note: In the "Maximum Number of Bits" column, the bits refer to bits received by the

HS-DSCH transport block during a TTI on the HS-DSCH.

In the preceding table,

UEs of category 13 and category 14 are only required to support 64QAM.

UEs of category 15 and category 16 are only required to support MIMO.

UEs of category 17 and category 18 support 64QAM and MIMO, but not simultaneously.

UEs of category 19 and category 20 support 64QAM+MIMO.

UEs of category 21 and category 22 support 16QAM+DC-HSPA \.

UEs of category 23 and category 24 support 64QAM+DC-HSPA.

UEs of category 25 and category 26 support 16QAM+MIMO+DC-HSPA.

UEs of category 27 and category 28 support 64QAM+MIMO+DC-HSPA.

Enhancement

In RAN11.0, UEs of category 13, category 14, category 15, category 16, category 17, and

category 18 are introduced.

In RAN12.0, UEs of category 19 to category 24 are introduced.

In RAN13.0, UEs of category 25 to category 28 are introduced.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

None

Dependency on Node B hardware

None

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

Dependency on other NEs

None

Page 143: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 143 of 415

2.3.16 WRFD-01061015 HSDPA 1.8Mbit/s per User

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.0.

Summary

This feature enables the HSDPA rate to reach a maximum of 1.8 Mbit/s for each user.

Benefits

This feature provides higher peak bit rate and enhances the end user experience.

Description

High Speed Downlink Packet Access (HSDPA) is an important feature of 3GPP Release 5

which can provide high speed service for the downlink. With this feature, the UE with

interactive or background service on the HS-DSCH can reach a peak rate of up to 1.8 Mbit/s

(MAC layer), thus greatly enhancing the user experience.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

UE should have the capability of HSDPA Category 12(or later):category 3,4,5,6,7,8,9,10,12,

13,14,15,16,17,18,19,20,21,22,23,24,25,26,27,28

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

CN support user rate of 1.8Mbit/s or above.

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

Page 144: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 144 of 415

2.3.17 WRFD-01061016 16 HSDPA Users per Cell

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.0.

Summary

This feature enables a single HSDPA cell to support 16 HSDPA users simultaneously. If the

number of HSDPA users exceeds 16, the DCH is used for service provisioning.

Benefits

This feature provides operators with a maximum of 16 HSDPA users in an HSDPA capable

cell.

Description

A maximum of 16 HSDPA users can be served simultaneously in an HSDPA capable cell with

this feature.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

Page 145: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 145 of 415

2.3.18 WRFD-010620 HSDPA 3.6Mbit/s per User

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.1.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R5.

Summary

This feature enables the HSDPA rate per user to reach a maximum of 3.6 Mbit/s.

Benefits

This feature provides a higher peak bit rate and enhances user experience.

Description

HSDPA is an important feature of 3GPP Release 5 that can provide high speed service for

downlink. With this feature, the UE with interactive or background services on the HS-DSCH

can reach the peak bit rate up to 3.6 Mbit/s (MAC layer). Thus, user experience is greatly

enhanced.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

UE should have the capability of HSDPA Category 5(or later):category 5,

6,7,8,9,10,13,14,15,16,17,18,19,20,21,22,23,24,25,26,27,28

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

CN support user rate of 3.6Mbit/s or above.

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

Page 146: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 146 of 415

2.3.19 WRFD-010629 DL 16QAM Modulation

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R5.

Summary

Compared with the QPSK modulation, the 16QAM modulation is a higher-order downlink

data modulation mode. This feature enables the peak rate on the Uu interface to reach 14.4

Mbit/s.

Benefits

Provides higher peak bit rate HSDPA service for HSDPA users.

Description

The HS-PDSCH is used to carry the HS-DSCH data. The HS-PDSCH may use QPSK or

16QAM modulation symbols.

When the UE is in poor radio environment, the transmission can adopt the low-order QPSK

modulation mode and small transport blocks to ensure communication quality.

When the UE is in good radio environment, the transmission can adopt the high-order

16QAM modulation mode and large transport blocks to achieve high peak rate.

The UE of category 10 can support a maximum of 15 HS-PDSCH codes and 16QAM

modulation mode. The supported peak rate on the air interface can reach 14.4 Mbit/s.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

UE should have the capability of HSDPA besides Category 11 and Category 12:category

1,2,3,4,5,6,7,8,9,10,13,14,15,16,17,18,19,20,21,22,23,24,25,26,27,28

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

Page 147: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 147 of 415

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

2.4 HSDPA Performance Improvement

2.4.1 WRFD-010631 Dynamic Code Allocation Based on Node B

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

This feature implements dynamic code allocation on the Node B side. The Node B adjusts the

allocation of code resources in each TTI according to available code resources and scheduling

algorithms. This feature can further improve the utilization of code resources.

Benefits

This feature increases the resource utilization and system throughput.

Description

In Node B-controlled dynamic HS-PDSCH code allocation, Node B determines the

HS-PDSCH code use according to the code availability and scheduling algorithm in each 2ms

TTI. Node B-controlled dynamic HS-PDSCH code allocation is more efficient and flexible

than RNC-controlled dynamic HS-PDSCH code allocation. The resource can be scheduled

and used in a short time at the Node B, compared with signaling message transmission on the

Iub interface using RNC-controlled dynamic HS-PDSCH code allocation.

HS-DSCH transmission to multiple users in parallel during a single TTI requires more

HS-SCCH codes and more HS-PDSCH codes. Code multiplexing is adopted and is found

useful in cases where the Node B has allocated more HS-PDSCH codes than what is

supported by the UE. For instance, the UE supports 5 codes and the Node B has 10 codes

available in a single TTI. The code multiplexing can increase the resource utilization and

system throughput.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

Page 148: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 148 of 415

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

2.4.2 WRFD-010621 HSDPA 7.2Mbit/s per User

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

This feature enables the HSDPA rate per user to reach a maximum of 7.2 Mbit/s.

Benefits

This feature provides a higher peak bit rate and enhances user experience.

Description

HSDPA is an important feature of 3GPP Release 5 that can provide high speed service for

downlink. With this feature, the UE with interactive or background services on the HS-DSCH

can reach the peak bit rate of up to 7.2 Mbit/s (MAC layer). Thus, user experience is greatly

enhanced.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

Page 149: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 149 of 415

UE should have the capability of HSDPA Category 7(or later):category

7,8,9,10,13,14,15,16,17,18,19,20,21,22,23,24,25,26,27,28

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

CN support user rate of 7.2Mbit/s or above.

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010620 HSDPA 3.6Mbit/s per User

WRFD-010629 DL 16QAM Modulation

2.4.3 WRFD-010622 32 HSDPA Users per Cell

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.1.

Summary

This feature enables a single HSDPA cell to simultaneously support 32 HSDPA users. If the

number of HSDPA users exceeds 32, the DCH is attempted for service provisioning.

Benefits

This feature provides HSDPA services at a higher peak bit rate for up to 32 users per cell.

Description

Up to 32 HSDPA users can be admitted to a HSDPA cell.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

Page 150: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 150 of 415

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

2.4.4 WRFD-010611 HSDPA Enhanced Package

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.1.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R5.

Summary

This feature provides a series of enhanced HSDPA functions to meet the commercial

requirements of HSDPA services.

Benefits

Enhance the HSDPA performance by introducing the GBR-based QoS guarantee mechanism.

Enhance the HSDPA networking capability to meet HSDPA networking requirements.

Description

HSDPA enhanced package is introduced on the basis of WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction

Package, and provides enhancement features to meet the QoS and HSDPA network

requirements. Related features include:

EPF and GBR Based Scheduling

HSDPA State Transition

HSDPA DRD (Direct Retry Decision)

HS-DPCCH preamble support

Enhancement

In RAN6.0 and RAN10.0, this feature is enhanced. For details, refer to the enhancement of

the features in the package.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

Page 151: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 151 of 415

UE should support the functions connected with HSDPA Enhanced package.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

2.4.5 WRFD-01061103 Scheduling based on EPF and GBR

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.1.

Summary

The operator can set different QoS parameters (such as priority, weight, and GBR) for

different users. Based on the QoS parameters, the EPF algorithm can accurately allocate

resources by proportion. This feature can make different users obtain accurate differentiated

experience.

Benefits

By satisfying quality requirements of different traffic types, the system capacity is maximized.

Description

Scheduling algorithm is to schedule UEs’ transmission every 2ms TTI. Considering a

compromise between the system capacity and user fairness, this feature provides four HSDPA

scheduling algorithms for the operators to choose from:

Max C/I

Round robin algorithm

Proportional Fair algorithm (PF)

Enhanced Proportional Fair algorithm (EPF)

1. In enhanced proportional fair algorithm (EPF), HSDPA carrying services are divided into

two categories: delay sensitive and throughput sensitive. Priority is given to delay sensitive

services during schedule ordering.

2. During uncongested periods in the cell, the EPF algorithm (which is based on the PF

algorithm) can fulfill the latency requirements of delay sensitive services, and also provide

Guaranteed Bit Rate (GBR) to throughput sensitive services. In this way fairness can be

effectively guaranteed between the user and a low QoS priority requirement service.

3. During uncongested periods in the cell after fulfilling the basic QoS requirements of every

user, the EPF algorithm can distribute surplus resources according to Scheduling Priority

Page 152: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 152 of 415

Indicator (SPI) weight, thus allowing throughput sensitive services to attain higher speeds. In

order to satisfy more users, once BE services have achieved Happy Bit Rate (HBR), the

scheduling priority is reduced significantly, thereby letting the resources to be distributed

amongst other users. HBR can be configured by the operator.

4. When a cell is uncongested, EPF algorithm will give priority to delay sensitive services

during resource distribution, thereby guaranteeing the networks basic traffic QoS. In case of

surplus resources, remaining resources will be assigned to throughput sensitive services.

Moreover, the services will be provided with GBR speed services according to the traffic’s

SPI sequence.

5. SPI weight depends on the traffic class, user priority and traffic handling priority (THP).

6. Users can be divided into Gold, Silver and Bronze categories, all mapped by ARP, which

are configurable. Moreover, uplink and downlink GBR configuration is also based on user

priority, and is used for HSDPA scheduling algorithms. Through this feature, HSDPA’s QoS

guarantee mechanism is enhanced.

7. EPF algorithm was introduced in RAN5.1. Based on ARP, SPI mapping also receives

further optimization. Moreover, the minimum throughput of GBR services including BE

services can be configured. Minimal limitations during the scheduling process need to receive

strict assurances.

Enhancement

In RAN6.0, the GBR for Gold/Silver/Bronze users can be configured, this enhances QoS

guarantee mechanism.

In RAN10.0, the scheduling function concerning the signaling RB is added to the EPF

algorithm. In addition, the traffic is classified into delay sensitive services and throughput

sensitive services.

In RAN11.0 EPF algorithm increased the scheduling capabilities of CELL_FACH’s status

queue, moreover it introduced HBR, in order to improve user satisfaction.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

Page 153: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 153 of 415

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

2.4.6 WRFD-01061111 HSDPA State Transition

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.0.

Summary

This feature enables the handover between the DCH and HS-DSCH and makes it possible for

the UE to enjoy the high-speed service. When the UE is in the inactive state, this feature

enables the UE to be handed over to the CELL_FACH to save the system resources when

there is no data transferred for a long time.

Benefits

This feature supports the switching between DCH and HS-DSCH and makes it possible for

the UE to enjoy the high speed service. Meanwhile, the system resource is saved by moving

the UE to CELL_FACH when there is no data transferred for a long time.

Description

This feature enables the UE to perform a state transition between CELL_DCH (HS-DSCH),

CELL_DCH, and CELL_FACH. With the introduction of HSDPA, a new RRC state of

CELL_DCH (HS-DSCH) is provided. The following figure shows the RRC state relation.

CELL_PCH CELL_FACH

CELL_DCH

CELL_DCH(with HS-DSCH)

Channel Switching Between CELL_DCH (HS-DSCH) and CELL_FACH

If the HS-DSCH is carrying BE service or streaming service and there is no data to be

sent for a long time, the transition from CELL_DCH (HS-DSCH) to CELL_FACH is

triggered. Actually, this feature is supported in the same way as state transition from

CELL_DCH to CELL_FACH.

A UE on CELL_FACH will be switched to CELL_DCH (HS-DSCH) due to a higher bit

rates request on downlink.

Channel Switching Between CELL_DCH (HS-DSCH) and CELL_DCH

Page 154: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 154 of 415

The channel switching between HS-DSCH and DCH is mainly triggered by mobility

management. The transition from CELL_DCH to CELL_DCH (HS-DSCH) can be

triggered by periodical retry and the traffic volume

The mobility triggering is described in WRFD-01061006 HSDPA Mobility Management

feature.

The traffic volume report that indicates a higher bit service needs to be transferred. The

UE in CELL_DCH will be transferred to CELL_DCH (HS-DSCH) if it is an HSDPA

capable cell and the UE has HSDPA capability. This feature enables the UE to enjoy high

speed service.

If an HSDPA capable UE is set up on the DCH for BE services for some reasons, for

example, the admission of the HS-DSCH fails, then a periodical retry mechanism is

triggered, allowing the UE to enter the CELL_DCH (HS-DSCH). The retry time is

configurable.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

2.4.7 WRFD-01061112 HSDPA DRD

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.0.

Summary

This feature enables HSDPA suitable service to be established on the HS-DSCH cell as much

as possible if a UE is HS-DSCH capable, thus achieving better service performance.

Page 155: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 155 of 415

Benefits

This feature enables HSDPA suitable service to be established on the HS-DSCH cell as much

as possible if a UE is HS-DSCH capable, thus achieving better service performance.

Description

This feature enables HSDPA suitable service be mapped onto the HS-DSCH as soon as

possible if a UE is HS-DSCH capable.

When a UE camps on an R99-concentric cell and requests for a streaming or BE service

which is HSDPA suitable, the service will be mapped onto the HS-DSCH of the HSDPA

capable cell if allowed by the HSDPA admission control.

In the case a UE camps on an HSDPA cell and requests for a streaming or BE service which is

compatible with HSDPA, if the HSDPA admission fails on the current cell but another

HSDPA capable cell which has the same center as the current cell is available, then the service

will be mapped onto the HS-DSCH of the HSDPA capable cell that has the same center as the

current cell if it is allowed by the HSDPA admission control.

An HSDPA capable UE has an HSDPA suitable service but is currently mapped onto the DCH

due to some limitations (for example, the current cell does not support HSDPA or the HSDPA

admission control fails). If the UE moves around and the best cell begins to support HSDPA,

the service will be re-mapped onto the HS-DSCH of the best cell if allowed by the HSDPA

admission control. If the best cell does not support HSDPA, but there is an HSDPA capable

concentric cell and the HSDPA admission control is allowed, the service will be re-mapped

onto the HS-DSCH of that concentric cell.

An HSDPA capable UE has an HSDPA suitable service, but is currently mapped onto the

CELL_FACH or CELL_DCH (DCH only). In addition, there is a data transmission request on

the downlink, and the concentric cell supports HSDPA instead of the current cell. In this case,

the service will be re-mapped onto the HS-DSCH of that HSDPA capable cell.

Enhancement

In RAN5.1, in any condition, if an HSDPA capable UE has an HSDPA suitable service, but is

currently not mapped onto the HS-DSCH, and if the current best cell or the concentric cell of

the best cell is HSDPA capable, the RNC will periodically attempt to re-map the service onto

the HS-DSCH until the service retry succeeds.

In RAN12, to reduce the call drop rate, a punishment mechanism is implemented. The D2H

DRD is forbidden for the users which encountered DRD failure at the RAB Setup procedure.

This mechanism can be configured by operator.

In RAN12 Periodically DRD based on measurement is introduced, RAB can be setup in the

original DCH cell, and by following inter frequency measurement to chose a HSDPA cell to

perform DRD, thus reduce the drop rate caused by blind handover. The Periodically DRD

based on blind handover or based on measurement can be selected by operator.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

Page 156: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 156 of 415

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

WRFD-020400 DRD Introduction Package

2.4.8 WRFD-01061113 HS-DPCCH Preamble Support

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

Summary

This feature enables the transmission of dedicated preamble subframes before ACK/NACK

subframes are transmitted on the HS-DPCCH, thus improving transmission reliability.

Benefits

HS-DPCCH preamble mode technology enables the Node B to distinguish between DTX and

ACK/NACK without requiring high ACK transmit power

The uplink coverage gain is about 0.2 dB to 0.9 dB with different accompanying DPCH

services.

Description

The High Speed Dedicated Physical Control Channel (HS-DPCCH) carries uplink feedback

signaling related to downlink HS-DSCH transmission. The HS-DSCH-related feedback

signaling consists of Hybrid-ARQ Acknowledgement (HARQ-ACK) and Channel-Quality

Indication (CQI).

If UE detects the HS-SCCH control message, it will reply with an ACK or NACK message

based on the result of the decoding and it will inform the sender of the result to further request

retransmissions.

If the UE does not detect the HS-SCCH control message, it will reply with a DTX message.

To reduce the probability that the Node B decodes this DTX as ACK by mistake, the transmit

power of the ACK/NACK message should be high.

Page 157: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 157 of 415

Huawei supports HS-DPCCH preamble mode detection. The proposed enhancement is to

send special Preamble sub-frames in the uplink HS-DPCCH before an ACK/NACK

sub-frame. This method reduces the probability of a DTX->ACK error in the Node B, because

the Node B has to decode at least two successive timeslots erroneously before the earlier

mentioned scenario can take place. Due to the prior preamble information detection, the same

performance of the HARQ-ACK field detection can be sustained with lower power.

N

HS-DPCCH

HS-DSCH

HS-SCCH

ACK or NACK

Data Packet

N N+1 N+2 N+3

N N+1 N+2 N-1

PRE

PREAMBLE transmitted in sub-frame N-1 to indicate reception of relevant signalling information in sub-frame N on HS-SCCH

Normal ACK/NACK to indicate correct or incorrect decoding of packet

POSTAMBLE transmitted in sub-frame N+1 (unless a packet is correctly decoded from sub-frame N+1 on the HS-DSCH, or control information is detected in sub-frame N+2 on the HS-SCCH)

N+1 N+2 N+3

POST

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

This feature also depends on the Node B hardware:

The BTS3812E, BTS3812A and BTS3812AE need to configure EBBI board, EBOI

board, EULP or EULPd board.

The BBU3806 needs to configure EBBC or EBBCd board; the BBU3806C needs to

configure EBBM board.

s to configure WBBPb or WBBPd board.

Dependency on UE

UE should have the capability of HSDPA Category 6(or later) and support this feature.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

Page 158: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 158 of 415

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

2.4.9 WRFD-010630 Streaming Traffic Class on HSDPA

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R5.

Summary

This feature enables the streaming services to be mapped onto the HS-DSCH, thus improving

the utilization of cell resources.

Benefits

This feature enables the system to support a higher speed RAB of PS streaming service.

Description

This feature enables the streaming service to be mapped onto the HS-DSCH if a UE is

HSDPA capable. The system sets a switch to enable or disable the feature that streaming

service is mapped onto the HS-DSCH. A service rate threshold is also set only when the

requested service bit rate is higher than the threshold. At this time, the requested service can

be mapped onto the HS-DSCH. Otherwise, it will be mapped onto DCH. The service rate

threshold can also be configured by the operator.

When the streaming service is carried on the HS-DSCH, the maximum downlink bit rate can

reach 384 kbit/s.

When a UE has a streaming service on the HS-DSCH, it can use another CS RAB or another

PS RAB simultaneously. One HSDPA BE RAB and one HSDPA streaming RAB can be used

by one UE simultaneously if the UE capability permits.

Enhancement

In RAN5.1, GBR of streaming traffic is used to estimate whether the maximum available

power for HSDPA can satisfy the requirement of streaming service and

interactive/background service in admission control in RAN5.1.

The HSDPA scheduling algorithm also considers the GBR information of streaming traffic so

that all HSDPA streaming services are guaranteed when the bit rate is not less than GBR.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Page 159: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 159 of 415

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010611 HSDPA Enhanced Package

2.4.10 WRFD-010650 HSDPA 13.976Mbit/s per User

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R5.

Summary

This feature enables the HSDPA rate per user to reach a maximum of 13.976 Mbit/s.

Benefits

This feature provides a higher peak bit rate and enhances user experience.

Description

HSDPA is an important feature of 3GPP Release 5 that can provide high speed service for

downlink. With this feature, the UE with interactive or background services on the HS-DSCH

can reach the peak bit rate up to 13.976 Mbit/s (MAC layer). Thus, user experience is greatly

enhanced.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

This feature requires WFMRc board in BSC6800.

Dependency on Node B

Page 160: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 160 of 415

NA

Dependency on UE

UE should have the capability of HSDPA Category 10, 13(or later),category

10,13,14,15,16,17,18,19,20,21,22,23,24,25,26,27,28

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

CN support user rate of 13.976Mbit/s or above.

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010621 HSDPA 7.2Mbit/s per User

2.4.11 WRFD-010651 HSDPA over Iur

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R5.

Summary

This feature enables HSDPA services to be carried on the Iur interface and provides

continuous HSDPA services for UEs moving between RNCs.

Benefits

HSDPA over Iur provides continuous HSDPA services for mobile users moving between

RNCs. It enlarges the range of HSDPA services to the RNCs that have Iur connections with a

certain RNC.

Description

HSDPA over Iur is the scenario where the HSDPA serving cell is carried at the DRNC. The

feature includes HSDPA service management over Iur, HSDPA mobility management over Iur,

and so on.

HSDPA service management over Iur

HSDPA service management over Iur refers to HSDPA service setup, modification,

release, and state transition.

When the UE is in the CELL_DCH state and the DRNC cell is in the active set or the UE

is in the CELL_FACH state and camps in a DRNC cell, the HSDPA service can be setup,

modified, and released over Iur.

The service over Iur can be reconfigured between HSDPA and R99 with UE state

transition between CELL_DCH and CELL_FACH.

HSDPA mobility management over Iur

Page 161: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 161 of 415

HSDPA mobility management over Iur includes hard handover, cell update (caused by

radio link failure), and serving cell change.

The processes are similar to the corresponding mobility management described in

WRFD-01061006 HSDPA Mobility Management, and the difference is that the cells

change between RNCs.

HSDPA static relocation

If the HSDPA service is over Iur and the radio links are provided only by the target RNC, the

static relocation can be triggered by Iur congestion.

HSDPA service pre-emption at the DRNC

When the new HSDPA service is not admitted to the network, the CRNC may trigger

pre-emption of other HSDPA services with lower priorities. If the CRNC is the DRNC, it

sends RADIO LINK PREEMPTION REQUIRED INDICATION to the SRNC and the SRNC

releases the HSDPA services indicated in the RADIO LINK PREEMPTION REQUIRED

INDICATION.

Other functions of this feature, such as HSDPA power offset adjustment over Iur and

HSDPA radio link parameter update over Iur are similar to the processes realized on the

Iub interface.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

The neighbouring RNC should also support HSDPA over Iur.

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

Page 162: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 162 of 415

2.4.12 WRFD-010652 SRB over HSDPA

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R6.

Summary

SRB over HSDPA enables the DL SRBs of multiple UEs to be carried over HSDPA through

the FDPCH multiplexing technology, thus reducing the consumption of DL code resources

and the call setup delay.

Benefits This feature provides a higher signaling rate and reduces the call process delay.

Compared with the scenario where the SRB is carried on the DCH, code resources are

saved and cell load is reduced when the SRB is carried on HSDPA.

Description

The signaling over SRB is delay-sensitive and irregular. In some cases, the code may be

limited prior to power and the cell capacity is affected. Thus, it is more appropriate to set up

SRB over the HSDPA rather than the DCH. When compared with SRB over DCH, SRB over

HSDPA and F-DPCH multiplexing can save code resources.

SRB over HSDPA can be applied during the RRC connection setup procedure or other

procedures such as mobility management.

If the SRB is set up over the DCH, it can be reconfigured to the mapping on HSDPA in some

cases, for example, the target cell of handover supports HSDPA while the source cell does not.

Inversely, the SRB mapping on HSDPA can also be reconfigured to the mapping on DCH if

the target cell of handover does not support HSDPA.

SRB over HSDPA is configurable. The operator can also configure whether SRB over HSDPA

is applied to RRC connection setup or not.

Enhancement

Enhanced F-DPCH is supported in RAN11.0.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

This feature depends on the Node B hardware:

The BTS3812E, BTS3812A and BTS3812AE need to configure EBBI board, EBOI

board or EDLP board.

Page 163: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 163 of 415

The BBU3806 needs to configure EBBC or EBBCd board; the BBU3806C needs to

configure EBBM board.

The BBU3900 need to configure WBBPb or WBBPd board

Dependency on UE

The UE should support FDPCH/EFDPCH

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

2.4.13 WRFD-010623 64 HSDPA Users per Cell

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

This feature enables a single HSDPA cell to simultaneously support 64 HSDPA users. If the

number of HSDPA users exceeds 64, the DCH is attempted for service provisioning.

Benefits

This feature provides HSDPA services at a higher peak bit rate for up to 64 users per cell.

Description

Up to 64 HSDPA users can be admitted to a HSDPA cell.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

Page 164: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 164 of 415

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010622 32 HSDPA Users per Cell

HSUPA Introduction and HSUPA 1.44 Mbit/s per User

2.4.14 WRFD-030010 CQI Adjustment Based on Dynamic BLER Target

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0

Summary

In live networks, channel quality fluctuates constantly. To achieve the highest possible

downlink throughput, an appropriate Block Error Rate (BLER) target is required.

This feature helps select the optimum BLER target based on downlink channel quality

fluctuations in real time.

Benefits

This feature increases the downlink throughput in HSDPA cells by up to 10%.

Description

In radio environments, many factors affect downlink throughput, such as multipath fading and

UE movement speeds. To achieve the highest possible downlink throughput for HSDPA users

in an ever-changing radio environment, the Node B needs to dynamically adjust the BLER

target. This feature enables the NodeB to do so. After adjusting the BLER target, the Node B

can then adjust the Channel Quality Indicator (CQI) to increase the downlink throughput.

This feature supports CQI adjustment based on dynamic BLER target for non-MIMO mode

UE in RAN13.0 when HSDPA is both deployed in network side and UE side.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Page 165: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 165 of 415

Dependency on Node B

BTS3812E and BTS3812AE must be configured with the EBBI, EBOI, or EDLP board.

BBU3806 must be configured with the EBBC or EBBCd board. BBU3806C must be

configured with the EBBM board.

BBU3900 must be configured with the WBBPb or WBBPd board.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

2.4.15 WRFD-030011 MIMO Prime

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0.

Summary

MIMO Prime is one of Huawei's proprietary performance technologies. Based on

dual-transmission RF modules, it can greatly improve spectrum utilization and increase

network capacity.

Benefits

MIMO Prime can increase the capacity of the cell in which MIMO has not been implemented

by about 5% to 10%. The increase in the overall cell throughput helps to greatly improve the

experience of users in medium and bad radio conditions. The trial test shows that this feature

can increase the throughput of the single user in medium and bad radio conditions by about

15% and 20% respectively.

MIMO Prime does not depend on the UE and is applicable to various services including

HSDPA and 64QAM. Furthermore, it does not affect the performance of traditional UEs.

When the penetration of MIMO-capable UEs is low, MIMO Prime can effectively protect the

investments of operators who have already deployed MIMO-capable RF modules but haven’t

implemented MIMO. As the number of MIMO-capable UEs increases, operators can

gradually enable the MIMO feature to achieve the maximum benefits in terms of capacity and

user experience.

Description

MIMO Prime is based on Virtual Antenna Mapping (VAM), which applies matrix processing

to the original signal before sending it over the antennas. The original signal is allocated to the

Page 166: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 166 of 415

two antennas with equal power. After VAM is enabled, each signal is split into two signals.

This results in a certain phase difference in the two received signals, which affects the

strength of the signals after they are combined. MIMO Prime supports automatic phase

adjustment based on the signal environment, thereby achieving increased UE throughput by

enhancing the reception quality of the UE.

Figure2-6-14-1 Principles of MIMO Prime

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

NA

Dependency on NodeB hardware

This feature is supported only by the 40W RRU3801C, RRU3804, RRU3806, RRU3808,

WRFU, RRU3805, WRFUd, RRU3828, RRU3829, RRU3928, RRU3929, MRFUd,

MRFUe, as well as the RRU3908 V1 operating in 850 MHz, 900 MHz, and 1900 MHz.

For RF modules providing only one transmit channel, two such RF modules need to be

interconnected to support this feature.

The BBU3900 must be configured with the WBBPb or WBBPd.

The BTS3812E and BTS3812AE do not support this feature.

The DBS3800 doesn’t support this feature.

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

Dependency on other NEs

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Page 167: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 167 of 415

2.4.16 WRFD-030004 Adaptive Configuration of Typical HSPA Rate

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.1.

Summary

This feature is applicable only to PS best effort (BE) services over High Speed Packet Access

(HSPA) channels. This feature enables the RNC to calculate the actual maximum traffic rate

based on the maximum bit rate (MBR) assigned by the CN.

Benefits

This feature enables mobile operators to quickly and flexibly provide services with various

traffic rates, facilitating new market expansion to increase revenue.

Description

To meet market requirements, mobile operators need to provide services with various traffic

rates over HSPA. Typical traffic rates configured at the RNC, however, are fixed and

separated, and may be inconsistent with the MBR required by mobile operators.

Without this feature, the RNC selects a typical traffic rate closest to the MBR assigned by the

CN if a traffic rate inconsistency occurs between the RNC and CN. This rate, not the MBR, is

then used for calculating the actual maximum traffic rate of the UE. As a result, the rates

propagated by mobile operators are unavailable for UEs, affecting brand image.

With this feature, the RNC can use the MBR assigned by the CN to calculate the actual

maximum traffic rate when the MBR cannot be mapped onto any typical traffic rate.

Note that the MBR assigned to UEs with an HSUPA TTI of 10 ms must be higher than 32

kbit/s and the MBR assigned to UEs with an HSUPA TTI of 2 ms must be higher than144

kbit/s. Otherwise, these UEs cannot achieve traffic rates higher than corresponding MBRs.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

None

Dependency on NodeB hardware

None

Dependency on the UE

None

Page 168: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 168 of 415

Dependency on the CN

None

Dependency on other NEs

None

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

2.5 HSPA+ Prime Service

2.5.1 WRFD-010680 HSPA+ Downlink 28Mbit/s per User

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R7.

Summary

This feature enables the HSPA+ MIMO rate per user to reach a maximum of 28 Mbit/s. This

feature enhances the user experience for high-speed data services.

Benefits This feature can improve the frequency utilization and increase the maximum downlink

rate.

This feature can provide end users with high-speed data experience.

Description

HSPA+ is introduced in 3GPP Release 7 to provide high speed data services. With this feature,

the peak downlink rate increases from 13.976 Mbit/s per user in R6 to 28 Mbit/s per user

(MAC layer).

Enhancement

DC-HSDPA is available from RAN12.0. With DC-HSDPA and downlink 16QAM, the peak

downlink rate also can increases from 13.976 Mbit/s per user in R6 to 28 Mbit/s per user

(MAC layer).

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

Page 169: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 169 of 415

This feature requires WFMRc board in BSC6800.

Dependency on Node B

The BTS3812E, BTS3812A, and BTS3812AE should be configured with the EBBI,

EBOI or EDLP board.

The BBU3806 should be configured with the EBBC or EBBCd board; the BBU3806C

should be configured with the EBBM board.

The BBU3900 should be configured with the WBBPb or WBBPd board.

For the RF part, the RF module of Huawei Node B supports one TX channel each, and

two interconnected RF modules can provide two TX channels to support 2 x 2 MIMO

Dependency on UE

The UE category must support cat16, cat18(or later)

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

CN support user rate of 28Mbit/s or above.

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010684 2*2 MIMO

WRFD-010650 HSDPA 13.976Mbit/s per User

or

WRFD-010696 DC-HSDPA

WRFD-010650 HSDPA 13.976Mbit/s per User

2.5.2 WRFD-010681 HSPA+ Downlink 21Mbit/s per User

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R7.

Summary

This feature enables the HSPA+ 64QAM rate per user to reach a maximum of 21 Mbit/s. With

this feature, users can enjoy high-speed data experience.

Benefits This feature can improve the frequency utilization and increase the maximum downlink

rate.

This feature can provide end users with high-speed data experience.

Page 170: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 170 of 415

Description

HSPA+ is introduced in 3GPP Release 7 to provide high speed for data services. With this

feature, the peak downlink rate increases from 13.976 Mbit/s per user in R6 to 21 Mbit/s per

user (MAC layer).

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

This feature requires WFMRc board in BSC6800.

Dependency on Node B

To support this feature, the following configurations are required:

The BTS3812E, BTS3812A and BTS3812AE need to configure EBBI board, EBOI

board or EDLP board.

The BBU3806 needs to configure EBBC or EBBCd board; the BBU3806C needs to

configure EBBM board.

The BBU3900 needs to configure WBBPb or WBBPd board.

Dependency on UE

The UE category must support cat 14,18,20,24 or 28

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

CN support user rate of 21Mbit/s or above.

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010683 64QAM

WRFD-010650 HSDPA 13.976 Mbit/s per User

2.5.3 WRFD-010685 Downlink Enhanced L2

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R7.

Page 171: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 171 of 415

Summary

Downlink Enhanced L2 supports the variable PDU size, which eliminates the contradictions

between the high-speed transmission that requires a large PDU size and the cell-edge

coverage that requires a small PDU size. This feature enables the dynamic adjustment of the

PDU size to improve the transmission efficiency on the Iub and Uu interfaces and increase the

cell edge throughput and coverage radius.

Benefits

This feature is a prerequisite of the 64QAM, MIMO, and enhanced CELL_FACH, which also

improves the transmission efficiency on the Iub and Uu interfaces.

Description

Downlink Enhanced L2 supports the variable PDU size, which eliminates the contradictions

between the high-speed transmission that requires a large PDU size and the cell-edge

coverage that requires a small PDU size. In addition, enhanced L2 reduces excessive overhead

caused by the fixed PDU size, and thus improves the transmission efficiency on the Iub and

Uu interfaces.

Downlink Enhanced L2 is a prerequisite for 64QAM, MIMO and enhanced CELL_FACH. It

removes the restrictions on the RLC window for users whose transmission rate is more than

14 Mbit/s. At the cell edge, small PDU size requires relative low SNR, thus better service

coverage and throughput will be attained.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on other RAN software functions

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

Dependency on UE

The UE must be Release 7 (or later) UE and support this feature.

2.5.4 WRFD-010689 HSPA+ Downlink 42Mbit/s per User

Availability

This feature is available from RAN12.0. It is introduced in 3GPP Release 8.

Summary

This feature enables the peak rate of the data service over HSPA+ to reach 42 Mbit/s per user.

Page 172: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 172 of 415

Benefits This feature improves the frequency utilization and increases the maximum downlink

rate.

This feature provides end users with high-rate data services.

Description

HSPA+ is introduced in 3GPP Release 7 to provide high-rate data services. With the

2*2MIMO+64QAM or 64QAM+DC HSDPA technologies introduced in R8 and the enhanced

performance of relevant NEs, the peak downlink rate per user reaches up to 42 Mbit/s.

TCP protocol is widely used in data transmission. As a file is being downloaded, the TCP

acknowledgement is sent in uplink. The higher the rate of download is, the larger the

bandwidth is required in uplink. If the download rate reaches up to 42Mbit/s, the rate of TCP

acknowledgement in uplink is much higher than 384 kbit/s which is the highest rate supported

by DCH. HSUPA bearer is required to provide high bandwidth in uplink to transmit TCP

acknowledgement in time. DL 42Mbit/s per user can be supported only in case of HSUPA

being used.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

Only BSC6900 supports this feature.

Dependency on NodeB

When this feature is applied, DPUe board is preferred to support more users with peak rate.

The BTS3812E, BTS3812A, or BTS3812AE must be configured with the EBBI, EBOI

or EDLP board.

The BBU3806 must be configured with the EBBC or EBBCd card; the BBU3806C must

be configured with the EBBM card.BBU3806C+EBBM only supports 64QAM+DC

HSDPA function.

The BBU3900 must be configured with the WBBPb or WBBPd card.

For the RF part which supports only one TX channel, two interconnected RF modules

can provide two TX channels to support 2 x 2 MIMO. In terms of RF modules including

2 Tx channels, no additional RF modules is required for 2*2MIMO.

Dependency on other RAN software functions

WRFD-010689 HSPA+ Downlink 21Mbit/s per User plus WRFD-010696 DC-HSPA plus

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package,

or

WRFD-010689 HSPA+ Downlink 21Mbit/s per User plus WRFD-010680 HSPA+ Downlink

28Mbit/s per User plus WRFD-010693 DL 64QAM+MIMO plus WRFD-010612 HSUPA

Introduction Package

Page 173: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 173 of 415

Dependency on other NEs

The UE should support category of 21(or later), categorie: 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28.

Dependency on CN

CN needs to support sending RAB assignment with relate data rate.

2.5.5 WRFD-010683 Downlink 64QAM

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R7.

Summary

Compared with the 16QAM modulation, the 64QAM modulation is a higher-order downlink

data modulation mode. This feature enables the peak rate on the Uu interface to reach 21

Mbit/s.

Benefits

Downlink 64QAM increases the peak rate per user and improves the local cell capability.

Operators attach great importance to data service and regard it as a growing point for profits.

Many consulting companies predict that the data traffic volume will grow rapidly and

accordingly raise higher requirements to the network throughput. If the bandwidth remains

unchanged, 64QAM will increase the average throughput of the system by 7% to 16% and

further improves the spectral efficiency of the system. In this way, the system provides users

with higher throughput and ultimately increases operators' profits on the per bandwidth basis.

On the other hand, 64QAM also raises the peak rate per user and provides a higher download

data rate for users. This enhances not only user experience but also operators'

competitiveness.

Description

3GPP R5 introduces 16QAM to increase the peak rate per user and expands the system

capacity, whereas 64QAM introduced in 3GPP R7 protocols is a further enhancement of

16QAM.

With downlink 64QAM, higher order modulation technology than 16QAM can be used when

the channel is of higher quality. Theoretically, 64QAM supports a peak data rate of 21 Mbit/s

and at the same time increases the average throughput of the system. Simulation shows that

compared with 16QAM, 64QAM can increase the average throughput by 7% and 16%

respectively in macro cell and in micro cell, if the UEs in the cells use the type 3 receivers.

The 3GPP R7 protocols define the categories of the UEs that support 64QAM, and add the

information elements (IEs) that support 64QAM in the reporting of local cell capability. The

RNC determines whether the RL between the Node B and the UE supports 64QAM according

to the local cell capability reported by the Node B and the UE capability. If the RL supports

Page 174: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 174 of 415

64QAM, the MAC-hs scheduler of the Node B determines every 2 ms whether to use 64QAM

according to the following aspects:

Channel Quality Indicator (CQI) reported by the UE

HS-PDSCH code resources and power resources of the Node B

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

The BTS3812E, BTS3812A and BTS3812AE need to configure EBBI board, EBOI

board or EDLP board.

The BBU3806 need to configure EBBC, EBBCd board; the BBU3806C need to

configure EBBM board.

The BBU3900 need to configure WBBPb, WBBPd board.

Dependency on UE

The UE category must support 64QAM. That is, the UE must belong to category

13,14,17,18,19,20,23, 24, 27, 28, as specified by the 3GPP protocols

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

WRFD-010685 Enhanced L2

2.5.6 WRFD-010684 2×2 MIMO

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R7.

Page 175: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 175 of 415

Summary

Based on space dimension resources, MIMO uses the multi-antenna technology at the

transmit end and receive end. This feature can double the transmission capacity of the

wireless communication system in a high SNR environment without the transmit power

added.

Benefits

2x2 MIMO increases the average throughput and peak rate of the cell. In the case of

unchanged bandwidth, 2x2 MIMO increases the average throughput of the system by 14% to

23%. Theoretically, the peak rate per 2X2 MIMO user can be twice the original peak rate. In

addition, MIMO has gains even under lower geographical factors (G = Ior/Ioc) and have more

gains under higher Ior/Ioc. From the service point of view, MIMO has a similar driving force

to 64QAM.

Description

2x2 Multiple Input Multiple Output (MIMO) uses two transmit antennas at the Node B to

transmit orthogonal (parallel) data streams to the two receive antennas at the UEs. Using two

antennas and additional signal processing at the receiver and the transmitter, 2x2 MIMO can

increase the system capacity and double user data rates without using additional bandwidth.

2x2 MIMO adopts different modes in the 3GPP protocols, with QPSK and 16QAM in R7, and

later with 64QAM in R8. With dual-stream dual-antenna mode and16QAM modulation, the

peak data rate per user is doubled to 28 Mbit/s and the average throughput of the system is

enhanced.

The 3GPP R7 protocols define the categories of the UEs that support MIMO, and add the

information elements (IEs) that support MIMO in the reporting of local cell capability. The

RNC determines whether the RL between the Node B and the UE supports MIMO according

to the local cell capability and UE capability reported by the Node B. If the RL supports

MIMO, the MAC-hs scheduler of the Node B determines every 2 ms whether to use MIMO

according to the following aspects:

Channel Quality Indicator (CQI) reported by the UE

Precoding Control Indication (PCI)

HS-PDSCH code resources and power resources of the Node B

For MIMO and HSDPA Co-carrier scenario, please refer to WRFD-010700 Performace

Improvement of MIMO and HSDPA Co-carrier.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

The BTS3812E, BTS3812A and BTS3812AE need to configure EBBI board, EBOI

board or EDLP board.

Page 176: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 176 of 415

The BBU3806 needs to configure EBBC, EBBCd board; the BBU3806C needs to

configure EBBM board.

The BBU3900 needs to configure WBBPb, WBBPd board.

For the RF part, the RF module of Huawei Node B supports one TX channel each and

two interconnected RF modules can provide two TX channels to support 2 x 2 MIMO.

20W RRU3801c can only support MIMO by using together with the same module (20W

RRU3801c)

Dependency on UE

The UE must belong to category 15(or later), that is category 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23,

24, 25, 26, 27, 28

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

WRFD-010685 Downlink Enhanced L2

WRFD-010629 DL 16QAM Modulation

2.5.7 WRFD-010693 DL 64QAM+MIMO

Availability

This feature is available from RAN12.0.

Summary

MIMO and 64QAM are introduced in 3GPP Release 7 and can only be used independently. In

3GPP Release 8, however, MIMO and 64QAM can be used in combination to increase the

peak throughput of a single user.

Benefits

With 64QAM+MIMO, the peak throughput of a single user can reach 42Mbit/s, compared to

28Mbit/s with 16QAM+MIMO or 21Mbit/s with 64QAM only.

Description Channel bearer

The SRB, CS service, IMS signaling, and PS conversational services are not carried on

MIMO, 64QAM, or MIMO+64QAM because the data flow is small and the gain is

insignificant. The PS streaming service, PS interactive service, PS background service,

and the combined services with previous services can be carried on MIMO+64QAM.

Scheduling

Page 177: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 177 of 415

The user scheduling based on a new extended CQI table for the MIMO+64QAM user is

supported.

Mobility management

The UE can be handed over from an MIMO+64QAM capable cell to an MIMO+64QAM

incapable cell and the MIMO+64QAM falls back. If UE moves in the opposite direction,

the MIMO+64QAM can be reconfigured to the UE after handover.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

None

2.5.8 WRFD-010698 HSPA+ Uplink 11.5 Mbit/s per User

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0.

Summary

This feature provides an uplink peak rate of 11.5 Mbit/s for a single user through uplink

16QAM and E-DPCCH boosting.

Benefits

This feature improves spectrum efficiency and increases the peak uplink rate, allowing end

users to enjoy high-speed uplink data services.

Description

This feature utilizes 16QAM (introduced in 3GPP Release 7) and E-DPCCH boosting to

increase the uplink peak rate from 5.74 Mbit/s to 11.5 Mbit/s.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

None

Dependency on NodeB hardware

The BTS3812E and BTS3812AE need to be configured with the EULPd board, and the

downlink services cannot be setup on HBBI/HDLP/NDLP board.

The DBS3800 needs to be configured with the EBBCd board.

Page 178: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 178 of 415

The 3900 series multi-mode base stations need to be configured with the WBBPd board.

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-010694 UL 16QAM

WRFD-010614 HSUPA Phase 2

WRFD-010697 E-DPCCH Boosting

Dependency on other NEs

The UE must support E-DPCCH boosting. The UE must be of HSUPA category 7, 8, or

9.

The CN must support an uplink data rate of 11.5Mbit/s or above.

UL Layer 2 Improvement

2.5.9 WRFD-010703 HSPA+ Downlink 84 Mbit/s per User (Trial)

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0.

Summary

This feature provides a downlink peak rate of 84 Mbit/s for a single user through the

simultaneous use of 64QAM, multiple-input multiple output (MIMO), and dual-cell HSDPA

(DC-HSDPA).

Benefits

This feature enables end users to enjoy high-speed data services.

Description

3GPP Release 9 defines the scenario where MIMO and DC-HSDPA are used together. When

the techniques 64QAM, MIMO, and DC-HSDPA are jointly used, a peak downlink rate of 84

Mbit/s can be achieved for a single user.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

The DPUe is required to support this feature.

Dependency on NodeB hardware

Page 179: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 179 of 415

The BTS3812AE/BTS3812E and DBS3800 cannot provide the downlink peak rate of 84

Mbit/s per user.

The 3900 series multi-mode base stations need to be configured with the WBBPd board.

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-010689 HSPA+ Downlink 42Mbit/s per User

WRFD-010693 Downlink 64QAM+MIMO

WRFD-010699 DC-HSDPA+MIMO

Dependency on other NE

The UE must be of category 28 to support 84 Mbit/s in the downlink, according to 3GPP

Release 9.

CN support user rate of 84Mbit/s or above.

Downlink 64QAM

2.5.10 WRFD-010699 DC-HSDPA+MIMO (Trial)

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0.

Summary

DC-HSDPA+MIMO is introduced in 3GPP Release 9. This feature combines DC-HSDPA

(introduced in 3GPP Release 8) and MIMO (introduced in 3GPP Release 7). This feature

allows the NodeB to send HSDPA data to a UE simultaneously over two adjacent carriers on

the same frequency band within the same coverage area by using MIMO.

Benefits

This feature fully utilizes the advantages of dual-carrier and dual-antenna techniques of

DC-HSDPA and MIMO respectively. It improves the spectrum efficiency and thus

significantly increases the single-user peak throughput, cell-edge-user throughput, and cell

capacity.

Increasing the single user peak throughput

DC-HSDPA+MIMO achieves higher spatial multiplexing gain than DC-HSDPA. This

feature doubles the single-user peak rate from 28 Mbit/s to 56 Mbit/s (When using

16QAM modulation) or from 42 Mbit/s to 84 Mbit/s (with 64QAM).

DC-HSDPA+MIMO uses two carriers simultaneously while SC-HSDPA uses only one

carrier. This feature doubles the single-user peak rate, as mentioned previously.

Increasing the cell-edge-user throughput

DC-HSDPA+MIMO achieves closed-loop transmit diversity gain on the cell edge,

compared with DC-HSDPA.

DC-HSDPA+MIMO use two carriers and thus doubles the throughput, compared with

SC-HSDPA+MIMO.

Page 180: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 180 of 415

Increasing the cell capacity

DC-HSDPA+MIMO improve the spectrum efficiency within 10 MHz bandwidth and

Huawei simulation testshows that it can increase the system throughput by 10% to 20 %,

compared with DC-HSDPA.

Description

The following figure shows the basic principles of DC-HSDPA+MIMO.

The DC-HSDPA+MIMO feature brings together the performance enhancement benefits of the

two different technologies DC-HSDPA and MIMO.

RAN13.0 supports the configuration of MIMO on one or two carriers to reach the theoretical

peak rate of 63 Mbit/s or 84 Mbit/s respectively.

The PS best effort services are carried over DC-HSDPA+MIMO.

DC-HSDPA+MIMO apply the same principles as DC-HSDPA in load control and mobility

management.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

None

Dependency on NodeB hardware

The BTS3812E and BTS3812AE need to be configured with the EBBI or EDLP board,

and the uplink services cannot be setup on HBBI/HULP board.

The DBS3800 needs to be configured with the EBBC or EBBCd board. In addition, the

DBS3800 supports a maximum of DC+MIMOx1, that is, only one frequency in the

DC-HSDPA cell can be configured with the MIMO feature.

The 3900 series multi-mode base stations need to be configured with the WBBPb or

WBBPd board.

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-010696 DC-HSDPA

Page 181: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 181 of 415

WRFD-010684 2x2 MIMO

Dependency on other NEs

The UE must be of HS-DSCH category 25, 26, 27, or 28.

Differentiated Service Management

2.5.11 WRFD-010694 UL 16QAM

Availability

This feature is available from RAN12.0.

Summary

3GPP Release 7 introduces HSUPA UE category 7, which supports the 16QAM mode and an

UL peak rate of up to 11.5 Mbit/s in theory.

Benefits

The UL system capacity of the HSUPA network is increased.

The peak rate of HSUPA users (UE category 7) is increased.

Description

3GPP R7 introduces UE category 7, which supports the 16QAM mode and an UL peak rate of

up to 11.5 Mbit/s in theory. This is a 100% improvement over the previous 3GPP release of

HSUPA for which the maximum peak rate is 5.74 Mbit/s"

The HSUPA 16QAM improves the UL data transmission performance and increases the

system capacity of HSUPA cells.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

The BTS3812E/BTS3812AE must be configured with the EULPd board.

The DBS3800 supports must be configured with the EBBCd board.

The 3900 series base stations must be configured with the WBBPd board.

Dependency on UE

The UE must be of category 7, category 9.

Page 182: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 182 of 415

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010614 HSUPA Phase 2

2.5.12 WRFD-010695 UL Layer 2 Improvement

Availability

This feature is available from RAN12.0.

Summary

In RAN11.0 or earlier versions, the UL radio link controller (RLC) operates only in fixed

PDU mode. The size of protocol data units (PDUs) is fixed. After UL layer 2 improvement is

introduced, the UL RLC (in UM and AM modes) can operate in flexible PDU or fixed PDU

mode, depending on the higher-layer configuration. When the RLC operates in flexible PDU

mode, it can receive PDUs of flexible sizes so as to decrease the size of UL PDUs and

increase the UL throughput in the case that the UL transmit power of the UE is limited.

Benefits

This feature improves the user peak throughput as well as the uplink throughput in weak

coverage. When the UE moves from the center of the cell to the border of the cell and no

layer 2 improvement is available, the transmit power of the UE is limited if the distance from

the center of the cell reaches a specified value. In such a case, the throughput decreases

sharply, and the transportation may be interrupted. After UL layer 2 improvement is

introduced, the throughput can decrease smoothly because the size of PDUs transmitted by

the UE decreases. Therefore, the transportation is more continuous.

Description

In 3GPP R7, in the downlink, MAC layer segmentation is introduced through the change from

the fixed PDU size to the flexible PDU size for the RLC. Therefore, the DL supports the high

rate, DL layer 2 evolution, and smooth evolution of old protocol formats to new formats.

The UL has similar problems. The PDUs of a fixed size cannot support high rate services

effectively because PDUs of a small size are not applicable to high rate services. Though

PDUs of a large size are applicable to high rate services, the power at the border of the cell is

limited. Moreover, the fixed PDU size may lead to additional padding bits, thus affecting the

transmission efficiency.

UL layer 2 improvement has the following characteristics:

RLC supports flexible RLC PDU sizes.

The MAC layer introduces the MAC-i/is entity. The biggest difference between the

MAC-i/is entity and the MAC-e/es entity is that the MAC-i/is entity supports data

Page 183: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 183 of 415

segmentation and concatenation at the MAC layer and can select an appropriate PDU

size based on the air interface quality to improve the data transmission efficiency.

The RNC can determine whether layer 2 improvement is required according to the UE

capability, cell capability, and active set capability.

The network side supports the handover between the cells with UL layer 2 improvement and

the cells without UL layer 2 improvement.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

For BTS3812E and BTS3812AE, EBBI/EBOI/EULP/EULPd is needed.

For BBU3806,EBBC or EBBCd is needed;For BBU3806C,EBBM is needed.

For BBU3900, WBBPb or WBBPd is needed.

Dependency on UE

The UE need to be compliant with 3GPP Release 8(or later) to support the feature

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

WRFD-010685 Downlink Enhanced L2

2.5.13 WRFD-010696 DC-HSDPA

Availability

This feature is available from RAN12.0.

Summary

The Dual Cell-HSDPA (DC-HSDPA) feature allows the UE to establish connections to two

adjacent inter-frequency same-coverage cells. With this feature, the UE can use the resources

in both cells that operate on different carriers, thus increasing the peak throughput of the UE.

Page 184: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 184 of 415

Benefits

This feature improves the single-user throughput and the cell throughput.

Single-user throughput

After DC-HSDPA is introduced, the throughput is doubled at the center and border of the cell.

Theoretically, DC-HSDPA in 64QAM mode can provide a peak throughput of 42 Mbit/s at the

center of the cell. The gain also shortens the data transmission delay and improves the user

experience.

Cell throughput

After DC-HSDPA is introduced, DC-HSDPA has the cell throughput gain of 5%–10% relative

to the total throughput of the two inter-frequency co-coverage cells. The gain is inversely

proportional to the number of UEs in a cell.

Description Configuration of primary and secondary carriers

When two frequencies, for example, f1 and f2 are used in DC-HSDPA, one DL frequency

serves as the primary carrier and the other as the secondary carrier, which is defined in 3GPP

TR25.825. In the UL, only one frequency is used, which serves as the primary carrier.

Both DC-HSDPA cells are configured with the PCPICH, SCH, PCCPCH, SCCPCH, and

PRACH. Both cells have the basic common channel (CCH) configuration for retaining and

initiating services. The single carrier (SC) UEs can camp or originate a call in each cell.

DC-HSDPA differentiated bearer policy

The CS service, IMS signaling, SRB signaling, or PS conversational service is carried on a

single carrier instead of DC-HSDPA because the amount of data is small and the gain is

insignificant when DC-HSDPA is used.

The BE or streaming service can be carried over the DC-HSDPA. The BE/streaming

combined service is carried over the DC-HSDPA preferentially.

Mobility management

The active set information and measurement reports are sent on the primary carrier during the

handover of DC users. Whether to perform an intra-frequency or inter-frequency handover

depends on the frequencies of the primary carrier and the neighboring cell.

RAN12.0 supports handovers between DC cells, between the DC cell and the SC cell, and

between the DC cell and the system using the other RAT, to ensure seamless roaming of DC

terminals.

State transition in DC-HSDPA

The UE state transition in DC-HSDPA is performed in the same way as the state transition in

SC mode.

Traffic steering in DC-HSDPA

In the original network, R99 services preferentially use f1 and HSPA services use f2. After

DC-HSDPA is introduced, both f1 and f2 can be used for DL DC-HSDPA, and f2 is preferred

for HSUPA. In this way, the UL load on f1 is reduced, without disrupting R99 services.

Page 185: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 185 of 415

If the R99 and HSPA services have the same priority on f1 and f2 in the original network,

traffic steering is kept the same as that of HSPA after DC-HSDPA is introduced.

STTD mode is not supported when activate DC-HSDPA.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

The HBBI and HDLP of the BTS3812E/BTS3812AE do not support DC-HSDPA. To

support DC-HSDPA, the EBBI or EDLP board must be configured.

The BBU3806 with EBBC/EBBCd and the BBU3806C with EBBM support this feature.

The 3900 series base station supports the function when the WBBPb or WBBPd is

configured.

Dependency on UE

The HS-DSCH capabilities are classified into category 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

WRFD-010685 Downlink Enhanced L2

WRFD-010629 DL 16QAM Modulation

2.5.14 WRFD-140203 HSPA+ Uplink 23 Mbit/s per User

Availability

This feature is available from RAN14.0.

Summary

This feature allows a maximum uplink rate of 23 Mbit/s per user by using DC-HSUPA and

16QAM techniques.

Page 186: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 186 of 415

Benefits

The benefits of this feature are as follows:

Improves frequency utilization and increases the uplink peak rate per user.

Provides end users with a high-speed uplink data service experience.

Description

Based on the existing HSUPA peak rate of 11.5 Mbit/s, this feature increases the peak rate to

23 Mbit/s by using DC-HSUPA and 16QAM techniques.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

The RNC must be a BSC6900.

The DPUb or DPUe board must be configured.

In ATM transmission mode, the UOIa or UOIc board must be configured.

In IP transmission mode, the GOUa, FG2A, POUc, FG2c, or GOUc board must be configured.

The following table briefly describes the boards:

Board Name

Description

UOIa 4-port ATM over Unchannelized Optical

STM-1/OC-3c Interface unit REV:a

FG2a 8-port FE or 2-port electronic GE

interface unit REV:a

UOIc 8-port ATM over Unchannelized Optical

STM-1/OC-3c Interface unit REV:c

GOUa 2-port packet over GE Optical interface

Unit REV:a

FG2c 12-port FE or 4-port electronic GE

interface unit REV:c

GOUc 4-port packet over GE Optical interface

Unit REV:c

POUc 4-port IP over channelized Optical

STM-1/OC-3 interface Unit REV:c

Supporting IP over E1/T1 over

SDH/SONET

Page 187: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 187 of 415

Dependency on NodeB

All 3900 series base stations, except the iDBS3900, support this feature. The WBBPd or

WBBPf board must be configured on these base stations.

All DBS3800 series base stations, except the iDBS3800, support this feature. The

EBBCd board must be configured on these base stations.

The BTS3812E and BTS3812AE support this feature. The EULPd board and either the

EBBI or EDLP board must be configured on these base stations.

When 4-way receive diversity is used, a 3900 series base station must be configured. The

configured base station cannot be the iDBS3900 or BTS3902E.

Dependency on the UE

The UE must support E-DPCCH Boosting and DC-HUSPA. The UE must be of HSUPA UE

category 9.

Dependency on other NEs

None

Dependency on the CN

The CN is of 3GPP Release 7 or later to support a maximum uplink rate of 23 Mbit/s or

higher, which is promised at service subscription time.

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-010694 UL 16QAM

WRFD-010697 E-DPCCH Boosting

WRFD-140204 DC-HSUPA

WRFD-010698 HSPA+ Uplink 11.5Mbit/s per User

2.5.15 WRFD-140204 DC-HSUPA

Availability

This feature is available from RAN14.0.

Summary

Introduced in 3GPP Release 9, the feature Dual-Cell High Speed Uplink Packet Access

(DC-HSUPA) allows a UE in the uplink to use two adjacent 5 MHz carriers at the same time.

This increases the peak rate per user for uplink data transmission and the average cell

throughput.

Benefits

The benefits of this feature are as follows:

Increases the uplink peak rate per user.

Increases the cell uplink rate.

Page 188: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 188 of 415

Increases spectral efficiency by using uplink carrier aggregation.

Description

DC-HSUPA enables a UE to perform E-DCH transmission simultaneously on adjacent

carriers of two cells and therefore supports a higher transmission rate.

Each of the two cells enabled with DC-HSUPA can be configured with a common channel,

control channel, and data channel, for example, the P-CPICH, E-DPCCH, and E-DPDCH,

respectively.

This feature depends on DC-HSDPA and the primary DC-HSDPA carrier is configured as the

primary carrier, which transmits uplink HS-DPCCH information. SRB signaling, CS services,

IMS signaling, PS conversational services, as well as combinations of SRB signaling and one

of these three services produce only a small amount of data. Therefore, they are not carried

over DC-HSUPA.

A DC-HSUPA UE determines whether to perform an intra-frequency or inter-frequency

handover based on the measurement report of the primary carrier. If the new serving cell does

not satisfy the DC-HSUPA requirements after the handover, the UE reverts to single-carrier

HSUPA (SC-HSUPA). RAN14.0 supports handovers between DC-HSUPA cells, DC-HSUPA

and SC-HSUPA cells, and DC-HSUPA and other RATs to ensure seamless roaming for

DC-HSDPA UEs.

Figure 2-5-15-1 DC_HSUPA Data Transmission between UE and Node B

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

None

Dependency on NodeB

All 3900 series base stations, except the iDBS3900, support this feature. The WBBPd or

WBBPf board must be configured on these base stations.

Page 189: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 189 of 415

All DBS3800 series base stations, except the iDBS3800, support this feature. The

EBBCd board must be configured on these base stations.

The BTS3812E and BTS3812AE support this feature. The EULPd board and either the

EBBI or EDLP board must be configured on these base stations.

When 4-way receive diversity is used, a 3900 series base station must be configured. The

configured base station cannot be the iDBS3900 or BTS3902E.

Dependency on UE

The UE must be of 3GPP Release 9 or later. The UE must be of HSUPA UE category 8 or

9.

Category-8 UEs support only DC-HSUPA+QPSK. Their peak rate is 11.5 Mbit/s.

Category-9 UEs support DC-HSUPA+16QAM. Their peak rate is 23 Mbit/s.

Dependency on other NEs

None

Dependency on the CN

None

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-010614 HSUPA Phase 2

WRFD-010695 UL Layer 2 Improvement

WRFD-010652 SRB over HSDPA

WRFD-010636 SRB over HSUPA

WRFD-010696 DC-HSDPA

WRFD-010638 Dynamic CE Resource Management

2.6 HSPA+ Performance Improvement

2.6.1 WRFD-010688 Downlink Enhanced CELL-FACH

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R7.

Summary

This feature enables the FACH to be carried on the HS-DSCH. Based on this feature, the UE

can receive data at a higher rate in CELL_FACH state.

Page 190: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 190 of 415

Benefits

This feature enables the UE to transmit data at a higher rate in CELL_FACH state and shorten

the state transition delay of the UE, thereby enhancing the experience of end users in online

state.

Description

Enhanced CELL-FACH is a new feature introduced in R7.

Based on this feature, the UE can receive data on the HS-DSCH at a higher rate in

CELL_FACH state.

After this feature is introduced, the UE is still in CELL_FACH state. This feature is used for

downlink data transmission of the UE. The data carried on the BCCH, CCCH, DCCH, or

DTCH can be mapped to the HS-DSCH and then transmitted to the UE through the HSDPA

shared channel on the Uu interface. In this case, the UE in CELL_FACH state can share

HSDPA code resources and power resources as the UE in CELL_DCH does, thus

implementing downlink high-speed data transmission and shortening the state transition delay

of the UE. This feature enhances the traditional CELL-FACH that is used for only low-speed

(32 kbit/s) data transmission. In R7, the UE incapable of enhanced CELL-FACH uses the

traditional CELL-FACH to receive data, and the UE capable of enhanced CELL-FACH uses

the enhanced CELL-FACH to receive data if the cell on which the UE camps supports the

enhanced CELL-FACH.

To enable the UE to receive data from the HS-DSCH in CELL_FACH state, UTRAN adds

HS-DSCH receiving parameters in CELL_FACH state to the system broadcast information.

The parameters include HS-SCCH configuration, HS-PDSCH configuration, and common

H-RNTI identifier.

When the cell is configured with HS-DSCH receiving, the UE preferentially uses the

HS-DSCH to receive dedicated signaling data carried on the FACH in CELL_FACH state

instead of on the SCCPCH.

The UE in CELL_FACH state keeps monitoring the HS-SCCH. If any data is available, the

UE automatically receives data from the HS-DSCH without state handover from the FACH to

DCH, thus avoiding the delay caused by the state handover.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

HBBI、HDLP on BTS3812E/BTS3812AE do not support this feature, EBBI, EDLP is

needed.

BBU3806 does not support this feature, EBBC or EBBCd is needed. EBBM is needed

by BBU3806C to support this feature.

3900 series NodeB: WBBPa does not support this feature, WBBPb or WBBPd is needed.

Page 191: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 191 of 415

Dependency on other RAN software functions

WRFD-010685 Downlink Enhanced L2

Dependency on other NEs

The UE must be Release 7 (or later) UE and support this feature.

2.6.2 WRFD-010700 Performance Improvement of MIMO and HSDPA Co-carrier

Availability

This feature is available from RAN12.0.

Summary

The performance of MIMO cells configured with Spatial Time Transmit Diversity (STTD)

deteriorates obviously, because the receivers of legacy HSDPA-supportive UEs fall back from

equalizer to rake. At an early phase of MIMO deployment, a large number of legacy

HSDPA-supportive UEs are in use on networks. In the MIMO and HSDPA co-carrier case, the

deterioration in system performance has become the greatest obstacle to commercial launch of

MIMO.

To solve the preceding problem and improve the MIMO and HSDPA co-carrier performance,

Huawei develops PSP-based MIMO, where PSP refers to the Primary/Secondary common

Pilot mode.

Benefits

This feature solves performance deterioration in networks where STTD is employed and

legacy HSDPA-enabled UEs are used. This feature helps implement the MIMO and HSDPA

co-carrier deployment.

With this feature, MIMO and HSDPA can be properly deployed on the same carrier so that

frequency resources are saved.

Description

MIMO-supportive UEs estimate the characteristics of channels transmitted from each antenna,

based on the Common Pilot Channel (CPICH). In a cell, signals are transmitted over the

CPICH in two modes: STTD on the Primary CPICH (P-CPICH) and PSP.

In STTD mode, the receivers of legacy HSDPA-supportive UEs fall back from equalizer to

rake. This causes obvious deterioration in the system performance.

This feature adopts PSP-based MIMO to improve the MIMO and HSDPA co-carrier

performance. The key techniques involved are PSP, Intelligent Interference Control (IIC), and

Virtual Antenna Mapping (VAM).

Page 192: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 192 of 415

PSP is applied in MIMO mode. The P-CPICH is configured on one antenna and the S-CPICH

is configured on the other antenna so that diversity is prevented. The P-CPICH and S-CPICH

are used for channel estimation of MIMO users. In this way, the receivers of

HSDPA-supportive UEs do not fall back from equalizer to rake.

If PSP is enabled, the signals transmitted from the secondary antenna are unknown to

HSDPA-supportive UEs, and therefore the receivers of the UEs cannot suppress the multipath

interface caused by the signals from the secondary antenna. In this case, the system

performance deteriorates. To solve this problem, IIC is applied. IIC monitors the percentage

of each type of UE in a cell in an intelligent manner and dynamically adjusts the available

power that is allocated to MIMO users and HSDPA users. In this way, IIC controls the

interference caused by the signals from the secondary antenna to the signals of legacy

HSDPA-supportive UEs.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

This feature is only supported by 40W RRU3801C, RRU3804, RRU3806, RRU3808,

WRFU, RRU3805, WRFUd, RRU3828, RRU3829, RRU3928, RRU3929, MRFUd,

MRFUe and 850M/900M/1900M RRU3908V1

BTS3812E/AE cannot support this feature.

Dependency on UE

The UE must be support 2x2 MIMO. That is, the UE category must be category 15, 16, 17, or

18 as defined by 3GPP

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Page 193: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 193 of 415

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

WRFD-010685 Downlink Enhanced L2

WRFD-010684 2x2 MIMO

2.6.3 WRFD-010686 CPC - DTX / DRX

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R7.

Summary

This feature is related to uplink DTX and downlink DRX. This feature can reduce the

interference between UEs and improve the HSPA+ user capacity per cell.

Benefits

This feature can improve the always online experience of end users, increase the system

capacity, and save the battery consumption of the UE.

Description

Discontinuous Transmission (DTX)/Discontinuous Reception (DRX) are the key features of

the CPC, which consists of DTX in the uplink and DRX in the downlink.

Uplink DTX means that the UE automatically makes discontinuous transmission on the

DPCCH according to a certain pattern when there is no transmission on the EDCH and the

HS-DPCCH in the uplink. The UL DPCCH DTX pattern is configured by SRNC to on one

hand minimize the transmission on DPCCH and on the other hand maintain the physical

uplink synchronization between Node B and UE by periodically sending. Uplink DTX

reduces the noise raised by the DPCCH in the uplink and also reduces the redundant signal on

the DPCCH.

Downlink DRX is implemented on the basis of Uplink DTX. Downlink DRX means that the

UE receives data on the HS-SCCH according to the transport pattern that RNC configures,

and thus the UE need not detect the HS-SCCH in the period when no data would be sent

according to the pattern.

Enhancement

None.

Page 194: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 194 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

For the BTS3812E, BTS3812A and BTS3812AE, the EBBI, EBOI, EULP/EULPd

(supporting uplink DTX), and EDLP (supporting downlink DRX) should be configured.

For the BBU3806, the EBBC/EBBCd should be configured. For the BBU3806C, the

EBBM should be configured.

For the BBU3900, the WBBPb/WBBPd should be configured.

Dependency on UE

The UE must be Release-7 (or later) to support this feature.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010652 SRB over HSDPA

WRFD-010636 SRB over HSUPA

2.6.4 WRFD-010687 CPC - HS-SCCH less operation

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R7.

Summary

This feature is related to HS-SCCH less operation. This feature can increase the capacity of

downlink data services.

Benefits

This feature can increase the capacity of downlink data services.

Description

The HS-SCCH Less HS-DSCH Transmission (HS-SCCH Less Operation for short)

mechanism means that the HS-DSCH need not be accompanied by the HS-SCCH when

sending the predefined small transport blocks, and the HARQ retransmission for the first

Page 195: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 195 of 415

HS-DSCH transmission requires the company of the HS-SCCH. This is one of the key

features of the CPC.

HS-SCCH Less HS-DSCH Transmission only applies to the UE in CELL_DCH state when

the F-DPCH is configured but the DCH is not configured in the UL and DL directions

(actually the uplink is more concerned). This mechanism can be initiated without DTX/DRX,

that is, HS-SCCH Less HS-DSCH Transmission and DTX/DRX are independent of each

other.

In addition, HS-SCCH Less Operation has the following features:

Supports the QPSK modulation only.

Supports only four predefined transport formats (MAC-hs PDU).

Provides four semi-static transport formats for UEs.

HS-PDSCH CRC is 24 bit and UE-specific (HS-PDSCH CRC is the same as HS-SCCH

CRC; therefore, HS-PDSCH CRC contains a 16-bit H-RNTI).

Allocates up to two predefined HS-PDSCH codes to each UE:

− The predefined HS-PDSCH codes are allocated to the UE in semi-static state.

− The UE can receive HS-SCCH Less HS-DSCH Transmission at any time on one or

two codes, and can perform blind detection in four formats.

− The UE must keep cyclic buffer for 13 continuous TTIs for blind detection of the

HS-PDSCH codes.

The UE does not send the NACK for the first transmission but it sends the ACK/NACK

for retransmission.

Limitations of HARQ:

− Two retransmissions

− Predefined redundancy version (not configurable)

HARQ retransmission of HS-SCCH Less HS-DSCH Transmission should accompany

the HS-SCCH by using the same channel codes and encoding modes between Release 5

and Release 6. Some bits, however, may change their meanings and inform the UE of the

following information:

− The HS-SCCH is used for HS-SCCH Less Operation.

− The retransmission is the first or the second one.

− The channel codes and TB size used by HARQ.

− HARQ combined information, which uses the offset of current TTI to indicate the

position where the information has been sent.

The UE keeps attempting to receive data from the HS-SCCH in a traditional sense.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

Page 196: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 196 of 415

NA

Dependency on UE

The UE must be Release-7 (or later) to support this feature.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010652 SRB over HSDPA

WRFD-010636 SRB over HSUPA

2.6.5 WRFD-010697 E-DPCCH Boosting

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0.

Summary

This feature uses the E-DCH dedicated physical control channel (E-DPCCH) instead of the

DPCCH as the reference channel for channel estimation during HSUPA demodulation. This

feature helps reduce the SIR requirement of the DPCCH and increase the rates of HSUPA

services.

Benefits

This feature together with uplink 16QAM increases uplink rates to the theoretical peak rate

11.5 Mbit/s instead of less than 8 Mbit/s due to SIR target limitation of the DPCCH.

Description

E-DPCCH boosting is introduced in 3GPP Release 7.

This technique is a prerequisite for uplink 16QAM to increase uplink rates because a higher

rate requires more accurate channel estimation.

Traditionally, the DPCCH is selected as the reference channel for channel estimation. The

DPCCH, however, cannot meet the power requirement in the case of high-speed transmission

bursts in the uplink. This is because the DPCCH power is affected by outer-loop power

control, and therefore delay exists in the power adjustment. Also, the SIR target of the

DPCCH is limited. These limitations of the DPCCH adversely affect the accuracy of channel

estimation.

To solve this limitation, the E-DPCCH boosting technique increases the transmit power of

E-DPCCH and uses the E-DPCCH for channel estimation. The boosting technique can lower

the requirement for DPCCH SIR.The E-DPCCH can increase the accuracy of channel

Page 197: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 197 of 415

estimation because its transmit power is not limited. In this way, this feature improves the

reception quality of uplink high-speed services.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

None

Dependency on NodeB hardware

The BTS3812E and BTS3812AE need to be configured with the EULPd board, and the

downlink services cannot be setup on HBBI/HDLP/NDLP board.

The DBS3800 needs to be configured with the EBBCd board.

The 3900 series multi-mode base stations need to be configured with the WBBPd board.

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

Dependency on other NEs

The UE must be Release-7 (or later) to support the boosting technique.

2.6.6 WRFD-010701 Uplink Enhanced CELL_FACH

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0.

Summary

This feature enables the random access channel (RACH) to be mapped onto the E-DCH

Dedicated Physical Data Control Channel (E-DPDCH). With this feature, UEs in the

CELL_FACH state can transmit uplink data at higher rates.

Benefits

This feature improves the "always-on" experience by providing high-speed uplink data

transmission for UEs in the CELL_FACH state and shortening the UE state transition and

service setup delay.

Compared with the traditional CELL_FACH state, the service setup delay for a UE to transit

from idle mode to the CELL_DCH state and the UE state transition delay from CELL_FACH

to CELL_DCH can be shortened by more than 50%.

Page 198: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 198 of 415

Description

Enhanced uplink for the CELL_FACH state is introduced in 3GPP Release 8.

This feature enables UEs in idle mode or the CELL_FACH state to use the E-DPDCH for data

transmission at higher rates. Higher rates are achieved because the RACH is mapped onto the

E-DPCH instead of the physical random access channel (PRACH). In contrast to the PRACH,

which provides 20 ms TTI and 8 kbit/s, the E-DPCH provides 2 ms or 10 ms TTI. This feature

can increase the maximum transmission rate, theoretically, to 5.76 Mbit/s.

In addition, this feature uses the E-AI (Extended AI) to support more signature sequences. As

a result, the probability that UEs compete for uplink transmission resources is lower, and the

user experience is improved.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

None

Dependency on NodeB hardware

The BTS3812E, BTS3812A, and BTS3812AE need to be configured with the EULPd,

EBBI, EBOI, or EULP board. The downlink services cannot be setup on

HBBI/HDLP/NDLP board.

The BBU3806 must be configured with the EBBC/EBBCd board. To support the E-AI,

the BBU3806 must be configured with the EBBCd board.

The BBU3900 must be configured with the WBBPb/WBBPd board. To support the E-AI,

the BBU3900 must be configured with the WBBPd board.

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-010652 SRB over HSDPA

WRFD-010636 SRB over HSUPA

WRFD-010695 UL Layer 2 Improvement

WRFD-010688 Downlink Enhanced CELL_FACH

Dependency on other NEs

The UE must be Release-8 (or later) UE and support uplink for CELL_FACH enhancement

state.

2.6.7 WRFD-010653 96 HSDPA Users per Cell

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

Page 199: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 199 of 415

Summary

This feature enables a single HSDPA cell to simultaneously support 96 HSDPA VoIP or other

low-rate users.

Benefits

This feature enables the system to serve more HSDPA users.

Description

In RAN11.0, a single cell can support up to 96 HSDPA users in VoIP or other low-rate

applications. The UE must support CPC-DTX/DRX. With this feature, the operator can

increase the voice service capacity per cell and provide services for more VoIP or low-rate

users in dense areas.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

In order to support this feature

EBBI, EBOI, EULP, EULPd is needed for BTS3812E and BTS3812AE.

EBBC, EBBCd is needed for BBU3806; EBBM is needed for BBU3806C.

WBBPb, WBBPd is needed for BBU3900.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010623 64 HSDPA Users per Cell

WRFD-010686 CPC - DTX / DRX

Page 200: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 200 of 415

2.6.8 WRFD-010639 96 HSUPA Users per Cell

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

Summary

This feature enables a single HSUPA cell to simultaneously support 96 HSUPA VoIP or other

low-rate users. This feature can increase the capacity of voice services or other low-rate

services per cell.

Benefits

This feature allows more HSUPA users in one cell and improves the system capacity.

Description

In RAN11.0, a single cell can support up to 96 HSUPA users in VoIP or other low-rate

applications. The UE must support CPC-DTX/DRX.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

In order to support this feature

EBBI, EBOI, EULP, EULPd is needed for BTS3812E and BTS3812AE.

EBBC, EBBCd is needed for BBU3806; EBBM is needed for BBU3806C.

WBBPb, WBBPd is needed for BBU3900.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010634 60 HSUPA Users per Cell

Page 201: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 201 of 415

WRFD-010653 96 HSDPA Users per Cell

2.6.9 WRFD-010654 128 HSDPA Users per Cell

Availability

This feature is available from RAN12.0.

Summary

This feature enables a single HSDPA cell to support a maximum of 128 HSDPA users

simultaneously.

Benefits

This feature increases the maximum number of HSDPA users that can be supported in a cell.

This is particularly useful when most calls use low rate services (such as VoIP over HSPA), as

the number of such calls can be quite larger than with high data rate services.

Description

With this feature, a maximum of 128 HSDPA users can be supported in one cell. This can be

especially useful to increase the system capacity for VoIP services or other low-rate services

which can be established simultaneously over HSDPA. For such services, it may be necessary

to use also the Continuous Packet Connectivity (CPC) feature, to reduce the radio resources

required by each user. This feature improves the CS traffic capacity of a single cell and

provides VoIP services or other low-rate services to more users.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

The feature is only available for 3900 series NodeB, 3900 series NodeB (except BTS3902E)

requires WBBPd2/WBBPd3 board which is one type of WBBPd.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

Page 202: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 202 of 415

WRFD-010653 96 HSDPA Users per Cell

WRFD-010670 128 HSUPA Users per Cell

2.6.10 WRFD-010670 128 HSUPA Users per Cell

Availability

This feature is available from RAN12.0.

Summary

This feature enables a single HSUPA cell to support a maximum of 128 HSUPA users

simultaneously.

Benefits

This feature increases the maximum number of HSUPA users that can be supported in a cell.

This is particularly useful when most calls use low rate services (such as VoIP over HSPA), as

the number of such calls can be quite larger than with high data rate services.

Description

With this feature, a maximum of 128 HSUPA users can be supported in one cell. This can be

especially useful to increase the system capacity for VoIP services or other low-rate services

which can be established simultaneously over HSUPA. For such services, it may be necessary

to use also the Continuous Packet Connectivity (CPC) feature, to reduce the radio resources

required by each user. This feature improves the CS traffic capacity of a single cell and

provides VoIP services or other low-rate services to more users.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

The feature is only available for 3900 series NodeB, 3900 series NodeB (except BTS3902E)

requires WBBPd2/WBBPd3 board which is one type of WBBPd.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

Page 203: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 203 of 415

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010639 96 HSUPA Users per Cell

WRFD-010654 128 HSDPA Users per Cell

2.6.11 WRFD-010704 Flexible HSPA+ Technology Selection

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0.

Summary

This feature allows dynamic selection of DC-HSDPA or MIMO for newly admitted users

according to the number of HSDPA users (including SC-HSDPA and DC-HSDPA users) and

the downlink load status.

Benefits

This feature selects DC-HSDPA or MIMO for newly admitted users according to the number

of HSDPA users and the downlink load status. This allows users to obtain the optimum bearer

mode and the highest possible throughput.

Description

DC-HSDPA and MIMO provide differing benefits in different scenarios: Carrying traffic over

DC-HSDPA when the number of HSPDA users is low and cell load is light provides relatively

high throughput. Likewise, carrying traffic over MIMO when the number of HSDPA users is

high and cell load is heavy also provides relatively high throughput.

Under DC-HSDPA networking scenarios, one or two carriers may simultaneously support

MIMO depending on the configuration by the operator. The number of HSDPA users and the

downlink load carried on each carrier change over time. The optimum bearer mode varies in

different circumstances. In scenarios supporting both of these technologies, this feature allows

dynamic selection of DC-HSDPA or MIMO for newly admitted users according to the current

number of HSDPA users and the downlink load carried on the two carriers. This allows users

to use the best relative HSPA+ technology and experience high throughput in different

scenarios, thereby improving the user experience.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on the RNC hardware

None

Dependency on the NodeB hardware

Page 204: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 204 of 415

BTS3812E, BTS3812A, and BTS3812AE should configure EBBI, EBOI, and EDLP

boards. In addition, uplink services cannot be established on HBBI or HULP boards.

The BBU3806 of the DBS3800 must configure the EBBC or EBBCd board, and

BBU3806C must add support for the EBBM board.

The 3900 series base stations must configure WBBPb or WBBPd boards.

Huawei BTS RF modules support only one transmission channel. MIMO requires

interconnection of two RF modules.

Dependency on the UE

UEs must be HSDPA category 21 or higher. That is: HSDPA category 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26,

27, 28

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-010696 DC-HSDPA

WRFD-010684 2×2 MIMO

2.6.12 WRFD-010713 Traffic-Based Activation and Deactivation of the Supplementary Carrier In Multi-carrier

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0.

Summary

This feature requires the downlink service of the user is carried on DC-HSDPA or

DC-HSDPA+MIMO and the uplink service is carried on DC or SC-HSUPA. It can deactivate

the supplementary carrier of a UE when the traffic volume to be processed by the UE is low.

When the traffic volume rises, the supplementary carrier can then be activated, the user

becomes dual-carrier user again.

Benefits

Compared with the dual-carrier transmission, because only prime carrier is demodulated by

the UE, the transmission power of HS-DPCCH can be reduced, which decreasing the uplink

transmission load as well.

Taking DC-HSDPA as an example, in the scenario of a large amount of users and low traffic

in the downlink, and the penetration rate of DC-HSDPA terminal is 100%, deactivating the

secondary carrier can theoretically reduce the uplink load by 5% to 10%.

Description

The NodeB decides whether to deactivate the secondary carrier of a UE based on the amount

of data to be transmitted by the UE and the throughput of the UE. Given a small amount of

data and low throughput, the NodeB deactivates the secondary carrier and sends an HS-SCCH

order to notify the UE of the deactivation. When the amount of data becomes large or the

Page 205: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 205 of 415

throughput becomes high, the NodeB activates the secondary carrier and sends an HS-SCCH

order to notify the UE of the activation.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

None

Dependency on NodeB hardware

None

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-010696 DC-HSDPA

Dependency on other NEs

To support DC-HSDPA, the UE must be of HS-DSCH category 21, 22, 23, or 24.

To support DC-HSDPA+MIMO, the UE must be of HS-DSCH category 25, 26, 27, or

28.

2.6.13 WRFD-010702 Enhanced DRX

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0.

Summary

The enhanced discontinuous reception (DRX) feature enables UEs in the enhanced

CELL_FACH state to receive the high-speed downlink shared channel (HS-DSCH)

discontinuously. This feature helps UEs that process a small amount of services to save power,

by changing the state of such UEs to the enhanced CELL_FACH state.

Benefits

In the enhanced CELL_FACH state, a UE that discontinuously receives the HS-DSCH

consumes less power than a UE that continuously detects the HS-SCCH and continuously

receives the HS-DSCH.

Description

Continuous connectivity (CPC) for packet data users is introduced in 3GPP Release 7. CPC

incorporates the DRX technique that helps HSPA UEs in the CELL_DCH state save power.

Enhanced DRX is introduced in 3GPP Release 8 to further save UE power when the UE is in enhanced CELL_FACH state. After this feature is enabled, the RAN and UEs in the enhanced

Page 206: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 206 of 415

CELL_FACH state transmit and receive data at a specified time. The UE detects the

HS-SCCH at regular intervals instead of detecting the HS-SCCH continuously. When there is

no data to transmit, the UE shuts down the receiver. As a result, the power consumption of the

UE decreases.

If enhanced DRX is enabled and the RAN has data to transmit to the UE, the data is

transmitted only at user-specified times, which leads to a slight increase in transmission delay.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

None

Dependency on NodeB hardware

The BTS3812E, BTS3812A, and BTS3812AE need to be configured with the EULPd,

EBBI, EBOI, or EULP board.

The BBU3806 needs to be configured with the EBBC or EBBCd board. The BBU3806C

needs to be configured with the EBBM board.

The BBU3900 needs to be configured with the WBBPb or WBBPd board.

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-010688 Enhanced CELL_FACH

Dependency on other NEs

The UE must be Release-8 (or later) UE and support enhanced Enhanced DRX.

HSPA+ Downlink 42Mbit/s per User

Page 207: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 207 of 415

3 Smart MBB

3.1 Smart Phone Solution

3.1.1 WRFD-020500 Enhanced Fast Dormancy

Availability

This feature is available from RAN12.0.

Summary

This feature is concerned with the impact of Fast Dormancy to the RNC. To reduce the

signaling processing cost in the Fast Dormancy procedure, when receiving SCRI (signaling

connection release indication) message from UE or UE inactivity timer expires, RNC can

transfer UE state to CELL/URA_PCH instead of IDLE mode which is in legacy Fast

Dormancy processing.

Benefits

This feature can reduce the signal processing cost of RNC in a network comprised of

intelligent UEs with FAST DORMANCY capable, thus avoid overflow of signaling

processing unit in RNC caused by Fast Dormancy.

Description

Some intelligent UEs support Fast dormancy function. To save the power, when there is no PS

data transfer, UE can send a SCRI message to require RNC release the RRC connection and

then periodically send heartbeat message to the core network, without implementation of this

feature, RNC will release the RRC connection, then each of the following heartbeat messages

will cause RRC connection setup, authentication, encryption and RAB setup procedures.

Comparing to normal PS call procedure, this Fast dormancy mechanism will greatly increase

the signaling processing cost of RNC and may cause overflow of signaling processing unit in

RNC.

With this feature, when receiving SCRI from UE or UE inactivity timer expires, RNC will

decided to transfer the state of the UE to CELL/URA_PCH instead of IDLE mode. When UE

periodically sends heartbeat message, RNC will reconfigure UE to CELL_FACH or

CELL_DCH. The signaling procedure between UE and RNC will be limited to only a few

message exchanges because the RRC connection keep existing, at least 40% signaling

Page 208: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 208 of 415

exchange can be reduced and RNC CPU resources can be saved significantly while UE

battery consumption is saved as much as that in IDLE mode.

When receiving SCRI message, if one of the following condition is met, RNC will look the

UE as FAST DORMANCY capable, initial this feature and transfer UE to CELL/URA_PCH

state:

IMEI of the UE belongs to the range of IMEIs defined by operator configuration

RNC can get the IMEI of the UE by sending a “IDENTITY REQUEST” to UE and get UE

response;

Because the producer and model information are included in IMEI, operator can configure the

range of IMEIs with FAST DORMANCY function.

The cause value in SCRI message is "UE Requested PS Data session end."

When UE inactivity timer expires, if IMEI of the UE belongs to the range of IMEIs defined

by operator configuration, the UE will be transferred to CELL/URA_PCH state instead of

IDLE state.

Pls be aware that when SCRI without cause value was sent and smart phone will be

transferred to CELL/URA_PCH state which might have the risk of incompatibility. In this

case, we strongly suggest providing the feature together with Huawei professional services.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

Page 209: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 209 of 415

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

3.1.2 WRFD-140205 iPhone Voice Experience Improvement

Availability

This feature is available from RAN14.0.

Summary

Considering the characteristics of the current radio frequency (RF) system and antenna system

of the iPhone 3, iPhone 3GS, and iPhone 4, this feature enables the RNC to identify iPhones

and assign them dedicated radio performance parameters, including radio link power control

parameters and handover parameters.

Benefits

This feature provides the following benefits:

It reduces the call drop rate of iPhones in weak coverage areas.

It reduces call drops or handover failures caused by signal quality fluctuations in the

overlapping area of two cells when an iPhone performs an inter-RAT handover at a

designated threshold.

Description

The various iPhone models differ from other vendor phones in the following ways:

The receiver sensitivity of the iPhone 3 or iPhone 3GS is relatively weak.

The antenna receive performance of the iPhone 4 is negatively affected by human body

capacitance when the user is holding the unit, and as a result the receiver sensitivity

decreases.

Therefore, iPhone users are more likely to experience call drops, network disconnections, and

unsatisfactory CS voice services than other cell phone users. Considering the large number of

iPhones in the network, it is important to improve user experience of iPhone users.

This feature enables performance compensation for iPhones on the network side as follows:

Page 210: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 210 of 415

For CS voice services, the RNC performs a new international mobile equipment identity

(IMEI) acquisition procedure. During the procedure, the RNC detects the IMEI tracking

area code (TAC), which is then used to identify the unit as an iPhone.

The RNC configures specific power control and handover parameters for the iPhone.

Based on the parameter settings, the iPhone obtains a high downlink power control

threshold in weak coverage areas and performs handovers at the designated threshold.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

None

Dependency on NodeB hardware

None

Dependency on other RAN features

None

Dependency on other NEs

None

Dependency on the UE

None

Dependency on the CN

None

3.1.3 WRFD-140206 Layered Paging in URA_PCH

Availability

This feature is available from RAN14.0.

Summary

Due to the rapid rise of smart phone use in recent years, PS paging messages have accounted

for an increasingly large proportion of paging messages. Conventionally, PS paging messages

are sent to the entire UTRAN registration area (URA). Once Layered Paging is activated, PS

paging messages are sent to the last cell on which a UE camped, the neighboring cell of the

last cell, or the URA. This reduces the number of paging messages and the possibility of PCH

congestion.

Benefits

The benefits of this feature are as follows:

Page 211: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 211 of 415

Reduced number of paging messages and signaling overhead, compared with the paging

in idle mode.

Decrease the number of cell update for UE transmission between cells and increase the

capability of common channel.

Description

The RNC transits UEs processing PS services to the URA_PCH state instead of the

CELL_PCH state to prolong the time users are online and reduce high signaling overheads

caused by frequent state transitions from the idle mode to another state. However, the RNC

must page a UE in the URA_PCH state in the entire URA because the RNC does not know

which cell the UE camps on. This results in a large number of unnecessary paging messages,

which can in turn lead to PCHs being congested, especially with the continuously increasing

number of smart phones in use.

This feature enables the RNC to firstly page the UE in the last cell on which the UE camped

and the neighboring cells. If the RNC still does not receive any response from the UE, the

RNC pages the UE in the URA.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

None

Dependency on NodeB

None

Dependency on UE

None

Dependency on other NEs

None

Dependency on CN

None

Dependency on other RAN features

None

Page 212: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 212 of 415

3.2 Smart Pipe

3.2.1 WRFD-020132 Web Browsing Acceleration

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0.

Summary

This feature enables detection of web page accesses and allocation of higher downlink

bandwidth, reducing delay in loading web pages.

Benefits

This feature decreases the time users spend waiting for web pages to load, significantly

improving the user experience.

Description

Web browsing is the most widely used data service. Users expect to be able to quickly load

web pages at any time or place. In traditional mobile telecommunication systems, however,

multiple services coexist and equally compete for limited bandwidth resources. Bandwidth is

not allocated preferentially to web page access, making it difficult for users to enjoy

high-quality, low-delay web browsing. During high-traffic hours, web access is frequently

impacted by other services and users experience high levels of delay.

This feature recognizes web browsing services by using service awareness technique and then

preferentially allocates higher bandwidth to these services. As a result, the load time for web

pages decreases and the user experience improves.

This feature is applicable to web page access acceleration where HSDPA users take priority

over other users and combined services over other services.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

NIUa board is required

Dependency on NodeB hardware

BTS3812E/BTS3812AE series base station should be configured with EBBI/EDLP;

HBBI and HDLP cannot support this feature.

DBS3800 series base station should be configured with EBBC/EBBCd; HBBU cannot

support this feature.

3900 series base station should be configured with WBBPb or WBBPd; WBBPa cannot

support this feature.

Page 213: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 213 of 415

Dependency on other RAN features

None

Dependency on other NEs

None

3.2.2 WRFD-020133 P2P Downloading Rate Control during Busy Hour

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0.

Summary

This feature enables the detection of P2P download services and rate restrictions on P2P

services when the system load is high. When the system load is low, the rate of P2P download

services is not restricted.

Benefits

As high-bandwidth mobile telecommunication systems grow rapidly, more and more users are

using P2P services to download music or video. Due to its high volume and long duration,

P2P traffic consumes a large amount of system resources. This significantly increases

operating costs and adversely affects the quality of other delay-sensitive services.

This feature restricts P2P traffic during busy hours, thereby reducing operating costs and

improving the user experience of other delay-sensitive services. During non-busy hours, P2P

downloads are not restricted and P2P users can enjoy high speeds and make full use of

network resources.

Description

In the traditional P2P flow control scheme, the maximum rate restriction is set on the CN side.

The limitation of this scheme is that radio resources cannot be fully utilized when the traffic

load of the system is low.

This feature recognizes the P2P download traffic by using service awareness technique. When

the system load is high, rate restriction limits the rate of P2P download services to release the

occupied resources for other services. When the system load is low, resources for P2P are

unrestricted and P2P services are still able to engage in high speed downloads. This allows

multiple users and services to fully utilize network resources.

This feature is applicable to P2P rate restriction where HSDPA users take priority over other

users and combined services over other services.

Enhancement

None

Page 214: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 214 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

NIUa board is required.

Dependency on NodeB hardware

BTS3812E/BTS3812AE series base station should be configured with EBBI/EDLP;

HBBI and HDLP cannot support this feature.

DBS3800 series base station should be configured with EBBC/EBBCd; HBBU cannot

support this feature.

3900 series base station should be configured with WBBPb or WBBPd; WBBPa cannot

support this feature.

Dependency on other RAN features

None

Dependency on other NEs

None

Page 215: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 215 of 415

4 Green

4.1 Power Consumption Saving

4.1.1 WRFD-020116 Dynamic Power Sharing in Multi-Carriers

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

Summary

This feature enables power sharing between carriers to improve the utilization of power

resources. In RAN11.0, the Node B allows the carrier carrying HSDPA services to share the

unused power resources of another carrier carrying R99 services.

Benefits

This feature can improve the network performance and the utilization of the existing

equipment. The simulation shows that with dynamic power sharing of two carriers, the

capacity of the HSDPA cell increases by 5% to 6%.

Description

Dynamic Power Sharing of Multi-Carriers means that among multiple carriers, the carrier

bearing HSPA service can dynamically share the unused power resource of another carrier.

This function increases the utilization of the power amplifier as well as the HSPA service rate

of the cell. For asymmetrical power configuration, the carrier with higher emitting power can

not share the unused power resource of the carrier with lower emitting power.

RAN11.0 supports the power sharing of two carriers. When one carrier is for R99 and the

other is for HSDPA, the HSDPA carrier can determine in real time the power to be used

according to the power used by the R99 carrier.

The simulation shows that with dynamic power sharing of two carriers, the capacity of the

HSDPA cell increases by 5% to 6%.

Enhancement

None.

Page 216: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 216 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

4.1.2 WRFD-020117 Multi-Carrier Switch off Based on Traffic Load

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

Summary

When the network is idle or traffic load is very low, this feature enables the RNC to switch off

one or more carriers in the same coverage area to reduce the power consumption of the Node

B.

Benefits

This feature optimizes the energy-efficiency by disabling the idle carriers; this feature brings

the following benefits:

Reduce the negative impact on environment

Save the TCO for operator

Description

In terms of power consumption assessment of the products in mobile networks, it shows that

the radio access network (and particularly the Base Stations) is the highest contributor of

power consumption and CO2 emissions in the use phase.

Page 217: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 217 of 415

If there are multi carriers running in the same coverage area, Huawei provides operators with

adaptive carriers’ power management to reduce the power consumption. The traffic volume is

different at different times. For example, the Node B in the Central Business District (CBD)

has relative high traffic volume in the daytime which requires more than one carrier to serve

all the subscribers, but from midnight to early morning of the next day the traffic volume is

relative low. In RAN10.0, during idle periods which are configurable for operator, the RNC

can dynamically shut down the carrier which has no subscriber and the other carriers in the

same area are in normal status. The carrier will be turned on again while the traffic volume in

the other carriers enters into LDR status or the idle periods ends. The energy can be saved in

this way.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

4.1.3 WRFD-020118 Energy Efficiency Improved

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

Summary

Based on the high efficient power amplification techniques, RAN11.0 introduces dynamic

adjustment of the power amplification parameters to further improve the power amplification

efficiency upon low load. The Node B adjusts the Power Amplifier (PA) bias voltage based on

the output power that varies with the traffic load, thus improving the PA efficiency and

reducing the static PA power consumption.

Page 218: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 218 of 415

Benefits

The energy-saving and less power consumption feature of the system has become a major

concern of the operators. The improved energy efficiency of the PA, the major component of

the Node B, reduces the power consumption of the entire Node B. Therefore, this feature

helps to save OPEX of the operator and is environment-friendly.

In addition, it lowers the requirements for basic power supply and heat dissipation of

equipment and reduces the difficulty in component selection. This greatly improves the

reliability of equipment.

Description

Huawei provides operators with various effective solutions to reduce the power consumption,

among which the key solution is to reduce the power consumption of the PA.

The RF module uses the Digital Pre-Distortion (DPD) technology and A-Doherty technology.

Thus, the PA efficiency reaches 40%, and the power consumption of the entire Node B is

greatly decreased.

Based on the high efficient power amplification techniques, RAN11.0 introduces dynamic

adjustment of the power amplification parameters to further improve the power amplification

efficiency upon low load.

In the actual operation of the network, the traffic load changes constantly, and thus the PA

output power of the Node B is changed accordingly. Generally, the PA efficiency is

proportional to the PA output power, that is, the efficiency is higher when the output power is

greater. The PA bias voltage is also proportional to the PA output power. When the PA output

power is great, a high bias voltage is required to protect the linearity of power amplification

so as to reduce the signal distortion. When the traffic load is low, the PA output power

decreases. But if the bias voltage is not adjusted at this time, the PA efficiency will be

decreased because the static power consumption is high. Therefore, the bias voltage can be

decreased along with the PA output power so that the static power consumption can be

decreased and the PA efficiency can be improved.

To improve the power efficiency in low traffic load, Huawei Node B supports the technology

of dynamically adjusting the PA parameters. The PA dynamically adjusts the PA bias voltage

according to the output power, thus improving the PA efficiency and reducing the power

consumption when the output power is low.

The Node B may experience different traffic load in different periods of a day. For example,

the Node Bs in the central business district (CBD), the traffic load is high in the day time but

is very low in the midnight till the morning of the next day. The transmit power of the Node B

varies with the traffic load, and thus the output power of the Node B is low when the traffic is

light. The Node B monitors the traffic load in real time and dynamically adjusts the PA

parameters to improve the PA efficiency when the output power is low. Thus, the energy can

be saved.

Enhancement

RAN11.0 supports dynamical adjustment of the PA parameters only when there is no HSDPA

services. In RAN11.0, the RF module does not support the dynamic adjustment of the PA

parameters if there are any ongoing HSDPA services.

RAN12.0 supports dynamic PA parameter adjustment when the HSDPA service is carried.

Page 219: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 219 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

MTRU for BTS3812E/AE and RRU3801C for Distributed baseband site can not provide this

function, whereas other RF modules support this feature.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

4.1.4 WRFD-020119 Multi-Carrier Switch off Based on Power Backup

Availability

This feature is available from RAN12.0.

Summary

In case of mains failure, the backup power system starts to operate. In this case, this feature

can achieve hierarchical carrier shutdown based on the shutdown duration and cell priority.

Benefits

This feature can reduce the NodeB power consumption and extend the up time of running

batteries in case of mains failure. For batteries, long-time running leads to aging, thus

decreasing the power backup time. This feature, however, can extend the up time of batteries,

so that the aged batteries still meet the requirements of the NodeB for power backup time. In

other words, the service life of batteries is prolonged.

Description

After this feature is enabled, the NodeB can assign priorities to carriers and then shut down

carriers by priority. In case of mains failure, the batteries start to operate. Then, the NodeB is

triggered to shut down the non-reserved and reserved local cells based on the preset shutdown

durations (T1,T2). After the mains failure is rectified, the NodeB automatically restores all the

cells that were shut down.

Page 220: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 220 of 415

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

The BTS3902E doesn’t support this feature.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

Page 221: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 221 of 415

4.1.5 WRFD-020122 Multi-Carrier Switch off Based on QoS

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0.

Summary

In the preconfigured time segments, this feature enables some carriers to be shut down,

ensuring the real-time rate of DCH and high Average Revenue Per User (ARPU) for HSPA

users, and only the GBR rate for low ARPU HSPA users. The purpose is to save power.

This feature is applied in the scenarios of multi-carriers with same coverage.

Benefits

According to an estimate on power consumption in mobile networks, power consumption and

carbon dioxide emission from RAN, especially NodeB, account for the major part of total

consumption. Telecom operators expect that the carriers with the same coverage be shut down

during low-traffic hours (for example, at midnight) to reduce costs.

However, with the rapid development of mobile broadband networks, an increasing number of

low ARPU users often stay connected 24 hours a day to download video and audio files.

Since their real-time rate is always ensured, the actual network load is still heavy even at

midnight, and it is hard to trigger the shutdown of same-coverage carriers.

After this feature is introduced, the real-time rates of DCH and high ARPU HSPA users are

ensured, whereas only the GBR rate is ensured for low ARPU HSPA users. As long as the

total load based on this requirement is below the specified threshold, the same-coverage

carriers can be shut down. This reduces energy consumption and increases the profits of

telecom operators.

Description

For multiple carriers with the same coverage, when the preconfigured time segment begins,

the users in the serving carrier (F2 in the following figure) are handed over to the

same-coverage neighboring carrier (F1 in the following figure). This can only happen if the

available resources plus non-GBR resources of low ARPU HSPA users in F1 meet the load

requirements of the real-time rates of DCH and high ARPU HSPA users as well as the GBR of

low ARPU HSPA users in F2. Then, the F2 can be shut down.

Page 222: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 222 of 415

When F1 comes into the basic congestion state or the preconfigured time segment comes to an

end, F2 is activated again.

In this way, not only the experience of high ARPU users is ensured but also idle carriers can

be shut down, and the profit of theoperators is increased.

The high ARPU and low ARPU users are configured by operators based on the SPI

(Scheduling Priority Indicator), and the GBP (Guaranteed Bit Power) in the above figure

means guaranteed power for GBR rate.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

None

Dependency on NodeB hardware

None

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA introduction package

Dependency on other NEs

None

Page 223: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 223 of 415

4.1.6 WRFD-020121 Intelligent Power Management

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0.

Summary

This feature introduces the function of Power Supply Unit (PSU) intelligent shutdown. With

this feature, certain PSUs can be powered on or off according to the power consumption of

the NodeB, thus reducing the power consumption.

Benefits

The PSU intelligent shutdown function can save about 4% of the electricity expenses for

operators in typical configuration.

Description

A NodeB with AC input is generally configured with multiple PSUs (converting AC into DC).

The number of configured PSUs depends on the maximum power consumption of the NodeB.

The purpose is to ensure that the NodeB operates properly even at the maximum load. In most

cases, the NodeB does not operate at full load, and thus the PSUs do not operate at full power.

Generally, the PSU conversion efficiency is proportional to its output power. In other words,

the decrease in the conversion efficiency increases the overall power consumption of the

NodeB. The following figure takes four configured PSUs as an example to show the

relationship between the PSU conversion efficiency and the PSU output power. As shown in

the figure, the total power of the four PSUs is 6,400 W and high PSU output power leads to

high power conversion efficiency.

When the NodeB is powered by multiple PSUs, the PSU intelligent shutdown function

enables shutting down one or several PSUs according to the actual load and the power supply

Page 224: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 224 of 415

need. This ensures that the Node B is always working at the state when PSUs are in the best

working effeciency. In this way, the remaining PSUs work in full load mode, thus ensuring

their best level of efficiency.

For MBTS scenario, because MBTS of GSM, UMTS and LTE are sharing one PMU, only one

license of GSM, UMTS and LTE is required for MBTS, but if the corresponding network is

down, this fuction will be deactivated for MBTS.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

None

Dependency on NodeB hardware

Only when DBS3900 or BTS3900A is used with APM30 and battery

Dependency on other RAN features

None

Dependency on other NEs

None

Page 225: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 225 of 415

5 Topology & Transmission

5.1 RAN Sharing

5.1.1 WRFD-021304 RAN Sharing Introduction Package

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

This feature enables multiple operators to share the same RAN equipment and have their own

independent cells. The same RAN equipment can provide different operators with rich and

personalized services.

Benefits

The most important and urgent factor for driving operators to share network is the substantial

CAPEX and OPEX saving. Approximately 30%– 40% CAPEX and OPEX can be saved if

RAN is shared. Another advantage is the increased roll-out speed and enlarged coverage-area

that can result in a quick network deployment and a success of UMTS. On the other hand,

reduced independency results in co-operation between operators and some restrictions when

expanding.

Description

There is growing optimism among 3G license holders about the prospects of sharing 3G

network infrastructures. The primary motivation for this sharing is to rapidly launch service

and reduce the costs of deployment, thereby improving the overall financial health of the

industry.

Analysis of a typical 3G Capital Expenditure (CPEX) model reveals that a majority of the

upfront costs are related to establishing coverage (i.e. access related CPEX). As shown in

Figure 2, approximately 70% of the CPEX involves acquiring the sites, access equipment,

civil works (i.e. construction of the site, installation of the equipment) and laying the

transmission network. With 3G, these fundamental implementation issues will be further

complicated by the lack of sites, tighter environmental regulations, and health concerns

regarding the hazards of radiation. In view of these challenges faced by 3G license holders,

shared network infrastructure solutions need to be explored in order to reduce the financial

Page 226: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 226 of 415

risks facing the industry, establish faster universal coverage and thus improve

time-to-revenue.

Since the deployment cost of RAN takes up the most among the total network, so RAN

sharing would be a preferred approach to share the heavy deployment costs for mobile

networks among operators in the roll-out phase and to increase the network utilization. It can

offer advantages for all parties involved in UMTS.

With this feature, all the RAN elements are physically shared, including the RNC, Node Bs,

Sites, and transport equipment. By ‘soft-splitting’ a physical RAN into different logical RANs,

multi-operators can cover the same area with their own frequency with only one physical

RAN. Each operator deploys its own frequency including its own Mobile Network Code

(MNC) and each operator has individually assigned cells. RNC routes the UE according the

cell or MNC&MCC derived from the IMSI and the Network Resource Identify (NRI) derived

from TMSI/P-TMSI, when Iu-Flex is used. The following figure shows the RAN sharing

solution architecture.

Iu interface

RNC

Operator A

CN

Macro

Node B

Iub

interface

Operator B

CN

Shared RAN

RRU

Operator B OSSOperator A OSS

Shared Master OSS

Itf-NIu interface

RNC

Operator A

CN

Macro

Node B

Iub

interface

Operator B

CN

Shared RAN

RRU

Operator B OSSOperator B OSSOperator A OSSOperator A OSS

Shared Master OSS

Itf-N

In RAN sharing architecture, RNC is shared by multiple operators (maximum is 4), and the

CN networks are supplied by operators separately. For the shared RNC, both shared and

non-shared Node B/RNC could be connected. For each operator’s CN network, Iu Flex may

be applied, and the decision could be made independently.

RAN sharing solution does not require any UE release dependency. The call traffic is routed

to appropriate CN network belonging to the operator selected by UE. In the shared RAN,

inter-system handover and intra-system handover within each operator are handled normally.

A switch is supplied to indicate whether intra-system handover between operators would be

allowed. For broadcast service such as CBS and MBMS, the traffics will be restricted in each

operator’s dedicated cells.

Page 227: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 227 of 415

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

Cannot work with WRFD-021311 MOCN Introduction Package at the same time.

5.1.2 WRFD-02130401 Dedicated Carrier for Each Operator

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

This feature enables the allocation of frequency resources to different operators for

independent operation.

Benefits

For license holders, distinct cost saving would be achieved, including the CAPEX and OPEX,

because all the RAN elements could be shared.

Description

RAN sharing solution is applicable for operators that have multiple frequency allocations, i.e.

all operators have their own licenses. In this scenario, the RAN elements but not the radio

frequencies are shared between operators, as illustrated in the following figure.

Page 228: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 228 of 415

1 (1)

Nokia Svenska AB06.05.2002

Frequency one

Frequency two

Shared RNC

Frequency one

Frequency two

Shared Node B

MNCone

MNCtwo

Operator one

Operator two

In this solution, 3GPP Release 99 specific is applied. For multiple operators that share the

RAN, their own PLMN codes are transmitted on their dedicated carrier, i.e. unique PLMN

code (composed by MCC and MNC) is broadcasted via system information within each

operator’s dedicated cells.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-021304 RAN Sharing Introduction Package

5.1.3 WRFD-02130402 Flexible Network Architecture

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Page 229: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 229 of 415

Summary

This feature can meet the networking requirements of different operators.

Benefits

Various requirements can be met with the help of the flexible architecture. Differentiated

service and effective cost are also achievable.

Description

In RAN Sharing solution, the flexibility of the network architecture is well supported. The

involved interfaces are Iub, Iur, Iu, and Iu-BC.

Iu interface

CN network is supplied by operator separately. On Iu interface, each operator may employ Iu

Flex or not independently. The maximum number of CN nodes (MSC or SGSN) that can be

connected is the same between shared or non-shared RNC. For the shared RNC, the capacity

will be divided by all operators.

For example, as illustrated in the following figure, operator A adopts the Iu Flex while

operator B does not.

Iu-BC interface

To the shared RNC, maximum 4 CBCs can be connected, i.e. each operator can have a

dedicated CBC, shown below.

Shared RNC

MSC 3 MSC 2

MSC 1

SGSN 2 SGSN 1

MSC

SGSN

Operator A Operator B

Page 230: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 230 of 415

With dedicated Iu-BC connection, each operator can independently deploy the Cell Broadcast

Service.

Iub interface

In the shared RAN, RAN elements could be shared by multiple operators, including

RNC and Node Bs. But there might be the case that shared Node Bs and non-shared

Node Bs coexist. In this RAN sharing solution, both shared and non-shared Node Bs are

allowed to connect to the shared RNC. See the following figure.

Iur interface

The Iur interface is similar to the Iub interface. That is, both shared RNCs and non-shared

RNCs can be connected to a shared RNC.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

Operator B

Operator A

Shared

RNC

Shared by

Operator A & B

Shared by

Operator A & B

Shared

RNC

CBC-B Operator B

Operator A CBC-A

SAs of Operator A

SAs of Operator B

Page 231: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 231 of 415

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-021304 RAN Sharing Introduction Package

5.1.4 WRFD-02130403 Mobility Control and Service Differentiation

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

This feature provides the configuration of different services for multiple operators to meet

their personalized requirements.

Benefits

Based on the service differentiation mechanism, operators that share the RAN can deploy

different service provision strategies to their subscribers.

Description Initial NAS message routing

In the dedicated carrier RAN sharing solution, each cell belongs to one operator. The

initial NAS message (for registration or call setup, etc.) will be routed to appropriate

target CN network, to which operator of the current cell (from which the call is initiated)

also belongs. As shown in the following figure for example, if UE initiates a call from

one cell belonging to operator B, then the initial NAS message will be routed to the CN

network of operator B.

Page 232: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 232 of 415

If the Iu Flex is adopted, then the NNSF will be applied right after the selection of CN

network, to decide which CN node should be the target of routing.

Differentiated and isolated CBS

CBS information content is broadcasted with a set of CBS SAs (service areas), and each

CBS SA is composed by a set of cells. In the dedicated carrier shared RAN, the CBS SA

is also operator dedicated, i.e. each operator’s CBS SA can be composed only by its own

cell. Therefore, the CBS is isolated between operators in the shared RAN.

Furthermore, since each operator can deploy a stand alone CBS equipment,

differentiated and independent service provision is also achievable.

Differentiated and isolated MBMS

The MBMS is similar to the CBS. MBMS service is distributed in a set of MBMS

broadcast areas, also called “MBMS SA”. Each MBMS SA is composed of a set of cells.

In the dedicated carrier shared RAN, the MBMS SA is also dedicated. MBMS service

initiated from dedicated SGSN is distributed (p-to-p or p-to-m) within operator dedicated

MBMS SAs, i.e. operator dedicated cells.

Furthermore, differentiated and independent MBMS service provision is also achievable.

Mobility control

Shared

RNC

MBMS SAs of

Operator A

MBMS SAs of

Operator B

BM-SC SGSN

Operator A

BM-SC SGSN

Operator B

Shared

RNC

Operator A

CN

Operator B

CN

Target CN network Originated Cell

Page 233: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 233 of 415

Inter-operator handover is usually forbidden by operators, but sometimes it is allowed. A

configurable flag is provided to indicate whether inter-operator intra-system handover is

allowed or not. The default setting is not allowed. The inter-system handover is handled

normally.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-021304 RAN Sharing Introduction Package

5.1.5 WRFD-02130404 Independent License Control

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

With this feature, operators can have their independent capacity and choose optional features,

thus meeting different service and operation requirements.

Benefits

With independent license control, total capacity of the physical RNC will be shared by

operators, and each can take specific proportion.

Page 234: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 234 of 415

Description

License control refers to the control of the capacity (Erlang and PO) and optional features

(except RAN Sharing feature itself). For multiple operators that share the RNC, independent

capacity and optional features control for each operator is supplied.

For independent capacity control, the total capacity could be split by multiple operators. Each

operator can get specific proportion of the total capacity based on its requirement, and the

actual capacity usage will be monitored and controlled.

For independent optional features control, each operator may choose different set of optional

features For example, one operator may choose some optional features but the others do not.

Most optional features can be controlled separately by operators. For example, if the MBMS

is chosen by operator A but not by operator B, then operator A can provide the MBMS, but

operator cannot provide the MBMS.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-021304 RAN Sharing Introduction Package

5.1.6 WRFD-02130405 Independent Cell-level FM/PM/CM

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

With this feature, operators can monitor and maintain their own cells.

Page 235: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 235 of 415

Benefits

Providing Independent Cell-level FM/PM/CM

Description Independent cell-level Fault Management

Most alarms are object related. For those alarms related to cells, they are contained only

in the data collection of the corresponding instance set. For those alarms not related to

cells or any objects, they are contained in all data collections of all instance sets. As each

instance set corresponds to only one manager, the operator dedicated alarms can only be

accessed by the owner FM manager.

For operations originated from the FM manager (i.e., alarm handling operations, setting

operations, etc.), as the operated targets are alarms, they are processed in the same way.

Each manager can only operate the alarms in the corresponding instance set, i.e., the

alarms dedicated to one operator.

Independent cell-level Performance Management

All counters are object related. For those counters related to cells, their statistical results

are contained only in the data collection of the corresponding instance set. For those

counters not related to cells, their statistical results are contained in all data collections of

all instance sets. As each instance set corresponds to only one manager, the operator

dedicated results can only be accessed by the owner PM manager.

For operations originated from the PM Manager (i.e., job management operations,

threshold setting operations, etc.), as the operated targets are objects, they are processed

in the same way. Each manager can only operate the objects in the corresponding

instance set, i.e., the objects dedicated to one operator. For example, each operator can

only create measurement jobs on his own cells. Dedicated cell-level measurement of

each operator is supported including Node B CE utilization, cell traffic throughput, etc.

RAN also supports non cell-level measurement, which is shared by operators. Items are

RNC/Node B utilization, PA utilization and Iub capacity & throughput, etc.

Independent cell-level Configuration Management

The configuration flows are the same in both sharing and non-sharing mode. The

difference lies in data, and is embodied in cell-level configuration.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

Page 236: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 236 of 415

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-021304 RAN Sharing Introduction Package

5.1.7 WRFD-02130406 Transmission Recourse Sharing on Iub/Iur Interface

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

With this feature, operators can share Iub/Iur transmission resources to effectively use the

transmission bandwidth and reduce the operation cost.

Benefits

Transmission resource is costly. Shared transmission resource management strategy leads to

effective usage of the bandwidth, and will finally bring cost saving to all the operators sharing

the RAN.

Description

In the shared RAN, shared transmission resource management strategy is adopted on both Iub

and Iur interface.

Iub interface,

The Iub interface is composed of Node B control port (NCP), CCPs, ALCAP link (not

applicable for IP transmission), OM path, and a number of user plan links.

For each Node B, only one unique NCP could exist. Generally multiple CCPs can exist,

but they need to work in load sharing mode. In normal case, the ALCAP link is also

unique for each Node B. Shared OM path for one Node B is also proposed, because the

Node B is shared, though multiple OM paths are allowable, but it brings no benefit. So,

the control plane links (NCP, CCP, ALCAP link) should be shared by operators.

To achieve effective transmission resource usage, user plane links are also shared by

operators.

Iur interface

SS7 is adopted for Iur interface control plane. SS7 links work in load sharing and

redundant mode, and all the SS7 links must be shared by operators utilizing the Iur

interface.

For the Iur interface user plane, it is handled in the same way as that for the Iub interface.

Page 237: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 237 of 415

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-021304 RAN Sharing Introduction Package

5.1.8 WRFD-021305 RAN Sharing Phase 2

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

Summary

This feature provides multiple operators with separated Iub transmission resource

management to meet their QoS requirements.

Benefits

In the shared RAN, operator’s differentiated QoS requirement is guaranteed with this feature.

Description

Based on RAN Sharing phase 1, dedicated Iub transmission control function was introduced

in phase 2, in which separated Iub transmission resource management is provided for

operators sharing the RAN.

On the common Iub interface, separated Iub transmission resource management aims to

guarantee the QoS for operators, and no interference between each other.

Page 238: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 238 of 415

In RAN sharing phase 2, dedicated Iub transmission control is not mandatory, i.e. shared

transmission resource in Iub is still applicable.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-021304 RAN Sharing Introduction Package

5.1.9 WRFD-02130501 Dedicated Iub Transmission Control

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

Summary

This feature provides multiple operators with separated Iub transmission resource

management to meet their QoS requirements.

Benefits

In the shared RAN, operator’s differentiated QoS requirement is guaranteed with this feature.

Description

Dedicated Iub transmission control refers to separated Iub transmission resource management

for operators sharing the RAN. It is only applicable for user plane, but not control plane and

OM path. Control plane must be shared by operators.

Page 239: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 239 of 415

Control plane links (including NCP, CCPs, ALCAP link) and bandwidth (occupied by these

links) should be commonly used by operators. But in user plane, each operator may use

dedicated links (such as AAL2 paths / IP paths) and bandwidth (occupied by these links).

Refer to the following figure (example in ATM transmission).

For user plane bandwidth, the shared mode is supplied in phase 1, while phase 2 supports

dedicated mode. In dedicated mode, operator dedicated logical resource group is introduced,

which aims to separate the user plane bandwidth between operators.

For logical resource group, two different cases are applicable. In case 1, physical link is

common to all groups. In case 2, physical links are dedicated to each group. Both cases will

be supported. These two cases are illustrated as follows.

I. Case 1

GROUP-A

GROUP-B

Physical Link

II. Case 2

Physical Link

Physical Link

GROUP-A

GROUP-B

When creating a logical group, the operator to which bandwidth belongs and the maximum

available bandwidth should be specified. To achieve the separate resource management, each

operator’s dedicated group should contain some user plane links, which will also become

operator dedicated.

NCP bandwidth

CCPs bandwidth

ALCAP bandwidth

O&M bandwidth

User plane

bandwidth

Could be dedicated

or shared

Must be shared

Page 240: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 240 of 415

Based on the dedicated logical resource group, the operator can perform admission control

and congestion control independently.

Admission Control

In this feature, admission control for transmission resource is performed separately to avoid

conflict between operators. That is, for each operator’s call traffic, the required transmission

resource (bandwidth) would only be allocated from this operator’s dedicated group. There is

no difference whether the resource groups are carried by the shared physical link (case 1) or

separated physical links (case 2). See the example in the following figure.

Congestion Control

In this feature, congestion control of transmission resource is also performed separately.

Congestion is detected and reported independently for operator dedicated group, and only its

own users are involved in the control process. As shown in the following figure for example,

if congestion happens to Group-B (owned by operator B), only users that belong to operator B

are involved.

Besides the admission control and congestion control, the flow control for the HSDPA is also

isolated between operators.

HSDPA flow control

Page 241: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 241 of 415

As shown in the preceding figure, HSDPA flow control is performed separately for operator A

and B. For example, available bandwidth for HSDPA within dedicated group is calculated as:

Available bandwidth for HSDPA within Group-A

=min {(maximum bandwidth of Group-A - total bandwidth allocated for R99 within

Group-A), maximum bandwidth for HDSPA within Group-A}

Where:

Group-A is dedicated for Operator A.

Enhancement

In RAN12, the transmission resource management of different operators can be configured.

Iub CAC and flow control can be configured as one of the following three modes:

a. In Iub CAC, different users are admitted according to devided bandwidth of different

operators, flow control algorithm is performed according to their individual bandwidth

either.

b. In Iub CAC, all the users are admitted according to totoal bandwidth instead of

individual bandwidth, flow control algorithm is also performed according to total

bandwidth.

c. In Iub CAC, different users are admitted according to devided bandwidth of different

operators, but flow control algorithm is performed according to total bandwidth.

In these three modes,

a. Different operators can have different QoS mapping scheme ( ARP/TC/THP)

b. The mapping between QoS attributes (TC/ARP/THP ) and SPI/SPI weight/User GBR of

BE service can be configured for each operator.

c. The Iub CAC and congestion control to the users of different operators are performed

according to their individual mapping configurations.

Dependency

Dependency on other RAN software functions

WRFD-021304 RAN Sharing Introduction Package

Page 242: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 242 of 415

5.1.10 WRFD-021303 IMSI Based Handover

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.0.

Summary

This feature supports the configuration of SNA-related information on the RNC side. When

the CN does not support the SNA function, this feature enables the UTRAN to provide

limitations to mobile areas of the UE.

Benefits

With this feature, the RNC can prevent the UE in connected mode from being moved to an

un-subscribed area without CN support. This feature can also be used as a supplement for

implementing shared networks solutions.

Description

This feature is an alternate solution when the CN does not support the function of the shared

network support in connected mode which is described in WRFD-021301 Shared Network

Support in Connected Mode. That is, the following mappings must be configured on the RNC

instead of informed by the CN.

The SNA that an LA belongs to

The SNA that the UE is allowed to connect to

With this information, UTRAN can provide the same restrict mechanism for UE in connected

mode without CN node support.

The following procedures are affected in the IMSI-based handover and the process is the

same as described in the feature WRFD-021301 Shared Network Support in Connected

Mode:

RRC Establishment

Cell Update

URA Update

Handover

Relocation

Handling Common ID

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

Page 243: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 243 of 415

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-021304 RAN Sharing Introduction Package

5.1.11 WRFD-021311 MOCN Introduction Package

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

Summary

With this feature, multiple operators can share a cell. This feature applies to the scenarios

wherein multiple operators share a carrier or further sharing is required.

Benefits

MOCN enables the operators to save Capital Expenditure (CAPEX) and Operation

Expenditure (OPEX), especially in areas where a single carrier is sufficient to support

subscribers from different operators. For operators involved in the fierce competition of the

telecom industry, MOCN can help them to achieve capital gains as well as corporate

soundness and competitiveness.

Compared with other sharing modes that use independent carriers, MOCN can share carrier

resources and better utilize resources.

Description

MOCN, introduced in the 3GPP R6 protocols, is known as one of the access network sharing

modes. In addition to access nodes such as RNC and Node B, MOCN also shares the carriers.

The network architecture of MOCN is shown below:

Page 244: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 244 of 415

Different from RAN Sharing that uses independent carriers, MOCN uses common carrier

resources. Similar to RAN Sharing, the Core Network (CN) in MOCN is independent, that is,

the CN nodes belong to different operators. When multiple operators share common carrier

resources, the users of these operators have cell resources in common. In this respect,

compared with RAN Sharing, MOCN can better utilize resources.

Huawei does not offer the MOCN solution with RAN Sharing solution together.

In MOCN solution, all the software features cannot be controlled separately by different

operators. Thus one optional feature needs be bought by all the customers before it is

available.

MOCN introduction package has the following features:

Common carriers shared by operators

Dedicated Node B or cell for operators

MOCN mobility management

MOCN load balancing

MOCN independent performance management

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

The UE should support the MOCN function.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Page 245: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 245 of 415

Dependency on CN

The CN should support the MOCN function.

Dependency on Other Features

Cannot work with WRFD-021304 RAN Sharing Introduction Package at the same time.

5.1.12 WRFD-02131101 Carrier Sharing by Operators

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

Summary

With this feature, multiple operators can share a carrier.

Benefits

MOCN enables the operators to save Capital Expenditure (CAPEX) and Operation

Expenditure (OPEX), especially in areas where a single carrier is sufficient to support

subscribers from both operators. For operators involved in the fierce competition of the

telecom industry, MOCN can help them to achieve capital gains as well as corporate

soundness and competitiveness.

Compared with the sharing mode that uses independent carriers, MOCN can share carrier

resources and better utilize resources.

Description

MOCN uses common carrier resources and enables multiple operators to share the RAN

equipment and the same carriers. One cell can belong to and serve different operators.

The basic functions of MOCN are as follows:

System information broadcast

The RNC broadcasts the PLMN IDs of multiple operators in the Master Information

Block (MIB) to send the UE the information about these operators. Based on the

information, the UE performs PLMN selection.

Network selection

MOCN network sharing specifies the following two types of UE:

− Supporting UE: refers to the UE that supports network sharing.

In MOCN network sharing, the RNC broadcasts the PLMN information of multiple

operators through the Multiple-PLMN list IE in the MIB. The supporting UE can

analyze the PLMN information and inform the RNC of the selected PLMN through

the initial direct transfer message. The supporting UE should support the 3GPP R6

protocols.

− Non-supporting UE: refers to the UE that does not support network sharing.

The non-supporting UE cannot analyze the PLMN information of operators from the

system information.

Page 246: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 246 of 415

The RNC adopts different methods to select suitable operators for the two types of UEs.

The supporting UE selects a suitable PLMN ID from the PLMN IDs of multiple operators as

broadcast in the MIB, and reports the selected PLMN ID to the RNC through the initial direct

transfer message. Accordingly, the RNC selects a suitable CN node for the UE based on the

PLMN ID of the UE. If the operator enables the Iu Flex function, the RNC selects one of the

CN nodes based on the NAS Node Selection Function (NNSF).

The non-supporting UE does not report PLMN ID to the RNC through the initial direct

transfer message. The RNC selects a CN node for the UE through the redirection function.

PS/CS consistency

The CS/PS consistency is achieved by coordinating the RNC and the CN. It prevents the

RNC from selecting two CN operators (for CS domain and PS domain respectively) for

the UE. For a network with the Gs interface, the CS registration is forwarded from the

PS domain; therefore, the SGSN is responsible for ensuring the CS/PS consistency. For a

network without the Gs interface, the RNC ensures the CS/PS consistency.

In addition, to facilitate the implementation of MOCN, some UEs that support 3GPP R5

rather than 3GPP R6 may realize the MOCN-associated features of Release 6. The RNC

supports these pre-R6 UEs which implement MOCN independently.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-021311 MOCN Introduction Package

Page 247: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 247 of 415

5.1.13 WRFD-02131102 Dedicated Node B/Cell for Operators

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

Summary

This feature enables operators to independently control a Node B or cell in MOCN scenarios.

Benefits

Through dedicated Node Bs/Cells, the operators can flexibly set the network sharing areas to

meet various requirements for network sharing and scenarios.

Description

To satisfy the special requirements of different operators, the RNC can not only connect to a

shared Node B of multiple operators (known as MOCN Node B), but also connect to a

dedicated Node B, namely, non-shared Node B which serves one operator only, as shown

below:

The dedicated Node B belongs to Operator A only; therefore, all the UEs that access the

network from this Node B will be connected to the CN node of Operator A.

For MOCN Node B, some cells of the shared Node B can be dedicated to one operator and

serve this operator only. The RNC supports the dedicated cell for an operator.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

Page 248: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 248 of 415

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-021311 MOCN Introduction Package

5.1.14 WRFD-02131103 MOCN Mobility Management

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

Summary

This feature adapts to different MOCN mobility policies. Whether the UE can be handed over

to a new cell depends on the PLMN ID of the target cell and the operator ID of the UE.

Benefits

This feature can ensure a continuous shared network service, improve user perception, and

provide more flexible mobility management policies, thus meeting different network sharing

requirements of operators.

Description

Generally, inter-operator handover is prohibited, but there are some exceptions. The RNC

provides a flag implying that the inter-operator handover within the system is allowed. The

flag can be configured by operators although the inter-operator handover is prohibited by

default. If the flag is provided, it indicates that the UE movement is not limited by operators.

The inter-RAT handover between operators is allowed no matter what the flag is.

MOCN mobility management prevents the UE from being handed over to the cells that

belong to a different operator when the inter-operator handover is prohibited. The handover of

UEs include soft handover, hard handover, intra-frequency handover, and inter-frequency

handover.

Enhancement

None.

Page 249: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 249 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-021311 MOCN Introduction Package

5.1.15 WRFD-02131104 MOCN Load Balance

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

Summary

This feature enables load balancing between multiple operators and ensures the network

fairness.

Benefits

This feature ensures the balance of load and the fairness of network sharing between different

operators.

Description

For a non-supporting UE, the RNC selects a suitable operator for the UE based on the

redirection function. In some cases, multiple operators can serve one UE (for example, a

roaming UE); therefore, the load balancing mechanism is required to ensure the balance of

load and the fairness of network sharing between operators.

The RNC supports the load balancing mechanism of MOCN. In the first and the following

attempts of redirection, the RNC selects the operator with least times of success access. This

allows multiple UEs to be evenly allocated to different CN operators and thus guarantees the

load balance between operators.

Page 250: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 250 of 415

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-021311 MOCN Introduction Package

5.1.16 WRFD-02131105 MOCN Independent Performance Management

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

Summary

This feature enables operators to independently obtain the information about network

operation such as traffic and network quality.

Benefits

With this feature, operators can independently obtain the information about network operation

such as traffic and network quality.

Description

The RNC supports independent performance management for different operators. That is to

say, the operators can obtain their specific information about network operation, such as

traffic volume and network quality.

Page 251: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 251 of 415

In addition, the performance counters related to MOCN, for example, the redirections with

various causes are added to the RNC performance counters.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-021311 MOCN Introduction Package

5.1.17 WRFD-02131106 Routing Roaming UEs in Proportion

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0.

Summary

If an RNC is shared by several operators that support the Multi-Operator Core Network

(MOCN) and have a roaming agreement with each other, when UEs of another RNC enter the

coverage area of this RNC, this RNC routes these UEs to the CNs of different operators

according to the predefined routing proportion.

Benefits

With this feature, the telecom operators sharing one RNC can flexibly route roaming UEs to

CNs.

Description

In a shared RNC, roaming relations can be configured between the operators who share the

RNC and other operators who do not. For the UEs of an operator that enter the coverage area

Page 252: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 252 of 415

of the shared RNC, the allocation proportions among the operators who share the RNC can

also be configured.

When UEs of other operators roam into the area served by the shared RNC, and the UEs are

non-supporting (meaning they do not support network sharing, as specified in the optional

feature WRFD-02131101Carrier Sharing Among Operators), the RNC randomly routes these

UEs to a CN if the RNC does not receive the messages carrying IMSI information. If the CN

rejects the UE access requests or indicates that CS/PS coordination is required, the CN returns

the UE IMSI to the RNC. The RNC then obtains the PLMN from the IMSI and routes the UEs

to the CN of the operators who share the RNC according to the predefined roaming relations

and proportions. If the roaming UEs are supporting-UEs (supporting network sharing), this

feature is not applied.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

None

Dependency on NodeB hardware

None

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-021311 MOCN Introduction Package

Dependency on other NEs

None

Page 253: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 253 of 415

5.2 Topology Enhancement

5.2.1 WRFD-021200 HCS (Hierarchical Cell Structure)

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R99.

Summary

This feature complies with the hierarchical cell structure (HCS) as stipulated in 3GPP

specifications. It enables the UE to be handed over to the relevant hierarchical cell according

to its moving speed.

Benefits Improve the conversation quality for fast-moving UEs.

Improve the system capacity.

Reduce the signaling load by decreasing the unnecessary handover.

Description

In 3G networks, the so-called hot spots in radio communications may appear with the increase

of subscribers and traffic. This requires more cells to expand the network capacity. More cells

and smaller cell radius indicate that more frequent handovers of UEs take place. For a UE at a

fast speed, frequent handovers reduce call quality, increase uplink interference, and increase

signaling load.

In this situation, Hierarchical Cell Structure (HCS) is required to divide cells into different

hierarchies and up to 8 hierarchies are supported.

Cell Type Characteristics

Macro Cell Large coverage

Continuous coverage networking

Low requirement on capacity

Fast-moving environment

Micro Cell Densely populated areas

High requirement on capacity

Slow-moving environment

Pico Cell Indoor coverage

Outdoor dead-area coverage

Where, the Pico cell has the highest priority and the macro cell has the lowest priority.

Page 254: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 254 of 415

Speed Estimation

The speed estimation on each hierarchy of an HCS cell falls into one of the following

types:

− Fast speed

− Normal speed

− Slow speed

According to the number of changes of the best cell within time unit, speed estimation

algorithm estimates the moving speed of the UEs. See details as follows:

− If the number of changes of best cell for a UE is above the fast-speed threshold, this

UE is decided in fast speed;

− If the number of changes of best cell for a UE is below the slow-speed threshold, this

UE is decided in slow speed;

− If the number of changes of best cell for a UE is between fast-speed threshold and

slow-speed threshold, this UE is decided in normal speed.

HCS Handover Based on Speed Estimation

After the moving speed of the UE is estimated, inter-hierarchy handover algorithm

initiates the corresponding handover based on this speed decision.

According to the results of speed estimation,

− The UE in fast speed is handed over to the cell of lower priority.

− The UE in slow speed is handed over to the cell of higher priority.

− The UE in normal speed is not required to be handed over to any cell.

According to speed estimation, the RNC orders the fast-moving UE to handover to the cells of

lower priority to reduce the number of handovers, and orders the slow-moving UEs to

handover to the cells of higher priority to increase network capacity.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Page 255: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 255 of 415

Dependency on Other Features

NA

5.2.2 WRFD-020111 One Tunnel

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R7.

Summary

With this feature, there is only one tunnel between the RNC and GGSN.

Benefits

This feature improves efficiency for PS traffic. It avoids SGSN to be the bottle neck of the

network while high PS traffic occurs.

Description

The specification of One-Tunnel (direct connection between RNC and GGSN) is a part of

3GPP Release 7.

In 3G packet core architecture the SGSN (Serving GPRS Support Node) which is the gateway

between the radio network and the core network handles both signaling traffic (e.g. to keep

track of a users location) and the actual data packets exchanged between the user and the

Internet. Since the users' location can change at any time, data packets are tunneled

(encapsulated) from the gateway to the Internet (The Gateway GPRS Support Node, GGSN)

via the SGSN over the radio network to the mobile device. The current architecture uses a

tunnel between the GGSN and the SGSN and another one between the SGSN and the Radio

Network Controller (RNC). All data packets thus have to pass the SGSN which has to

terminate one tunnel extract the packet and put it into another tunnel. This requires both time

and processing power.

Since both the RNC and the GGSN are IP routers this process is not necessary in most

circumstances. With one tunnel approach the SGSN can create a direct tunnel between the

RNC and the GGSN and thus remove itself from the chain. Mobility Management remains on

the SGSN, however, which means for example that it continues to be responsible to modify

the tunnel in case the mobile device is moved to an area served by another RNC.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Page 256: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 256 of 415

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

Require GGSN and SGSN support such feature at the same time.

Dependency on Other Features

NA

5.3 ATM Transimission

5.3.1 WRFD-050405 Overbooking on ATM Transmission

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

This feature can improve the usage efficiency in ATM transmission scenarios.

Benefits

This feature provides a method for greatly saving OPEX on ATM transmission, especially on

Iub interface, and when deploying HSDPA high speed service.

Description

Overbooking on ATM transmission is used to improve the usage efficiency on ATM

transmission scenario, and this feature comprises of following two parts:

Overbooking on Call Admission Control and basic congestion control

Fast inner loop backpressure on the interface board

I. Overbooking on Call Admission Control and Basic Congestion Control

Transmission rate of the data service varies in different periods. For example, data flow is

generated when you are downloading a webpage, but no data flow is generated when you are

browsing the webpage. Therefore, there is a high peak/average ratio between the actual

transmission rate and the channel transmission rate. And this can be represented by active

factor of each service type. Such active factor can be configured as a network requirement.

Page 257: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 257 of 415

The thought of the Iub overbooking is that the transmission bandwidth of the Iub interface is

allocated according to a certain activating ratio instead of 100% of the maximum traffic ratio

when the admission is performed. As a result, the bandwidth shared by multiple users may not

meet the requirements for peak rate transmission. In this case, efficiency of using the

bandwidth on the Iub interface becomes quite low if no flow control is performed on the RNC.

The reason for such a case is that random packet loss on the Iub interface leads to PDU

re-transmission by the RLC and thus the transmission rate is degraded when the time delay

for transmitting TCP packet increases and the TCP flow control starts.

To solve this problem, packet loss on the Iub interface should be avoided and ensure that the

time delay for transmitting TCP packets is not affected by the packet loss.

To configure the re-transmission threshold and explain the Iub overbooking solution, two

events are defined: event A and event B:

When the re-transmission rate is continuously greater than the high threshold, event A is

reported from RLC to MAC-d and the latter one will inhibit the maximum current TFI.

If the re-transmission rate is continuously smaller than the low threshold, event B is

reported from RLC to MAC-d and the upper-level TFI inhibited previously is restored.

With this basic congestion control mechanism which applied in RLC and MAC player, the

data rate will be decreased immediately, but since data loss has occurred, the gain of

transmission resource usage efficiency and user feeling will be affected accordingly.

Therefore, the second part of this feature is introduced to enhance the performance farther.

II. Fast inner loop backpressure on the interface board

Such fast inner loop backpressure mechanism is implemented in the interface board and it

works as described below:

The RNC monitors the Buffer Occupancy (BO) status of each physical port and VP (Virtual

Port) or VC at the Iub transport network layer user plane continuously.

If the BO exceeds congestion threshold (TH2), the system enters congestion state and a

congestion backpressure signal will be generated and sent to radio network layer user

plane. Then the RNL UP will decrease the data sending rate to release the congestion.

If the BO is lower than congestion release threshold (TH1), the system enters normal

state and a congestion release backpressure signal will be generated and sent to the RNL

UP. Then the RNL UP will increase the data sending rate.

If the BO is higher than discard threshold (TH3), the system enters extreme congestion

state and the data will be discarded at the TNL UP directly.

Page 258: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 258 of 415

Time

TH1

TH3

TH2

Buffer Occupancy

Time

TH1

TH3

TH2

Buffer Occupancy

RNL User Plane

Iub TNL User Plane

① ② ④ ⑤③

From CN

To NodeB

RNL User Plane

Iub TNL User Plane

① ② ④ ⑤③

From CN

To NodeB

Since this backpressure mechanism works in the 10ms level, generally data loss will not occur

and Iub bandwidth usage efficiency is greatly increased accordingly.

This mechanism depends on the ATM interface board on RNC like AOU/UOI/AUE, and

NodeB must be connected to RNC directly through ATM interface board. It is not applied for

Hub Node B.

Enhancement

In RAN6.1, fast inner loop backpressure feature based on VC is supported for ATM transport.

In RAN10.0, fast inner loop backpressure feature based on port and VP is supported for ATM

transport.

Page 259: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 259 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

The backpressure and VP shaping mechanism depends on the ATM interface board on RNC

like AOU/UOI/AEU.

Dependency on Node B

BTS3902E can’t support this feature.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

5.3.2 WRFD-050105 ATM Switching Based Hub Node B

Availability

This feature was available from RAN 5.1

Summary

With this feature, Huawei Node B is capable of transmission convergence in ATM transport

mode.

Benefits

This feature can provide the convergence gain and reduce the cost of transmission lines.

Description

The ATM switching based hub Node B extends the tree topology, as shown in the following

figure.

The hub Node B is connected to the RNC through the STM-1 or E1 port. The hub Node B is

connected to the cascaded Node Bs through the E1 port. The Node Bs are converged on the

hub Node B and then connected to the RNC. ATM transmission convergence implements the

convergence gain on the Iub interface.

Page 260: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 260 of 415

RNC

NodeB

Hub NodeB

NodeB

NodeB

NodeB

NodeB

NodeB

ATM transmission convergence consists of PVC convergence and AAL2 convergence. The

following figure shows the topology of PVC convergence. PVC convergence is implemented

on the basis of tree-link PVC and group bandwidth management technologies. The PVC

convergence function of the hub Node B can implement switching between PVC 1 and PVC

A (Node B 1), between PVC 2 and PVC B (Node B 2), and between PVC 3 and PVC C (Node

B 3). The RNC provides the group bandwidth management function to ensure that

downstream Node Bs and hub Node B can share the transmission bandwidth of the Iub

interface.

Physical link

Hub NodeB

Physical link

PVC A

PVC B

PVC C

PVC

PVC 1

PVC 2

PVC 3

NodeB 1

NodeB 2

NodeB 3

Group bandwidth management is an improvement of the CAC algorithm based on AAL2 path.

This algorithm can ensure that the total bandwidth for UE admission is smaller than that of

physical ports and the total bandwidth of all configured AAL2 paths is greater than that of

physical ports.

In PVC convergence mode, the hub Node B can support four-level connections of

downstream Node Bs and up to 16 downstream Node Bs.

Enhancement

None.

Page 261: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 261 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

BTS3902E can’t support this feature.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

5.3.3 WRFD-050106 AAL2 Switching Based Hub Node B

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

With this feature, Huawei Node B is capable of AAL2 transmission convergence in ATM

transport mode.

Benefits

This feature can provide the convergence gain and reduce the cost of transmission lines.

Description

The AAL2 switching Based Hub Node B is a feature in ATM transport mode. It is the

extension of the tree topology. The hub Node B topology has two solutions: PVC convergence

and AAL2 Convergence. In order to achieve better congregation efficiency, the AAL2

convergence is introduced.

The AAL2 convergence is implemented through AAL2 switching. As shown in the following

figure, the bandwidth that the RNC allocates to the AAL2 paths of the Node Bs (Node B 1,

Node B 2, and Node B 3) is converged and switched on the AAL2 path of the hub Node B.

Therefore, all the Node Bs share the Iub bandwidth of the AAL2 path.

Page 262: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 262 of 415

Physical link

Hub NodeB

Physical link

AAL2 Link

NodeB1

NodeB2

NodeB3PVC

PVC

The hub Node B supports connections to 4 level downstream Node Bs in AAL2 convergence

mode. The hub Node B supports up to 16 downstream Node Bs.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

DBS3800 can not support this feature.

BTS3902E can not support this feature.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-050105 ATM Switching Based Hub Node B

5.3.4 WRFD-050406 ATM QoS Introduction on Hub Node B (Overbooking on Hub Node B Transmission)

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0 in BSC6800.

Page 263: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 263 of 415

This feature is introduced from RAN10.0 in BSC6810.

Summary

With this feature, the RNC can detect each virtual port through the VP shaping mechanism to

share the bandwidth of the Iub interface.

Benefits

This feature provides a method for greatly saving OPEX on ATM Hub Node B transmission,

and when deploying HSDPA service.

Description

The Iub transmission aggregation is a very important method to save operator’s CAPEX. The

figure below shows an example.

NodeB1

(Hub 1)

NodeB2

(Hub 2)

NodeB3

(Leaf)

RNC

SDH Backhaul

NodeB1

(Hub 1)

NodeB2

(Hub 2)

NodeB3

(Leaf)

RNC

SDH Backhaul

When the hub Node B transmission is applied, the RNC can be connected to more Node Bs

with only one physical port. In this case, the RNC may send out data with a high bit rate, and

if all the data is sending to one Node B, for example, Node B 3 in upper figure, congestion

may happen at Node B 2 and data will be lost accordingly. In order to avoid the possible data

loss, Iub Overbooking on Hub Node B Transmission is introduced in the RNC.

Iub Overbooking on Hub Node B Transmission feature uses Iub Overbooking CAC (Call

Admission Control) algorithm and VP (virtual Port) shaping mechanism. The Iub

Overbooking CAC algorithm is the same as that in feature WRFD-050405.

In VP shaping mechanism, all PVCs connected to one Node B are considered as one virtual

port; if one Node B is a hub Node B, all PVCs connected to it and PVCs connected to its leaf

Node Bs are considered as one virtual port only.

The VP shaping mechanism is almost the same as backpressure mechanism in feature

WRFD-050405. The difference is that the RNC monitors the buffer occupancy status of each

virtual port but not physical port when the VP shaping is applied.

With the VP shaping mechanism, data loss will not happen and Iub bandwidth can be fully

used.

Enhancement

None.

Page 264: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 264 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

BTS3902E can’t support this feature.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-050405 Overbooking on ATM transmission

5.3.5 WRFD-050302 Fractional ATM Function on Iub Interface

Availability

This feature was first available from RAN2.0.

Summary

This feature enables ATM cells to be transmitted on some timeslots of the E1/T1 bearer and

other data to be transmitted on other timeslots. It applies to the scenario where 2G and 3G

data is transmitted simultaneously.

Benefits

ATM on Fractional supports:

Sharing of transmission links between 2G and 3G systems.

Reduced time in market at initial rollout.

Savings of transmission costs when co-site 2G and 3G

Description

The Fractional ATM mode is an ATM transport mode in the TC sub layer of ATM physical

layer.

In fractional ATM, ATM cells are transmitted by using some of the 32 E1 timeslots. ATM cells

are mapped to some of the E1 timeslots, instead of all of the timeslots. At the peer end, the

ATM cell stream is recovered from these E1 timeslots. The timeslots that are unavailable for

ATM cell transmission can transmit other information.

Page 265: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 265 of 415

The E1/T1 boards can be configured using a fraction of a full E1/T1. For example, the GSM

system can share the transport links with the WCDMA system. This feature is both used for

small sites where one 2G BTS and one WCDMA BTS can share one link and when for

example 0.5 links are needed for the WCDMA BTS and there is 0.5 link free capacity for the

2G BTS. This will in many cases save the cost for installation of one link.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

The AEUa of the RNC supports Fractional ATM and the AOUa does not support this function.

Dependency on Node B

BTS3902E can’t support this feature.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

Page 266: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 266 of 415

5.4 IP Transmission

5.4.1 WRFD-050402 IP Transmission Introduction on Iub Interface

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.1.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R5.

Summary

This feature enables the Iub interface to be carried on the IP network.

Benefits

This feature provides a new Iub transport solution for operator. With IP transmission,

transport cost will decrease greatly with HSDPA/HSUPA service compared with ATM

transport cost.

Description

Huawei RNC provides the following physical port types on Iub IP transmission solution to

support different networking requirements:

E1/T1

FE

GE (with LAN Switch in BSC6800)

STM-1/OC-3c(POS (Packet Over SDH), BSC6900 only)

Channelized STM-1/OC-3(CPOS (Channelized POS), BSC6900 only)

Huawei Node B provides the following physical port types on Iub IP transmission solution to

support different networking requirements:

E1/T1

Electrical FE

Optical FE ( 3900 Node B only )

Electrical GE ( 3900 Node B only )

Optical GE ( 3900 Node B only )

The following features are also included:

Compliant with 3GPP R5 TR25.933

Support GE/FE/E1/T1/channelized STM-1/channelized OC-3/STM-1/OC-3c physical

interface

Support Diffserv mechanism and IEEE802.1P

Support IPV4

Support IP head compression

Support ML-PPP and MC-PPP, RAN11.0 Node B support ML-PPP combined two

transmission card

Page 267: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 267 of 415

Support DHCP, PPP Mux and VLAN

Support 1+1 and 1:1 MSP

The following figure shows the IP networking on Iub interface.

Besides the transport layer change (e.g. M3UA, SCTP), the Iub IP brings about some changes

in CAC as well as service differentiation.

In CAC, IP PATH is defined as the connection between RNC and Node B. Each IP PATH is

configured with a maximum DL PATH bandwidth and maximum UL PATH bandwidth, which

is configurable for operators. When a new call is coming, RNC will compare the required

service bandwidth with the available IP PATH bandwidth for UL and DL. If the IP PATH

bandwidth available for use is insufficient, the call is rejected. If the call is admitted, RNC

will reserve the bandwidth and mark it as being used.

The Iub IP adopts the DiffServ for QoS differentiation, similar to the differentiated ATM PVC.

PHB is defined according to the traffic type, each PHB having a DSCP (DiffServ Code Point)

and priority.

Page 268: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 268 of 415

BEPS Background

AF1PS Interactive

AF3PS Streaming

AF4PS Conversational

EFCS

EFSRB

EFCommon Channels

PHB(Per Hop Behavior)Traffic Type

BEPS Background

AF1PS Interactive

AF3PS Streaming

AF4PS Conversational

EFCS

EFSRB

EFCommon Channels

PHB(Per Hop Behavior)Traffic Type

6B'000000BE

5B'001010AF1

4B'010010AF2

3B'011110AF3

2B'100110AF4

1B'101110EF

Prior Queue #DSCPPHB

6B'000000BE

5B'001010AF1

4B'010010AF2

3B'011110AF3

2B'100110AF4

1B'101110EF

Prior Queue #DSCPPHB

Enhancement

In RAN10.0, the BSC6810 supports the POS/CPOS interface (UOIa and POUa).

RAN10.0, when the gateway or peer entity is faulty, this feature enables the RNC to detect the

link fault and then trigger IP re-route or board switch, thus avoiding packet loss and call drop.

RAN11.0 Node B support ML-PPP combined two transmission card.

RAN13.0 Iub support RNC and Node B integrated firewall

RNC integrated firewall include the following fuctions:

The internal firewall inspects the incoming IP data over the OM interface and provides the

following functions:

IP address filter. This technique allows only the IP data from authorized IP addresses and

network segments.

Safeguard against attacks of ICMP ping, IP fragments, low TTL, smurf, and DDos.

Safeguard against attacks of TCP sequence prediction, and SYN flood.

The internal firewall inspects the incoming IP data over the Iub, Iur, and Iu interfaces and

provides the following functions:

Intelligent white-listing: With this function, only data from permissible peer IP addresses and

ports and data of permissible protocol types can access the RNC.

Safeguard against ARP and ICMP flood

Safeguard against malformed packets

Limiting speed of the broadcast messages

NodeB integrated firewall include the following fuctions:

The internal firewall inspects incoming all the IP data including maintenance data, control

plane data and user plane data and provides the following functions:

Page 269: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 269 of 415

White-listing: With this function, only data from permissible peer IP addresses and ports

and data of permissible protocol types can access the NodeB. Ping denial function will

be supported; NodeB will drop the ICMP packets in this mode.

Maintenance data, control plane data and user plane data of 3900 series NodeB and

Maintenance data and control plane data of BTS3812E/AE and DBS3800 will filter by

White-listing function.

Safeguard against Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) and Internet Control Message

Protocol (ICMP) flood

Broadcast-message speed limiting

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

IP head compression is supported by PEUa and POUa board.

Only the Dopra Linux operating system supports the RNC integrated firewall for the OM

interface.

Only the FG2c and GOUc boards support the RNC integrated firewall for the Iub, Iur,

and Iu interfaces.

To support BFD, the FG2 and GOU are needed for BSC6900.

Dependency on Node B

NUTI board is needed with BTS3812E/AE to support this feature.

Only the 3900 series Node B supports inter-board ML-PPP.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

5.4.2 WRFD-050411 Fractional IP Function on Iub Interface

Availability

This feature was available from RAN6.1.

Page 270: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 270 of 415

Summary

This feature enables IP packets to be transmitted on some timeslots of the E1/T1 bearer and

other data to be transmitted on other timeslots. This feature mainly applies to the scenario

where the 2G Abis interface shares the 3G transport network.

Benefits Sharing of transmission links between 2G and 3G systems.

Reduced initial rollout Time in market at.

Savings on transmission costs when co-site 2G and 3G

Description

In fractional IP, IP packages are transmitted using some of the 32 E1 timeslots. IP packages

are mapped to some of the E1 timeslots, instead of all of the timeslots. At the peer end, the IP

package is recovered from these E1 timeslots. The timeslots that don’t use for IP package

transmission can transmit other information.

The E1/T1 boards can be configured for using a fraction of a full E1/T1. This is for instance

useful when a 2G system, like GSM, shall share the transport links with the WCDMA system.

This feature is both used for small sites where one 2G BTS and one WCDMA BTS can share

one link and when for example 0.5 links are needed for the WCDMA BTS and there is 0.5

link free capacity for the 2G BTS. This will in many cases save the cost for installation of one

link.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

PEUa and POUa board in BSC6900 support the feature.

Dependency on Node B

BTS3902E can’t support this feature.

Page 271: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 271 of 415

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-050402 IP Transmission Introduction on Iub Interface

5.4.3 WRFD-050403 Hybrid Iub IP Transmission

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.1.

Summary

This feature enables the transmission of real-time services and non-real-time services on

different paths to meet the requirements of UMTS services.

Benefits

This feature provides a method for saving OPEX on Iub transmission, especially when

deploying HSDPA/HSUPA service.

Description

The hybrid IP is a kind of innovative transmission solution provided by Huawei to meet the

requirements of different services in UMTS. That is, it transmits real-time service and

non-real-time service on different paths. Two kinds of hybrid transmissions are available:

FE+E1/T1 and FE+FE.

With the introduction of HSDPA technology and the capacity increase over the air interface,

the demand on Iub transmission bandwidth increases greatly. If E1 LL (Lease Line) is adopted,

the operator would need to rent a large amount of circuit, and it maybe very expensive to rent

and maintain the transport network. The requirement of different service in 3G is quite

different in transport bandwidth, BER and timing delay.

Considering the requirement of cost and QoS, the Iub hybrid transmission is introduced with

Iub IP transmission. The Iub hybrid transmission considers the service difference and select

different transport physical layer or transport path for different services. Real-time services

such as voice and streaming data services are transported on IP over E1/STM-1, while

non-real-time services such as interactive and background services are transported on IP over

Ethernet, as shown in the following figure.

Page 272: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 272 of 415

In RAN10.0, Resiliency Hybrid Iub IP Transmission solution is introduced. Iub user plane

traffic and Iub NBAP signaling can be carried over hybrid networks on backup mode. When

one path fails, all the new coming traffic is carried on another path.

Enhancement

In RAN10.0, Resiliency Hybrid Iub IP Transmission solution is introduced.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

BTS3902E can’t support this feature.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-050402 IP Transmission Introduction on Iub Interface

5.4.4 WRFD-050404 ATM/IP Dual Stack Node B

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Page 273: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 273 of 415

Summary

This feature enables Huawei Node B to support hybrid transmission based on ATM and IP.

With this feature, the services with different QoS requirements can be carried on the links of

different protocols. In addition, transmission backup can be implemented by this feature.

Benefits

This feature provides smooth upgrading from ATM transmission to IP transmission on Iub

interface. It helps protect operator’s investment and provide flexible networking.

Description

This feature helps protect operator’s investment and provide flexible networking. For existing

ATM network expansion, operator can overlay IP network in the existing ATM network. The

RNC can support IP Node B or ATM Node B, so you can add IP Node B in the existed ATM

network.

Moreover, the Node B can support ATM and IP dual protocol. You can add an interface card

or modify the configuration to get Iub IP network with existed ATM network, which has no

effect to the existed configuration. For example:

You can add a NUTI board to support IP transmission in a ATM Node B which has only

NDTI board;

You can upgrade Node B configuration to support IP transmission in a ATM Node B has

NUTI board;

In RAN10.0, Resiliency solution is introduced. Iub user plane traffic and Iub NBAP signaling

can be carried over ATM network and IP network on backup mode. When one path fails, all

the new coming traffic is carried on another path.

Enhancement

In RAN10.0, Resiliency ATM/IP dual stack Node B Transmission solution is introduced.

Page 274: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 274 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

BTS3902E can’t support this feature.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-050402 IP Transmission Introduction on Iub Interface

5.4.5 WRFD-050409 IP Transmission Introduction on Iu Interface

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.1.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R5.

Summary

This feature enables the Iu interface to be carried on the IP network.

Benefits

This feature provides a new Iu transport solution for operator. With IP transmission, transport

cost will decrease greatly compared with ATM transport cost.

Description

This feature provides Iu over IP transport solution including the following features:

Compliance with 3GPP R5 TR25.933

Support IP over FE electrical interface

Support IP over GE electrical interface and GE optical interface

Support IP over STM-1/OC-3c optical interface (POS (Packet Over SDH)) (BSC6900

only)

Support IP over channelized STM-1/OC-3 optical interface(CPOS (Channelized POS))

(BSC6900 only)

Page 275: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 275 of 415

Support IuCS over IP over E1/T1 physical interface (BSC6900 only)

Support Diffserv mechanism and IEEE802.1P

Support IPV4

Support IP head compression

Support ML-PPP and MC-PPP

Support PPP Mux and VLAN

Support FE/GE 1+1 backup redundancy

Support FE/GE load share redundancy

Support STM-1/OC-3c 1+1 and 1:1 MSP

Support channelized STM-1/OC-3 1+1 and 1:1 MSP

IP networking solution can be L1, L2, L3 networking on Iu interface similar to that on Iub

interface.

Besides the transport layer change, Iu IP brings some changes in CAC as well as service

differentiation

In CAC, IP PATH is defined as the connection between RNC and CN. Each IP PATH is

configured with a maximum DL PATH bandwidth and maximum UL PATH bandwidth, which

is configurable by operator. When a new call is coming, RNC will compare the required

service bandwidth with the available IP PATH bandwidth for UL and DL. If available IP

PATH bandwidth is insufficient, the call is rejected. If the call is admitted, RNC will reserve

the bandwidth and mark it as being used.

Enhancement

In RAN10.0, the BSC6810 supports the POS/CPOS interface (UOIa and POUa).

In RAN10.0, when the gateway or peer entity is faulty, this feature enables the RNC to detect

the link fault and then trigger IP re-route or board switch, thus avoiding packet loss and call

drop.

In RAN13.0, RNC integrated firewall was supported, which include the following functions:

The internal firewall inspects the incoming IP data over the OM interface and provides the

following functions:

IP address filter. This technique allows only the IP data from authorized IP addresses and

network segments.

Safeguard against attacks of ICMP ping, IP fragments, low TTL, smurf, and DDos.

Safeguard against attacks of TCP sequence prediction, and SYN flood.

The internal firewall inspects the incoming IP data over the Iub, Iur, and Iu interfaces and

provides the following functions:

Intelligent white-listing: With this function, only data from permissible peer IP addresses and

ports and data of permissible protocol types can access the RNC.

Safeguard against ARP and ICMP flood

Safeguard against malformed packets

Limiting speed of the broadcast messages

Page 276: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 276 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

Only the Dopra Linux operating system supports the RNC integrated firewall for the OM

interface.

Only the FG2c and GOUc boards support the RNC integrated firewall for the Iub, Iur,

and Iu interfaces.

To support BFD, the FG2 and GOU are needed for BSC6900.

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

CN should support IP transportation.

Dependency on Other Features

NA

5.4.6 WRFD-050410 IP Transmission Introduction on Iur Interface

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.1.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R5.

Summary

This feature enables the Iur interface to be carried on the IP network.

Benefits

This feature provides a new Iur transport solution for operator. With IP transmission, transport

cost will decrease greatly compared with ATM transport cost.

Description

This feature provides Iur over IP transport solution including the following features:

Compliant with 3GPP R5 TR25.933

Support GE/FE/E1/T1 physical interface

Support IP over FE electrical interface

Support IP over GE electrical interface and GE optical interface (BSC6900 only)

Page 277: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 277 of 415

Support IP over STM-1/OC-3c optical interface (POS (Packet Over SDH)) (BSC6900

only)

Support IP over channelized STM-1/OC-3 optical interface(CPOS (Channelized POS))

(BSC6900 only)

Support IP over E1/T1 physical interface (BSC6900 only)

Support Diffserv mechanism and IEEE802.1P

Support IPV4

Support IP head compression

Support ML-PPP and MC-PPP

Support DHCP, PPP Mux and VLAN

Support FE/GE 1+1 backup redundancy

Support FE/GE load share redundancy

Support STM-1/OC-3c 1+1 and 1:1 MSP

Support channelized STM-1/OC-3 1+1 and 1:1 MSP

IP networking solution can be L1, L2, L3 networking on Iur interface similar to that on Iub

interface.

Besides the transport layer change, Iur IP brings some changes in CAC as well as service

differentiation.

In CAC, IP PATH is defined as the connection between SRNC and DRNC. Each IP PATH is

configured with a maximum DL PATH bandwidth and maximum UL PATH bandwidth, which

is configurable by operator. When a new call is coming, RNC will compare the required

service bandwidth with the available IP PATH bandwidth for UL and DL. The call will be

rejected if no enough IP PATH bandwidth is available. After the call is admitted, RNC will

reserve bandwidth as in use.

The Iub IP adopts the DiffServ for QoS differentiation, similar to the differentiated ATM PVC.

PHB is defined according to the traffic type, each PHB having a DSCP (DiffServ Code Point)

and priority.

Enhancement

In RAN10.0, packet over STM-1/OC-3c is supported.

In RAN10.0, packet over channelized STM-1/OC-3 is supported.

In RAN10.0, when the gateway or peer entity is faulty, this feature enables the RNC to detect

the link fault and then trigger IP re-route or board switch, thus avoiding packet loss and call

drop.

In RAN13.0, RNC integrated firewall is supported, which include the following functions:

The internal firewall inspects the incoming IP data over the OM interface and provides the

following functions:

IP address filter. This technique allows only the IP data from authorized IP addresses and

network segments.

Safeguard against attacks of ICMP ping, IP fragments, low TTL, smurf, and DDos.

Safeguard against attacks of TCP sequence prediction, and SYN flood.

Page 278: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 278 of 415

The internal firewall inspects the incoming IP data over the Iub, Iur, and Iu interfaces and

provides the following functions:

Intelligent white-listing: With this function, only data from permissible peer IP addresses and

ports and data of permissible protocol types can access the RNC.

Safeguard against ARP and ICMP flood

Safeguard against malformed packets

Limiting speed of the broadcast messages

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

Only the Dopra Linux operating system supports the RNC integrated firewall for the OM

interface.

Only the FG2c and GOUc boards support the RNC integrated firewall for the Iub, Iur,

and Iu interfaces.

To support BFD, the FG2 and GOU are needed for BSC6900.

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

The neighbouring RNC should also support IP transportation.

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

5.4.7 WRFD-050420 FP MUX for IP Transmission

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

Summary

This feature enables the multiplexing of FP packets on the IP network to improve the

transmission efficiency.

Page 279: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 279 of 415

Benefits Save IUB IP transport resource to provide higher transport efficiency for IUB IP

transport.

Without FP MUX, the efficiency for voice packet is less than 50%; with FP-MUX, the

efficiency for voice packet is up to 80%.

Description

When IP transport is adopted for Iub interface, the packet of user plane is encapsulated within

UDP/IP/L2, the UDP, IP and L2 encapsulated head is too large for short packet, which leads

to the low transport efficiency.

Packet multiplexing is adopted to enhance the transport efficiency. Using FP MUX feature,

multiple FP packets with same source IP, destination IP and DSCP (DiffServ Code Point) are

packed into one UDP/IP packet, with compressed UDP information. Since less packet head,

higher transport efficiency is achieved.

FP MUX is Huawei private protocol. RNC and Node B must support this feature

simultaneously. FG2a/FG2c and GOUa/GOUc of BSC6900, WFIE of BSC6800 and NUTI of

Node B support this feature.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

The FG2a/GOUa/FG2c/GOUc/POUc supports FP MUX for BSC6900.

WFIE support FP MUX for BSC6800

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-050402 IP Transmission Introduction on Iub Interface

Page 280: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 280 of 415

5.4.8 WRFD-050422 Dynamic Bandwidth Control of Iub IP

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

Summary

This feature enables the RNC to adjust the available transport bandwidth according to the

packet loss rate and jitter on links detected by IP PM.

Benefits

When the packet loss or jitter increases, RNC will reduce the transmitting throughput to

alleviate and eliminate congestion. Thus, there is less packet loss and jitter, less packet

retransmission rate, and the transport efficiency is enhanced.

Description

Following scenarios need dynamic bandwidth control:

1. ADSL and ADSL 2+ are adopted for Iub IP and the bandwidth of Iub interface is influenced

by line quality.

2. IP traffic convergence. There is congestion when multiple nodes transmit packets with large

throughput simultaneously. This will become normal when HSPA service is large deployed.

When IP transport is adopted for Iub transport, the packet is transmitted in UDP/IP format, so

there is no congestion detection and congestion elimination mechanism. If there is congestion

in the network, the delay will arise, even packet will lose. This will trigger RLC

retransmission and decrease the transport efficiency.

The dynamic bandwidth control of Iub IP adjusts the available transport bandwidth according

to the packet loss rate of link and jitter detected by IP PM (Performance Monitor). When the

packet loss rate or jitter increases, the available bandwidth decreases. When the packet loss

rate or jitter decreases, the available bandwidth is increases.

The principle of IP PM is similar to that of ATM OAM PM. One end sends an FM (Forward

Monitoring) message periodically, the other end responds to the PM with the BR (Backward

Reporting) message as soon as it receives the FM message.

With FM and BR, packet loss rate of link and jitter could be calculated accordingly.

Page 281: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 281 of 415

IP PM is Huawei private protocol. RNC and Node B must support this feature simultaneously.

FG2a/FG2c, GOUa/GOUc of BSC6900, WFIE of BSC6800 and NUTI of Node B support this

feature.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

The FG2 and GOU support this feature for BSC6900.

WFIE support this feature for BSC6800

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-050402 IP Transmission Introduction on Iub Interface

5.4.9 WRFD-050408 Overbooking on IP Transmission

Availability

This feature was available from RAN 6.1.

Summary

Overbooking on IP transmission can save Iub transmission resources.

Benefits

This feature can save many Iub transmission resources, reduce the transport CAPEX and

OPEX of the operator, and improve the perception of end users.

Description

Iub Overbooking on IP Transmission feature comprises of the following three parts:

Page 282: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 282 of 415

Iub Overbooking CAC algorithm on Iub IP transmission

Fast inner loop backpressure mechanism.

IP shaping and policing

The data rates of many services vary with time during transmission in UMTS RAN. For

example, the rate of voice service is 12.2 kbit/s during conversation, but very low during

silence because only a few data frames are transmitted.

If the RNC allocates the maximum bandwidth for each service, many Iub transport resources

will be wasted. For example, downloading a 50 KB page takes only about one second, but

reading this page needs tens of seconds. In this case, over 90% of the Iub transport bandwidth

is wasted which means a lot of service rejections and a small Iub bandwidth usage.

Service actually occupied bandwidth can be estimated through the active factor of the service.

Based on the active factor, the RNC allocates a proper Iub transport bandwidth for the service

to make the RNC admit service as much as possible. More traffic is admitted, more statistics

multiplexing gain could be get. This is called Iub Overbooking CAC algorithm.

With Iub Overbooking CAC algorithm, more services are admitted than without overbooking

CAC. However, a potential problem is: if all services transmit with data rate higher than

admitted bandwidth simultaneously, congestion on Iub interface will happen and packets will

lose. As a result, the end user perception is bad and Iub bandwidth usage is not optimal. Also,

this will disable the Iub overbooking CAC algorithm.

To solve possible data congestion, a fast inner loop backpressure mechanism is also

implemented in system. It is described as follows:

RNC monitors the buffer occupancy situation of each physical port and logic port at the Iub

transport network layer user plane continuously.

If the BO exceeds congestion threshold (TH2), system enters congestion state and a

congestion backpressure signal will be generated and sent to radio network layer user plane.

Then the RNL UP will decrease the data sending rate to release the congestion.

If the BO is lower than congestion release threshold (TH1), system enters normal state and a

congestion release backpressure signal will be generated and sent to RNL UP. Then the RNL

UP will increase the data sending rate.

If the BO is higher than discard threshold (TH3), system enters extreme congestion state and

data will be discarded at the TNL UP directly.

Page 283: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 283 of 415

Time

TH1

TH3

TH2

Buffer Occupancy

Time

TH1

TH3

TH2

Buffer Occupancy

RNL User Plane

Iub TNL User Plane

① ② ④ ⑤③

From CN

To NodeB

RNL User Plane

Iub TNL User Plane

① ② ④ ⑤③

From CN

To NodeB

With the backpressure mechanism, data loss will not occur and Iub bandwidth usage is

optimal.

IP shaping and policing feature is also supported and provides the virtual port traffic shaping

function. All data between RNC and Node Bs are classified and put into separate queues by

different service type. With IP shaping, RNC builds several logical ports on one physical port.

Each logical port has its queues for buffering and all logical ports are scheduled as a whole for

IP transmission. RNC monitors the buffer occupancy of each virtual port as well as total

buffer occupancy of physical port. With this feature, transport congestion and packet loss

could be effectively eliminated in the scenario of limited transport bandwidth.

For example, FE or GE is used in RNC side and E1 is adopted in Node B side, the bandwidth

for such Node B is limited by E1. Without IP shaping, RNC will transmit the traffic at the

physical bandwidth of FE or GE, the throughput to the Node B would exceed the bandwidth

Page 284: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 284 of 415

of Iub interface, and cause congestion and packet loss. The transport efficiency will degrade

due to packet loss and retransmission.

Enhancement

In RAN10.0, fast inner loop backpressure based on logic port is supported.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

RNC IP interface boards (WFIE/ WFEE/WEIE board for BSC6800 & PEUa /

FG2a/FG2c / UOIa IP/UOIc_IP/ GOUa/GOUc board for BSC6900) all support

backpressure mechanism.

FG2a/FG2c/GOUa/GOUc/UOIa_IP/UOIc_IP in BSC6900 and WFIE board in BSC6800

support LP shaping.

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-050402 IP Transmission Introduction on Iub Interface

5.4.10 WRFD-050107 IP routing Based Hub Node B

Availability

This feature was available from RAN 10.0

Summary

With this feature, Huawei Node B is capable of transmission convergence in IP transport

mode.

Benefits

Reduce costs in transmission lines with the obtained convergence gain.

Page 285: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 285 of 415

Description

The IP routing Based Hub Node B is a feature in IP transport mode. It is the extension of the

tree topology, as shown in the following figure. The downstream Node Bs connect to the RNC

after the convergence at the hub Node B. The convergence gain is obtained from this

topology.

RNC

NodeB

Hub NodeB

NodeB

NodeB

NodeB

NodeB

NodeB

The hub Node B supports connections to 2 level downstream Node Bs and provides IP routing

for downstream Node Bs. The different IP path convergence at the hub Node B and multiplex

the Iub bandwidth. The hub Node B supports up to 8 downstream Node Bs.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

Only 3900 series NodeB can support IP routing Based Hub Node B.

The BTS3902E doesn’t support this feature.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

Page 286: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 286 of 415

WRFD-050402 IP Transmission Introduction on Iub Interface

Hub Node B Based ATM QoS Management

5.4.11 WRFD-011500 PDCP Header Compression (RFC2507)

Availability

This feature is available from RAN2.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R99.

Summary

This feature complies with the header compression function of packet data as defined in RFC

2507. It enables the deletion of redundant information such as TCP/IP header. The system

compresses the redundant protocol header before the data is transmitted on a link. In addition,

the system can decompress the received data.

Benefits

This feature can decrease the throughput of the Uu interface and improve the efficiency of

radio links.

Description

For TCP packets in telecommunications, many fields are constant and others change with

small and predictable values. Depending on whether the fields remain constant or change in

specific patterns, some fields can be either excluded from each packet or represented in a

smaller number of bits. This is described as header compression. Header compression uses the

concept of packet stream context. A context is a set of data about field values and value

change patterns in the packet header. For each packet stream, the context is formed at the

compressor and the de-compressor. After the context is established on both sides, the

compressor can compress the packets.

For packet data, TCP/IP header always takes up too many bytes in the whole packet. By

compressing the header of the TCP/IP contexts, the radio link efficiency can be greatly

improved. Meanwhile, small packet data due to header compressed can shorten the data

latency as well as the RTT.

The algorithm for header compression includes:

Compressible Chain of Sub-header Judgment Algorithm

Packet Stream Judgment Algorithm

Twice Algorithm for TCP Packet Streams

Header Request Algorithm for TCP Packet Streams

Compression Slow-Start Algorithm for Non-TCP Packet Streams

Periodic Header Refresh Algorithm for Non-TCP Packet Streams

Page 287: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 287 of 415

Enhancement

In RAN5.0, IP V6 header compression is supported.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

UE should support the compression function.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

5.4.12 WRFD-012001 RNC Offload (Trial)

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0 and is for trial in RAN13.0.

Summary

This feature enables the RNC to directly transmit some PS packets to the Internet.

Benefits

The benefits of this feature are as follows:

Saves transmission resources

Saves cost of deploying the SGSN and GGSN

Reduces data transmission delay

Description

This feature enables the RNC to directly transmit some PS packets to the Internet through an

offload outlet instead of through the backbone between the Iu-PS interface and Gi interface,

SGSN, and GGSN. In this way, the cost of deploying backbone, SGSN, and GGSN is saved,

and the data transmission delay is reduced.

Page 288: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 288 of 415

The offload function in RAN13.0 is implemented through Network Address Translation

(NAT).

The feature is used to offload the downlink data flow by controlling the uplink data flow. The

RNC analyzes the uplink data flow and transmits the data flow that meets the rules to the

Internet.

In the actual networks, there are more downlink data than uplink data. To enable the downlink

data to be admitted through the offload outlet, the source IP addresses of the uplink data need

to be changed to the external IP address of the offload outlet through NAT. Consequently, the

IP packets from the server will go to the RNC instead of the GGSN. In this way, the RNC

controls the downlink data flow by controlling the uplink data flow.

Telecom operators can define the application scope of this feature, such as IMSI, cell, traffic

type, APN and IP address.

The following picture is for offload Policy based on destination IP address.

For services such as MMS, WAP gateway, and Portal, the servers may be placed after the

GGSN within the RAN. Generally, these services are value-added, which are charged

separately. Therefore, the CN needs to be involved. With this feature, the IP addresses of the

preceding servers can be configured in the RNC. Subsequently, the RNC can distinguish the

IP packets from the UE to these destination IP addresses and forward the packets to the CN

through the GTPU over the Iu-PS interface.

Other IP packets are sent to the Internet through the offload outlet of the RNC. In this way, the

cost can be reduced, and service delay can be shortened.

This feature can only support to trial in RAN13.0.

Enhancement

None

Page 289: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 289 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

Only the FG2c and GOUc boards support the Gi interface between the RNC and the Internet.

Dependency on NodeB hardware

None

Dependency on other RAN features

None

Dependency on other NEs

None

5.4.13 WRFD-050412 UDP MUX for Iu-CS Transmission

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

Summary

This feature enables multiple RTP units to be encapsulated in one UDP packet on the Iu-CS

interface to improve the transmission efficiency.

Benefits

This feature can improve the utilization of Iu transmission resources, protect customer

investment, and reduce operation cost.

Description

After IP transport is introduced to the Iu-CS interface, packets on the user plane are

encapsulated with RTP/UDP/IP header, which reduces the transport efficiency, especially

when short packets are concerned.

UDP multiplexing (MUX) can be used to solve the problem by adding a shorter UDP MUX

sub header which makes it possible to encapsulate multiple RTP units in one UDP packet,

therefore, less overhead and higher transport efficiency can be achieved. Such feature can be

applied no matter RTP compression is on or not.

Generally, the feature can improve the Iu CS transport efficiency by 30% to 40%.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

Page 290: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 290 of 415

The feature is only for BSC6900 and need to be configured with

FG2a/GOUa/FG2c/GOUc/POUc interface board.

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

The feature requires the CS CN element (MGW) to support UDP MUX.

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-050409 IP Transmission Introduction on Iu Interface

5.4.14 WRFD-140207 Iu/Iur Transmission Resource Pool in RNC

Availability

This feature is available from RAN14.0.

Summary

With this feature, multiple Iu or Iur interface boards form a transmission resource pool. A

network element (NE) interconnected with the RNC, such as a neighboring RNC (NRNC),

the MGW, the SGSN, or the GGSN, can access all boards in this pool. This helps balance the

load shared by these boards.

Benefits

Board and port utilization is improved and the load shared by Iu or Iur interface boards is

balanced.

RNC capacity expansion is easy to implement and IP route configurations for the RNC do not

need to be modified if either of the following conditions is met:

New user-plane IP addresses are assigned to an interconnected NE.

Existing user-plane IP addresses of an interconnected NE are modified.

Description

Before this feature is introduced, Iu or Iur interface boards and their ports are configured to

work in active/standby mode. This increases the transmission reliability, but decreases board

and port utilization and expanding the RNC capacity is a difficult process.

The following figure shows the networking of an Iu/Iur transmission resource pool:

Page 291: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 291 of 415

Core Network

IP1

IP4

IP3

IP2

CE

CE

Interface

board 1

Interface

board 2

Interface

board 3

Interface

board 4

IP/MPLS

After this feature is activated, a transmission resource pool is set up between multiple Iu or Iur

interface boards and an NE interconnected with the RNC can access all boards in this pool.

The RNC preferentially assigns new services to a lightly loaded interface board in this pool

based on the load sharing mechanisms.

With this feature, IP addresses in an Iu or Iur transmission resource pool are connected to a

fixed gateway. Therefore, IP route configurations for the RNC do not need to be modified if

either of the following conditions is met:

New user-plane IP addresses are assigned to an interconnected NE.

Existing user-plane IP addresses of an interconnected NE are modified.

In addition, SCTP links on the control plane are carried by two interface boards in this pool

using dual homing to ensure stable link connectivity.

In an Iu or Iur transmission resource pool, interface boards can work in active/standby mode

or independent mode. When interface boards work in active/standby mode, the transmission

reliability is high and ongoing calls are not interrupted even if an interface board becomes

faulty. When interface boards work in independent mode, the board utilization is high but

ongoing calls are interrupted if an interface board becomes faulty.

This feature requires that IP routers be used between the RNC and an interconnected NE and

that the interconnected NE be able to access all boards in the Iu or Iur transmission resource

pool.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

Only GOUc and FG2c boards support this feature.

Dependency on NodeB

None

Dependency on other NEs

An NE interconnected with the RNC must be able to access all boards in the Iu or Iur

transmission resource pool.

Page 292: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 292 of 415

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-050409 IP Transmission Introduction on Iu Interface

WRFD-050410 IP Transmission Introduction on Iur Interface

Dependency on professional services

Deploying this feature on RNC transmission ports that work in active/standby mode requires

Huawei professional services.

5.4.15 WRFD-140208 Iub Transmission Resource Pool in RNC

Availability

This feature is available from RAN14.0.

Summary

With this feature, multiple Iub interface boards form a transmission resource pool. Each

NodeB interconnected with the RNC can access all boards in this pool. This helps balance the

load shared by these boards.

Benefits

The benefits of this feature are as follows:

Improved board and port utilization

Easy RNC capacity expansion

Balanced load across Iub-interface boards

Description

Before this feature is introduced, Iub interface boards and their ports are configured to work

in active/standby mode. This increases the transmission reliability but decreases board and

port utilization. In addition, because each NodeB is connected to a fixed GE port on an Iub

interface board, expanding the RNC capacity is a difficult process, especially for NodeBs with

heavy traffic.

The following figure shows the networking of an Iub transmission resource pool:

NodeB

NodeB

IP1

IP4

IP3

IP2

CE

CE

Interface

board 1

Interface

board 2

Interface

board 3

Interface

board 4

IP/MPLS

Page 293: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 293 of 415

After this feature is activated, a transmission resource pool is set up between multiple Iub

interface boards and each NodeB interconnected with the RNC can access all boards in this

pool. The RNC preferentially assigns new services to a lightly loaded interface board in this

pool based on the load sharing mechanisms.

With this feature, the IP addresses in an Iub transmission resource pool are connected to a

fixed gateway. Therefore, IP route configurations for the RNC do not need to be modified

when an interconnected NodeB is undergoing capacity expansion or configuration

modification. In addition, SCTP links on the control plane are carried by two interface boards

in this pool using dual homing to ensure stable link connectivity.

In an Iub transmission resource pool, interface boards can work in active/standby mode or

independent mode. When interface boards work in active/standby mode, the transmission

reliability is high and ongoing calls are not interrupted even if an interface board becomes

faulty. When interface boards work in independent mode, the board utilization is high but

ongoing calls are interrupted if an interface board becomes faulty.

This feature requires that IP routers be used between the RNC and interconnected NodeBs and

that these NodeBs be able to access all boards in the Iub transmission resource pool.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

Only GOUc and FG2c boards support this feature.

Dependency on Node B

Only 3900 series base stations support this feature.

Dependency on other NEs

Node Bs interconnected with the RNC must be able to access all boards in the Iub

transmission resource pool.

Dependency on other RAN features

None

Dependency on professional services

Deploying this feature on RNC transmission ports that work in active/standby mode requires

Huawei professional services.

Page 294: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 294 of 415

5.5 Satellite Transmission

5.5.1 WRFD-050104 Satellite Transmission on Iub Interface

Availability

This feature is available from RAN3.0.

Summary

This feature enables the transmission through satellite links on the Iub interface.

Benefits

This transmission feature is provided to support certain difficult types of geographical

application environments, such as islands, deserts or places where there is a lack of terrestrial

transmission facilities available for the operator. In this case, the operator may propose to use

satellite transmission support for Iub interface connection to the rest of the UMTS network.

Description

This function supports satellite transmission on the Iub interface, which is useful to cover

remote districts, such as an island.

When satellite transmission is applied over the Iub interface, the delay increases and the timer

in SAAL/NBAP/ALCAP should be adjusted to avoid data or link error due to transmission

delay and to meet satellite transmission requirements.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

Page 295: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 295 of 415

NA

5.5.2 WRFD-050108 Satellite Transmission on Iu Interface

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.1.

Summary

This feature allows operator to set up the Iu interface connection with Satellite Transmission.

Benefits

This transmission feature supports certain difficult types of geographical application

environments, such as islands, deserts or places where lack of terrestrial transmission facilities

available for the operator. In this case, the operator may propose to use satellite transmission

support for Iu interface connection to the core network.

Description

Satellite communication is a special form of microwave trunk communication and functions

as the supplementary and standby means of common communication methods. Satellite

communication features wide coverage, little impact by terrains, good mobility performance,

and flexible link scheduling. However, the equipment cost and link rental cost are high, and

the transmission quality is likely to be affected by environments.

The extra loopback delay of satellite transmission is usually 500 ms to 700 ms. Generally, the

delay is about 600 ms. The delay depends on the distance between the Earth station and the

satellite and the satellite technologies.

This function is available for satellite transmission on the Iu interface and can be used to

cover remote areas, such as islands.

When satellite transmission is used on the Iu interface, the transmission delay prolongs. In

addition, the SAAL/UP timers should be adjusted to avoid data error or link failure due to

transmission delay. The related parameters can be set to meet the requirements of satellite

transmission.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

Page 296: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 296 of 415

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

5.6 Clock

5.6.1 WRFD-050501 Clock Sync on Ethernet in Node B

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.1.

Summary

This feature is introduced to provide a solution for clock synchronization in all-IP networking

mode. With this feature, the operator can keep clock synchronization for Node Bs without

changing the existing data network and adding QoS requirements of the transport network.

Benefits

The IP clock is one of the major features of the Iub interface in an all-IP network.

The Node B supports Ethernet clock synchronization and obtains timing signals form the IP

network. This feature provides a low-cost clock solution.

Description

In ATM networking, the Node B obtains timing signals from GPS, BITS, TDM, and so on. In

IP networking, however, there may be some problems. GPS is still available in an all-IP

network but causes inconvenience because the GPS antennas and feeders have to be presented.

Only a few Node Bs can obtain timing signals from BITS, and TDM cannot be used in all-IP

networks. Therefore, the Node Bs need to obtain timing signals from the IP network, which is

called clock synchronization on Ethernet.

The clock servers generate time stamps and send the time stamps to Node Bs, which act as

clock clients in this case. Because there is great delay in packet networks, Node Bs use an

adaptive method to get rid of the delay and restore the timing signals. The time stamps are set

in packets at the UDP layer, and then transmitted at physical layer after related packet head is

added so there will be an extra spending in bandwidth.

The following figure shows an example of networking.

Page 297: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 297 of 415

Note the following information:

There are clock servers and clock clients. The servers can be placed in the network

independently, and the clients are integrated into the Node Bs.

An adaptive algorithm is taken in the system. The clock servers send time stamps, and

clock clients receive time stamps to restore the frequency.

One clock server serves a maximum of 512 Node Bs.

Two or more clock servers can be used together to improve reliability. This is optional.

The required Iub transmission bandwidth of time stamps in unicast mode is from 5 kbit/s

to 100 kbit/s for each clock client. In most cases, 25 kbit/s is recommended.

Frequency accuracy obtained in the Node B complies with 3GPP.

Enhancement

RAN11.0 supports IEEE 1588V2.

RAN13.0 support the G.8265.1 frequency synchronization protocol which was defined based

on 1588V2 in 2010 by ITU. NodeB can work with the 3rd

party’s time server if the standard

protocol was supported by the server.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Page 298: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 298 of 415

Dependency on Other Network Units

Huawei clock server should support this feature.

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-050402 IP Transmission Introduction on the Iub Interface

5.6.2 WRFD-050502 Synchronous Ethernet

Availability

This feature was available from RAN 11.0

Summary

This feature is introduced to provide a solution for clock synchronization in all-IP networking

mode. It enables the clock to be extracted and recovered from the Ethernet physical layer

(PHY). As no additional hardware is required on the Node B and RNC sides, this feature is a

convenient solution for clock synchronization.

Benefits

The synchronous Ethernet technology is one of the key features in the solution for network

over all IP solution. It is an economical, convenient solution.

Description

The synchronous Ethernet technology extracts clock signals from the Ethernet link code flows.

It is a physical layer based clock synchronization technology. A highly precise clock is used

by the Ethernet physical layer (PHY) for data transmission. The receiving end extracts and

recovers the clock from data stream, and the high precision can be maintained. This is the

basic principle of synchronous Ethernet technology.

Page 299: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 299 of 415

In Node B, there is no extra synchronization equipment or hardware needed to realize

synchronous Ethernet technology.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

Only BSC6900 supports this feature.

Dependency on Node B

It is only applicable in 3900 series Node B.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

The synchronous Ethernet technology requires that all the equipments on the clock relay path

must support the synchronous Ethernet.

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-050402 IP Transmission Introduction on the Iub Interface

5.6.3 WRFD-050425 Ethernet OAM

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0 and is only applicable to the BSC6900.

Summary

This feature is related to point-to-point and end-to-end Ethernet OAM. It provides an effective

solution for Ethernet link management and fault detection.

Benefits The Ethernet OAM helps the operator to manage user access in terms of detection,

monitoring, and rectification of Ethernet faults.

This feature achieves reliability and high availability of Ethernet services, enables the

service provider to provide economical and efficient advanced Ethernet services, and

ensures that the services have high quality and reliability that are required by

telecommunications services.

This feature is implemented at the RAN equipment, thus minimizing the impact of

Ethernet bandwidth fluctuation or faults on RAN.

Page 300: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 300 of 415

Description

With the introduction of IP RAN to the WCDMA system, the Ethernet as a type of transport

bearer is widely applied. As a L2 protocol, Ethernet OAM can report the status of the network

at the data link layer, thus monitoring and managing the network more effectively.

The functions of Ethernet OAM consist of fault detection, notification, verification and

identification. The faults involve the hard faults that can be detected by the physical layer,

such as broken links, and the soft faults that cannot be detected by the physical layer, such as

memory bridging unit damage. Ethernet OAM plays a significant role in reducing

CAPEX/OPEX and complying with the Service Level Agreement (SLA).

RAN supports two types of Ethernet OAM: point-to-point Ethernet OAM (802.3ah) and

end-to-end Ethernet OAM (802.1ag). The two types are described as follows:

Point-to-point Ethernet OAM

The point-to-point Ethernet OAM complies with IEEE 802.3ah. What the point-to-point

Ethernet OAM takes into consideration is the last mile, rather than the specific services.

The OAM implements point-to-point maintenance of the Ethernet through mechanisms

such as OAM discovery, loopback, link monitoring, and fault detection.

End-to-end Ethernet OAM

The end-to-end Ethernet OAM complies with IEEE 802.7ag. With regard to the OAM

domain as a whole, it establishes end-to-end detection to perform maintenance of the

Ethernet based on the services.

Enhancement

RAN12.0 the end-to-end Ethernet OAM complies with IEEE 802.8ag.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

Only BSC6900 supports this feature.

Dependency on Node B

RAN11.0, BTS3812E/AE and DBS3800 can only support IEEE 802.1ag draft 7; 3900

series NodeB can support IEEE 802.3ah and IEEE 802.1ag draft 7.

Page 301: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 301 of 415

RAN12.0, BTS3812E/AE, DBS3800, 3900 series NodeB can support both IEEE 802.3ah

and IEEE 802.1ag draft 8.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-050402 IP Transmission Introduction on the Iub Interface, or

WRFD-050409 IP Transmission Introduction on the Iu Interface, or

WRFD-050410 IP Transmission Introduction on the Iur Interface

Page 302: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 302 of 415

6 Network Security

6.1 Reliability

6.1.1 WRFD-040202 RNC Node Redundancy

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0 and is only applicable to the BSC6900.

Summary

With this feature, Node Bs can be connected to multiple RNCs and heartbeat detection is

performed on the interfaces of the active RNC. When the active RNC is faulty, the Node Bs

can be fast switched to the standby RNC for service provisioning.

Benefits

This feature improves the reliability and robustness of RAN and shortens the time of service

interruption due to single-point failure of the RNC. Thus, the quality of service is improved.

Description

An RNC controls the radio resources of an RNS. If the RNC incurs faults, all the Node Bs

within the RNS cannot access the network and the communication in the entire area covered

by the RNS is disabled.

Aiming to avoid the above-mentioned situations, the RNC node redundancy provides a

backup scheme of network element level. The RNC supports 1+1 backup mode. The principle

of the 1+1 backup mode are as follows:

Two sets of transport links are configured for the Node B. One set of links are connected to

the master home RNC, and the other to the slave home RNC. (All the data related to Node Bs,

cells, and neighboring cells have backup on both RNCs.) In normal cases, the master home

RNC serves as the CRNC that controls the Node B. If the master RNC fails, the Node B tries

to use the slave RNC as its CRNC and resumes work.

Page 303: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 303 of 415

The Node B has two Iub interfaces (two sets of control plane, user plane and maintenance

plane links) and has two RNCs that can serve as the CRNC. Therefore, the cold backup (call

not protected) is implemented and the reliability is improved. The master and slave RNCs

have no active/standby relation with each other. Both are in working state under normal

conditions, which maximizes the utilization of the equipment. If one of the RNCs incurs faults,

the other RNC can take over all the Node Bs controlled by the faulty RNC. This prevents the

Node Bs from being out of service and prevents the single-point failure of RNC equipment

level.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

6.1.2 WRFD-040203 RRU Redundancy

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

Page 304: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 304 of 415

Summary

RRU redundancy can improve the reliability and robustness of the RAN, shorten the service

disruption time caused by RRU failure, and guarantee QoS.

Benefits

This feature can improve the reliability and robustness of the RAN, shorten the service

disruption time caused by RRU failure, and guarantee QoS.

Description

In some rural area wherein the environment is unfavorable, the maintenance of the RRU is

inconvenient. RRU redundancy provides the receiver and transmitter backup solution. In the

case of the RRU redundancy, a local cell is configured with two RRUs: one active RRU and

one standby RRU. When the active RRU fails, the standby RRU resumes work.

In the case of the transmit diversity cell or MIMO cell, the cell will drop down to

NON-diversity mode or NON-MIMO mode, which can keep the network operating normally.

In the case of the non-transmit diversity cell, when the active RRU fails, the cells on the

active RRU will be re-allocated to the standby RRU.

In the case of the transmit diversity or MIMO cell, when one transmit path of RRU fails, the

cells on the RRU will be re-established with non-transmit diversity or non-MIMO mode.

Meanwhile Node B will keep the same transmitter power as far as possible. The cell will

attempt to switch to the cell with transmit diversity or MIMO mode until the transmit path

fault is rectified.

The cell re-establishment will cause service interruption, wherein interruption time is less than

30s.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

BTS3902E can’t support this feature.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Page 305: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 305 of 415

Dependency on Other Features

NA

6.1.3 WRFD-021302 Iu Flex

Availability

This feature is available from RAN3.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R5.

Summary

This feature allows one physical RNC to be connected to multiple MSCs and/or SGSNs, and

these CS/PS domain nodes can form different pools that serve the same pool area.

Benefits

Iu Flex greatly enhances the serviceability of the whole network including:

Enhancing the flexibility of the Iu interface

Increasing the total capacity of CN nodes

Enhancing the disaster tolerance capability of CN nodes

Reducing the signaling traffic of the CN

Enhancing the system utilization

In conclusion, the Iu Flex greatly enhances the serviceability of the whole network.

Description

This function allows one physical RNC to connect to multiple MSCs and/or SGSNs, and

these CS/PS domain nodes can form different pools which serves the same pool area. The

pool area has the following characteristics:

A pool area is a collection of one or more MSC or SGSN serving areas.

A pool area is served by one or more CN nodes in parallel that share the traffic of this

area between each other.

The pool areas may overlap. The RAN Node belongs to all the overlapping pool areas.

In one pool area, the UE roams without needing to change the serving CN node.

The pool areas of the CS domain and of the PS domain are configured independently.

Therefore, the pool area enhances the flexibility of the Iu interface, and the typical structure of

Iu Flex is shown as the figure below.

Page 306: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 306 of 415

Area 1

RAN

node

Area 5

RAN

node

Area 6

RAN

node

Area 7

RAN

node

Area 8

RAN

node

Area 2

RAN

node

Area 3

RAN

node

Area 4

RAN

node

PS pool-area 2PS pool-area 1

CS pool-

area 2CS pool-

area 1

MSC 3MSC 2

MSC 1

MSC 6MSC 5

MSC 4

SGSN 6

SGSN 2

SGSN 1

SGSN 5

SGSN 4

SGSN 3

MSC 7

The Network Resource Identity (NRI) identifies uniquely an individual CN node that serves a

pool area. Each CN node that supports the Iu Flex is configured with one or more specific

NRIs.

The CN node allocates the route information to the UE. If the CN node supports the Iu Flex,

the TMSI (or P-TMSI) allocated by the node contains the NRI. Then UE encodes the route

information which consists of 10 bits according to the TMSI (or P-TMSI), and sends the

parameter to the RNC through the INITIAL DIRECT TRANSFER message. Such a message

contains an IE ”Intra Domain NAS Node Selection (IDNNS)” which consists of not only the

route parameter but also an indication about from which identity (TMSI/PTMSI, IMSI, IMEI)

the route parameter is derived. Then RNC will use NAS Node Selection Function (NNSF) to

select the proper CN node (MSC or SGSN) for the UE. That is, if the NNSF finds the CN

node that the NRI derived from the initial NAS signaling message identifies, it routes the

message or frame to that CN node. Otherwise, the NNSF selects an available CN node

according to the signaling load balancing.

The UE encodes the route information according to the following rules:

The UE preferentially encodes the route information identified by the TMSI or P-TMSI.

If the TMSI or P-TMSI is unavailable and the UE contains the USIM or SIM card, the

UE encodes the route information identified by the IMSI.

If the TMSI or P-TMSI is unavailable and the UE does not contain the USIM or SIM

card, the UE encodes the route information identified by the IMEI.

Page 307: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 307 of 415

Accordingly, RNC selects the route based on the route parameter in the IDNNS of the

INITIAL DIRECT TRANSFER message as follows:

When the route parameter is derived from the TMSI or P-TMSI

The RNC derives the NRI from the parameter according to the configured length of the

NRI. Then the RNC selects the CN node according to the configured corresponding

relationship between the NRI and the CN node. If no NRI is configured to the CN node,

the RNC selects a CN Node based on the load balancing.

When the route parameter is derived from the IMSI

The parameter is an integer within the range from 0 through 999. The value can be

derived by (IMSI/10) MOD 1000. When route parameter is derived from the IMSI, it

should be indicated by the “IDNNS” IE that the current call attempt is an originating or

terminating call (response to paging).

For originating call, RNC would select the CN node according to either the IMSI V

value (the corresponding relationship between the IMSI V value and the CN node should

be preconfigured) or load balancing.

For terminating call, RNC should attempt to get the previously stored IMSI and Global

CN-Id. If succeeded, the CN node identified by the found Global CN-Id will be selected.

Otherwise, CN node will be selected as originating call.

When the route parameter is derived from the IMEI

The RNC selects the CN Node based on load balancing.

CS domain IMSI Paging handling

To increase the success rate of routing the paging response message to the CN node that

issues the paging request, the Iu-Flex-capable RNC needs to process the IMSI paging

message as follows:

In R5 protocols, an optional IE “Global CN-ID” is added to the RANAP PAGING message. If

RNC provides the Iu Flex feature and the paging message contains only the IMSI rather than

the TMSI, the paging message must contain Global CN-ID.

The NNSF in the RNC temporarily stores the IMSI and Global CN-ID upon reception of the

paging message. When the NNSF receives the INITIAL DIRECT TRANSFER message (a

paging response with an IMSI), it directly forwards the paging response to the CN node

identified by the Global CN-ID.

If the CN node is set to Mode 1 which indicates the Gs interface existing, the paging message

of the CS domain might be delivered on the Iu-PS interface. In this case, the SGSN adds the

Global CN-ID of the CS domain into the paging message.

Load Balancing Criteria

When the mapping between UE and CN node is not found, RNC will select a proper one

based on load balancing. The criteria is to select the lightest load CN node according to the

OVERLOAD indication from Iu interface and when the loads are the same, they will be

selected in turn.

The NRI length and the mapping relation between IMSI route parameters in IDNNS and CN

Node can be configured as needed.

Load balancing based on the capacity of CNs can also be used in the case that NNSF can not

get right NRI from the initial NAS signaling message. The traffic will be distributed to CNs

according to their capacity ratio.

Page 308: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 308 of 415

Enhancement

In RAN6.1, load balancing based on the capacity of CNs is supported.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

Require MSC or SGSN support such feature at the same time.

Dependency on Other Features

NA

6.1.4 WRFD-021306 Iu Flex Load Distribution Management

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.1.

Summary

This feature enables load balancing between multiple CN nodes in Iu Flex scenarios.

Benefits

Improving the performance and meeting the operator’s load distribution strategy in Iu Flex

networking scenario.

Description

This feature includes enhanced load balancing and load re-distribution. It's applicable for both

CS domain and PS domain.

Enhanced load balancing

According to 3GPP TS 23.236, when IMSI V value is carried by UE, RNC may route the IDT

message based on the pre-configured IMSI routing parameters, that is, the mapping

relationship between IMSI V value and CN-Id. Actually, it is hard work for operators to

configure these parameters.

Page 309: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 309 of 415

In this feature, the configuration for IMSI routing parameters is optional. For each IMSI V

value, load balancing is performed if routing parameter for this V value does not exist.

Load balancing in proportion based on the capacity of CN nodes is also introduced in this

feature. Because the capacity of the connected MSCs (CS domain)/SGSNs (PS domain) differ

from each other, the capacity of each MSC/SGSN should be take into account to balance the

load between MSCs/SGSNs, and the capacity of each MSC/SGSN can be configured by

operator or informed by MSC/SGSN through the messages INFORMATION TRANSFER

IND and INFORMATION TRANSFER CONFIRM with Huawei private extension IE. RNC

will distribute the UE according to the CN capacity ratio, this will avoide the impact for the

low capacity CN when too many UE in the system can not get the CN relation mapping.

Load Re-distribution

This feature is introduced from 3GPP R6, and is used to off-load traffic for MSC/SGSN. It's

helpful for some specific cases, such as the safely preparing for MSC/SGSN migration,

quickly restoring the load of MSC/SGSN that is recovered from failure, and so on. For load

re-distribution, two important identities are introduced, namely, "null-NRI" and

"Non-broadcast LAI/RAI".

This procedure is initiated from the MSC/SGSN, and the cooperation from the RNC is

required. During the load re-distribution phase, "Non-broadcast LAI/RAI" will be allocated to

UE by MSC/SGSN, which will trigger the Location/routing area updating procedure.

"Null-NRI" will be carried in the subsequent IDT message. The RNC will then route such

IDT message to MSCs/SGSNs which are not in "off-load" state. The "off-load" state should

be preconfigured on RNC for MSCs/SGSNs to off-load.

In RAN10.0, new counters related to load balancing are added including:

1. VS.LdBalRt.IMSI: The user number that was routed to CN node according to IMSI during

the load balance procedure.

2. VS.LdBalRt.InValidNRI: The user number that was routed to CN node, where the user’s

NRI is invalid, during the load balance procedure.

3. VS.LdBalRt.IMEI: The user number that was routed to CN node according to IMEI during

the load balance procedure.

Enhancement

In RAN10.0, following features are enhanced:

The capacity of each MSC/SGSN can be informed by MSC/SGSN through

INFORMATION TRANSFER IND and INFORMATION TRANSFER CONFIRM

messages with Huawei private extension IE.

New counters related to load balancing are added.

CN node status is reported to M2000 when the CN node status is changed.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Page 310: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 310 of 415

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-021302 Iu Flex

6.1.5 WRFD-140209 NodeB Integrated IPSec

Availability

This feature is available from RAN14.0.

Summary

This feature enables encrypted transmissions between the NodeB and the RNC or Security

Gateway (S-GW) to ensure data confidentiality, integrity, and anti-replay protection. With this

feature, operators can deploy a secure end-to-end network.

Benefits

This feature ensures network reliability and security by establishing a virtual dedicated transport

network on a public IP network. This feature costs less than external IPSec solutions.

Description

The IPSec provides a framework of a series of Request For Comment (RFC) standards dealing

with the following:

Authentication Header (AH)

Encapsulating Security Protocol (ESP)

Internet Key Exchange (IKE)

Authentication and encryption algorithms

The IPSec is designed to ensure data source authentication, data confidentiality, and

connectionless packet integrity and to provide services such as access control and anti-replay

protection. The IPSec provides a secure end-to-end network solution by means of data

encryption and authentication at the network layer. Huawei NodeBs incorporate the integrated

IPSec function to prevent RAN data from unauthorized access or being tampered with in IP

transmission mode.

Note that the frame structure of packets remains unchanged before and after encryption, and

therefore encrypted packets can still be transmitted over the Internet.

Page 311: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 311 of 415

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

None

Dependency on Node B

The NodeB must be configured with a UTRPc or UMPT board.

Dependency on UE

None

Dependency on other NEs

In a UMTS network, the S-GW must support the IPSec function on the RNC side.

Dependency on other CN

None

Dependency on other RAN features

None

6.1.6 WRFD-140210 NodeB PKI Support

Availability

This feature is available from RAN14.0.

Summary

This feature enables the NodeB on a live network to use the Certificate Management Protocol

version 2 (CMPv2) to automatically obtain a device digital certificate signed by the operator's

certificate authority (CA). With the device digital certificate, the NodeB and other network

elements authenticate each other according to IPSec, 802.1x, and Secure Sockets Layer (SSL).

Benefits

This feature enables network elements to authenticate each other and ensures network security.

Description

The CMP is an Internet protocol used for obtaining digital certificates in a public key

infrastructure (PKI). The CMP uses the certificate request message format (CRMF) defined in

RFC 2511.

This feature provides various packet and data structures related to certificate management. The

CMP provides various functions, such as certificate registration and application, key update, key

Page 312: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 312 of 415

recovery, certificate cancellation, cross authentication, CA key update notification, certificate

issue notification, and certificate cancellation notification.

In actual networks, operators require network elements to use certificates signed by the

operator's CA to implement IPsec, 802.1x, or SSL authentication. With this feature, NodeBs

automatically perform these procedures, including certificate registration, application, and

update.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

None

Dependency on Node B

A UTRPc board must be configured or the UMPT board must support PKI.

Dependency on UE

None

Dependency on other NEs

The operator's CA must be deployed in the network.

Dependency on CN

None

Dependency on other RAN features

In the UMTS network, a security gateway must be configured to support IPsec and CMPv2 on

the RNC side.

Page 313: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 313 of 415

7 Network Performance

7.1 Coverage Enhancement

7.1.1 WRFD-010203 Transmit Diversity

Availability

This feature is available from RAN2.0.

Summary

TX diversity enables the Node B to provide twice the number of RF DL channels compared

with no TX diversity. This feature can support STTD, TSTD, and CLD1 to effectively

improve the reception performance of the UE. In TX diversity mode, the UE must support

diversity reception.

Benefits

TX diversity can improve terminal performance in special circumstances, especially when

there is less valid multi-path effect and the UE speed is low. In this case, capacity and

coverage can be obviously improved and investment can be reduced while the same QoS is

guaranteed and the CAPEX and OPEX can be cut down by operators.

Description

There are several transmit diversity modes adopted in WCDMA 3GPP, namely the Time

Switched Transmit Diversity (TSTD) mode, Space Time Transmit Diversity (STTD) mode,

and Closed Loop Transmit Diversity Mode1 (CLD1). The TSTD and the STTD are open loop

transmit diversity, which do not need feedback information compared with the closed loop

diversity. The following table summarizes the possible application of open and closed loop

transmit diversity modes on different types of downlink physical channels.

Page 314: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 314 of 415

Physical channel type Open loop mode Closed loop mode

TSTD STTD Mode 1

P-CCPCH – X –

SCH X – –

S-CCPCH – X –

DPCH – X X

PICH – X –

MICH – X –

HS-PDSCH – X X

HS-SCCH – X –

E-AGCH – X –

E-RGCH – X –

E-HICH – X –

AICH – X –

If a cell works in TX diversity mode, the CPICH, PCCPCH, and SCH of the cell must also

work in TX diversity mode.

There are two types of physical channels that can use the Closed Loop Transmit Diversity

Mode1 (CLD1), that is, DPCH and HS-PDSCH. Huawei RAN6.0 supports this feature.

Enhancement

In RAN5.0, after the HSDPA feature is deployed, STTD for HS-PDSCH and HS-SCCH is

supported.

In RAN6.0, after the HSUPA feature is deployed, STTD for E-AGCH, E-RGCH and E-HICH

is supported.

Closed Loop Transmit Diversity Mode1 is a new feature of RAN6.0.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

TX diversity requires the Node B to provide two times RF channel resources compared with

no TX diversity mode. In TX diversity mode, the UE must support diversity reception, STTD,

TSTD, and CLD1.

Page 315: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 315 of 415

Dependency on UE

The UE must support diversity reception, STTD, TSTD, and CLD1.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

7.1.2 WRFD-010209 4-Antenna Receive Diversity

Availability

This feature is available from RAN3.0.

Summary

The 4-antenna RX diversity technology enables the Node B to provide twice the number of

RF UL channels compared with the 2-antenna RX diversity technology. In this way, the

system can obtain a higher UL coverage gain.

Benefits

It can improve receiver sensitivity and uplink coverage, so that the CAPEX is reduced.

Description

Receive diversity refers to a technique of monitoring multiple frequencies from the same

signal source, or multiple radios and antennas monitoring the same frequency, in order to

combat signal fade and interference.

Receive diversity is one way to enhance the reception performance of uplink channels. It does

not involve RNC or UE.

Huawei Node Bs support both RX diversity and none RX diversity. In RX diversity mode, the

Node B can be configured with 4 antennas (4-way), and 4 antennas for economical purpose

(4-way economical) through the Antenna Magnitude parameter. The only difference between

4-way and 4-way economical modes is that in the latter mode signals on the random access

channel are received from two antennas, but the signals on the dedicate channel are received

from four antennas.

In RX diversity mode, the Node B does not require additional devices and works with the

same algorithms. The 4-way RX diversity requires twice the number of RX channels

compared with 2-way RX diversity. The number of RX channels depends on the settings of

the antenna connectors on the cabinet top.

Enhancement

None.

Page 316: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 316 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

The RX diversity requires the Node B to provide enough RF channels and demodulation

resources that can match the number of diversity antennas.

The BTS3902E doesn’t support this feature.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

7.1.3 WRFD-021308 Extended Cell Coverage up to 200km

Availability

This feature is available from RAN3.0.

Summary

With this feature, the operator can use less Node Bs to extend the cell coverage.

Benefits

Improve the cell coverage to enable the ultra coverage with the minimal site number.

Description

This feature is helpful for scenarios of low capacity and ultra coverage (such as seas, deserts,

and rural areas). The cell coverage will extend to 30km ~ 200km.

Before RAN10.0, the increase in cell range up to 180 km does not require additional hardware

from a functional perspective, as long as the HBBI (macro Node B BTS3812E/BTS3812AE)

or HBBU (Distributed Node B DBS3800) board is used. For cell ranges above 30 km

hardware dimensioning is required for RACH, i.e. one HBBI or one HBBU board per

cell-carrier is needed.

In RAN10.0, new hardware WBBP (3900 Node B), EBBI (macro Node B

BTS3812E/BTS3812AE) , EBOI (macro Node B BTS3812E/BTS3812AE) or EBBC (Distributed Node B DBS3800) board increases in cell range up to 200 km from a functional

Page 317: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 317 of 415

perspective. For cell ranges above 30 km, there is no impact in hardware dimensioning, i.e.

one WBBPb4 can support 6 cell-carriers.

The improved cell coverage does not require additional hardware, but the environment should

be open and flat like sea coverage. The antenna will be installed on the hills or on a high

tower. It’s better to use four-antenna-diversity. High output power.

The network planning and parameter will be optimized, such as higher CPICH power.

Enhancement

In RAN10.0, Extended Cell Coverage is up to 200 km.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

The WBBP (3900 series Node B), EBBI (BTS3812E/AE), EBOI and EBBC/EBBM

(DBS3800) are required for this feature.

BTS3902E can’t support this feature.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

7.1.4 WRFD-021309 Improved Downlink Coverage

Availability

This feature is available from RAN 6.1.

Summary

This feature supports the deltaqrxlevmin parameter introduced in 3GPP R5. It can extend the

DL coverage of a cell.

Benefits Improves the downlink coverage and UE access capability

Improves the cell capacity by adjustment of PCPICH power in indoor scenario

Page 318: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 318 of 415

Improves the access capability in long distance coverage scenario

Reduces the sites number required.

Description

With supporting the parameter deltaqrxlevmin introduced in 3GPP Release5, UE is allowed

to camp on the cell and access the network with CPICH RSCP that is -119 dBm, therefore,

improve the downlink coverage compared to the original -115dBm.

Such parameter deltaqrxlevmin can be configured by operator.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-021308 Extended Cell Coverage up to 200km

7.1.5 WRFD-020138 HSUPA Coverage Enhancement at UE Power Limitation

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0.

Summary

This technique is introduced in 3GPP Release 8 to improve the coverage performance for

HSUPA services on the HSUPA cell edge.

Page 319: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 319 of 415

Benefits

This feature improves coverage at the HSUPA cell edge for BE services and voice services.

The emulation results show that the coverage can be increased by about 10%.

Description

This feature improves the HSUPA coverage performance through HSUPA power control

enhancement at UE power limitation introduced in 3GPP Release 8.

When a UE detects that its transmit power is limited, the UE enters power scaling mode. In

this mode, the transmit power on uplink physical channels is reduced proportionately to

improve coverage quality.

In the traditional power-scaling technique, the power offset of E-DPDCH relative to DPCCH

is not the most appropriate value, and therefore scaling mode offers only limited gains. In the

enhanced power scaling technique, the network side provides optimized transport block size

and the power offset of E-DPDCH relative to DPCCH. The UE uses these optimized settings

when its power is limited at the cell edge. In contrast to the traditional power-scaling

technique, the enhanced technique allows for more appropriate transport block size and

E-DPDCH power-offset settings, improving coverage performance at the HSUPA cell edge.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

None

Dependency on NodeB hardware

None

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

Dependency on other NEs

The UE needs to support 3GPP Release 8 or later. It also needs to support improved EUL

power control at UE power limitation.

7.2 Spectrum Efficiency Improvement

7.2.1 WRFD-021001 Flexible frequency bandwidth of UMTS carrier

Availability

This feature is available from RAN12.0.

Page 320: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 320 of 415

Summary

Huawei provide flexible frequency bandwidth range from 4.2MHz to 5MHz with algorithm

enhancement. Thus, Huawei can suppport the frequency separation range from 2.2MHz to

2.6MHz in UMTS and GSM co-site scenario. And Huawei also can suppport the frequency

separation range from 4.2MHz to 5MHz in UMTS and UMTS co-site scenario.

Benefits

It will increase the frequency utilization and provide UMTS mode even the frequency

resource is not enough for 5MHz. This feature can solve the problem that frequency is rare

resources for operators.

Description

Usually, the frequency bandwidth of UMTS must be 5MHz. With the development of 3G

service, the frequency resource is become more and more rare. The conflict is evident on the

high quality frequency band. Many operators can’t refarm 5MHz for the limited frequency

resource, but they want to deploy the new services on 850/900MHz for the competition

pressure. Through algorithm enhancement, Huawei can support frequency bandwidth less

than 5MHz. The feature only can be used in GU or UU co-site scenario.

However, KPI is impacted even with carefully network planning and optimization when

frequency bandwidth is less than 5MHz. The impact on the KPI can be reduced with Huawei

professional service, but it can’t get rid of the impact thoroughly. Thus, operator must balance

between the KPI and bandwidth utilization.

Due to the sensitivity of the KPIs when adopting this feature, Huawei recomends to operators

to use Huawei 's network optimization services to ensure accurate setting and fine tuning of

the different parameters in order to obtain the optimum KPIs.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

For 4.6M~5M(including 4.6M),all the RF module can support this feature.

For 4.2M~4.6M(excluding 4.6M), only 850M/1900M RRU3804, 850M WRFU, MRFU

v1/v2 and MRRU v1/v2, WRFUd, RRU3828, RRU3829, RRU3928, RRU3929, MRFUd,

MRFUe can support this feature.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Page 321: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 321 of 415

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

7.3 High Speed Mobility

7.3.1 WRFD-010206 High Speed Access

Availability

This feature is available from RAN 5.1.

Summary

With the advent of higher-speed vehicles, how to provide mobile communication services on

a high-speed moving vehicle becomes a challenge for the operator. This feature is one of the

major high-speed coverage solutions.

Benefits

High speed access is one of the key features in the differential solution for high speed

coverage. The Node Bs using high speed access supports coverage under which the moving

speed of UEs can exceed 400 km/h.

Description

Currently, the high-speed trains in some countries and regions can reach speeds of 200 km/h

to 300 km/h. The maglev train in Shanghai can reach a maximum speed of 430 km/h.

High-speed access is one of the key features in the high-speed coverage differentiation

solution. With this feature, the Node B can provide the coverage for the UE moving at a speed

of up to 450 km/h.

When the UE moves at a high speed, Doppler shift occurs. As Doppler shift affects the signal

reception on the baseband unit of the Node B, automatic frequency control (AFC) should be

implemented on the RAKE receiver. The Node B supports AFC for UL DPCH and PRACH.

The parameter "High Speed Movement Mode" can be used to activate AFC on the PRACH.

The frequency offset can be mapped to the maximum moving speed through the parameter

"Speed Rate (km/h)" on the LMT.

When this feature is enabled, the Extended Cell status will not be supported any more. The

capability of the HULP, HBBI, and HBBU carrying access channels falls (each board can

carry access channels for only one cell). In addition, this feature is not supported when

4-antenna RX diversity is configured.

the WBBP, EBBI, EBOI and EBBC are added to support this feature without compromising

the performance.

Page 322: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 322 of 415

Enhancement

In RAN10.0, the WBBP, EBBI, EBOI and EBBC are added to support this feature without

compromising the performance.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

7.3.2 WRFD-021350 Independent Demodulation of Signals from Multiple RRUs in One Cell

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0.

Summary

The feature of independent demodulation of signals from multiple RRUs in one cell enables

the signals from multiple RRUs to be demodulated independently and combined within a

BBU. It effectively reduces the number of handovers between cells for users.

Benefits

This feature introduces independent demodulation of signals from multiple RRUs in one cell.

Different RRU coverage areas in the same cell can reduce the number of handovers between

cells and increase cell capacity and throughput. Multiple RRU coverage areas can also be

used to flexibly form wire-shaped coverage areas. Using a relatively small number of cells,

the coverage needs of transportation routes can be met.

Description

This feature provides independent demodulation of signals from multiple RRUs in one cell. In

uplink, the NodeB performs independent demodulation and combination of the multiple RRU

Page 323: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 323 of 415

receiver signals within a BBU. In downlink, the NodeB copies the signal of a cell and outputs

it to multiple RRUs. Each RRU has its own antenna covering different sectors. Multiple

RRUs belonging to one cell possess the same scrambling code.

Baseband combination technology is used. Therefore, multiple RRU combined signals will

not introduce signal background noise or influence uplink receiver sensitivity.

In RRU cascade scenario, one 1.25G CPRI can support independent demodulation of

maximum 4 RRU in a cell; a 2.5G CPRI can support independent demodulation of maximum

6 RRU in a cell. Similarly, if there are 2 frequencies in one RRU, then one 1.25G CPRI can

support independent demodulation of maximum 2 RRU in a cell and a 2.5G CPRI can support

independent demodulation of maximum 4 RRU in a cell.

This feature is suitable for coverage in special locations with high speed motion such as

highways, railroad tracks, or formula 1 tracks.

When using this feature, 4-Antenna Receive Diversity, TX diversity, MIMO, FDE,UL

CELL_FACH enhancement or extended cell cannot be supported.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

None

Dependency on NodeB hardware

This feature is only supported by the DBS3900 series. In addition, the DBS3900 must be

configured with the WBBPb or WBBPd board.

The BTS3902E doesn’t support this feature.

Dependency on other RAN features

None

Dependency on other NEs

None

Page 324: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 324 of 415

7.4 Intra-system Mobility Management

7.4.1 WRFD-020302 Inter Frequency Hard Handover Based on Coverage

Availability

This feature is available from RAN2.0

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R99.

Summary

This feature introduces inter-frequency hard handover triggered by Active Set quality

measurement event 2D or by Uplink Radio Link Qos or emergency blind handover triggered

by event 1F.

Benefits

Coverage based Inter frequency hard handover provides supplementary coverage in

inter-frequency networking cells to prevent call drop, therefore, improve the network

performance and end user feeling.

Enhancement of inter frequency hard handover between multi frequency band cells can be

used to support multi frequency band networking scenario.

Description

Inter frequency hard handover is hard handover between cells of different frequencies. It can

be triggered by coverage, load or speed which is suitable for the corresponding scenarios. The

trigger condition based on the cell load belongs to the optional feature which is described in

WRFD-020103 Inter Frequency Load Balance. The trigger condition based on the UE speed

which is evaluated by RNC belongs to the optional feature which is described in

WRFD-021200 HCS (Hierarchical Cell Structure). In this feature, the handover is triggered

by coverage reason.

This trigger condition is based on the quality measurement. The compressed mode

measurement for DL or UL will be triggered by event measurement report 2D for

inter-frequency or inter-RAT handover and stopped by event measurement report 2F. When

compressed mode measurement is triggered, RNC will start the inter frequency measurement

in UE to get the target cell to handover if inter-frequency neighboring cells are configured.

The measurement quantity is combination of RSCP and Ec/N0. The compressed mode can

also be triggered by the combination of Ec/N0 and RSCP. Moreover, event 2B and period

measurement report mode are supported and which measurement quantity and mode to use

can be configured by operator. The measurement related parameters including threshold,

hysteresis, and trigger delay time, etc. The inter-frequency neighboring cell number can be up

to 64.

The compressed mode is divided into two types, namely, spreading factor reduction (SF/2)

and high layer approaches. The type of compressed mode to be used is decided by the RNC

automatically, according to the configurable spreading factor used in uplink and downlink.

Page 325: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 325 of 415

Another measurement report 1F can also trigger inter-frequency hard handover, but

compressed mode will not be triggered in this scenario since such a report means a call drop

may occur at any time and there is no time to implement the measurement procedure. The

target cell of handover is selected based on the equivalent down link overage of the inter

frequency blind neighboring cells. By this means the handover success rate can be guaranteed,

and the equivalent down link coverage is represented by RSCP of CPICH channel which is

determined after network planning.

Inter-frequency handover triggered by limitation of UE Tx power or high UL BLER is

available for PS BE, CS AMR and VP services.

In multi frequency band networking scenario which is described in WRFD-020110 Multi

Frequency Band Networking Management, the inter frequency hard handover is enhanced to

meet the networking requirements. That is, coverage based hard handover between different

frequency bands is supported and UE measurement capability will be considered to guarantee

that the UE is not handed over to the cell where the UE does not have the corresponding

capability on that frequency band. When the capability of the UE is insufficient can be

acquired, whether to implement the handover can be configured by operator.

Enhancement

In RAN3.0, event report mode and periodical report mode are supported.

In RAN5.1, compressed mode is triggered by combination of Ec/N0 and RSCP is supported.

In RAN5.1, puncturing mode as one compressed mode type is not supported anymore since

such a mode has been removed from 3GPP.

In RAN6.0, coverage based inter-frequency hard handover between multi frequency band cell

is supported.

In RAN6.0, combination of RSCP and Ec/N0 measurement is supported when triggering

compressed mode measurement, and available only for periodic measurement report mode.

In RAN10.0, combination of RSCP and Ec/N0 measurement is available when event 2B

measurement report mode is selected.

In RAN10.0, the inter-frequency handover triggered by limitation of UE Tx power or high UL

BLER is applicable to the PS BE, CS AMR, and VP services.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

UE should support the relevant measurements and the procedure of handover.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

Page 326: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 326 of 415

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

7.4.2 WRFD-020304 Inter Frequency Hard Handover Based on DL QoS

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R99.

Summary

When the load of services is higher in the cell and downlink QoS drops, this feature enables

the UE to be handed over to an inter-frequency cell, thus guaranteeing QoS requirements.

Benefits

DL QoS based inter frequency hard handover provides the method to prevent call drop and

guarantee the QoS in inter-frequency networking, therefore, improves the network

performance and enhances end user experience.

Description

In the scenarios of severe fading and high load, the call drop could take place due to the

limitation of DL transmitted code power. In addition, coverage area is different for different

services in network planning, thereby the system should take actions in order to guarantee the

downlink QoS and keep the connection as could as possible. The evaluation of downlink QoS

status is on the basis of TCP (Transmitted Code Power) or RLC retransmission (only for PS

BE).

Once the downlink QoS is detected to be in bad condition, inter-frequency handover could be

triggered:

For AMR and VP services, inter-frequency handover could be triggered based on TCP.

For PS BE service, inter-frequency handover could be triggered based on TCP and RLC

retransmission.

This feature can be switched on/off separately for AMR, VP and PS BE services.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Page 327: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 327 of 415

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-020302 Inter Frequency Hard Handover Based on Coverage

7.4.3 WRFD-020605 SRNS Relocation Introduction Package

Availability

This feature is available from RAN2.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R99.

Summary

This feature provides multiple solutions for user mobility between RNCs. The solutions

include the static relocation solution (with Iur interface), and hard handover/cell update/URA

update relocation solutions (without Iur interface).

Benefits Reduce the bandwidth occupied by the Iur interface.

Reduce the transmission delay of user plane.

Get the parameters of cell-level algorithms to optimize the performances.

Ensure that communications are not interrupted when the UE moves to the coverage area

of another RNC while the Iur interface is not available.

Help to keep the integrity and continuity of the data transfer, and improve the best effort

service performance during the SRNS relocation procedure.

Description

The serving RNS (SRNS) manages the connection between the UE and the UTRAN and can

be relocated.

The SRNS Relocation Introduction Package includes following features:

SRNS Relocation (UE Not Involved)

SRNS Relocation with Hard Handover

SRNS Relocation with Cell/URA Update

Lossless SRNS Relocation

Page 328: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 328 of 415

Enhancement

In RAN3.0, RAN5.0 SRNS Relocation Introduction Package is enhanced. For details, please

refer to the enhancement of the features in the package.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

The CN and DRNC must support this feature simultaneously.

Dependency on CN

The CN node must support this feature simultaneously.

Dependency on Other Features

NA

7.4.4 WRFD-02060501 SRNS Relocation (UE Not Involved)

Availability

This feature is available from RAN2.0.

Summary

This feature supports the SRNS procedure based on the standard Iu interface defined by 3GPP.

The static relocation procedure does not involve the UE and radio connections are affected

during the relocation. The static relocation is an optimal relocation mode.

Benefits Reduce the bandwidth occupied by the Iur interface

Reduce the transmission delay of user plane

Obtain the parameters of cell-level algorithms to optimize the performances

Description

When the Iur interface exists, the UE may use the radio resources of one RNC and connects to

the CN through another RNC.

After the SRNS is relocated (UE not involved), the Iur resources for the UE are released. The target RNC not only provides radio resources for the UE but also connects the UE to the CN.

Page 329: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 329 of 415

If the radio links are provided only by the target RNC, the static relocation for UEs in

CELL_DCH state can be triggered in the following four conditions:

SRNS relocation based on delay optimization

The SRNC calculates the transmission delay on the user plane. If the delay exceeds the

threshold, the SRNC initiates the SRNS relocation.

SRNS relocation based on transmission optimization

The SRNC calculates the bandwidth occupancy on the Iur interface. If the transmission

resource of Iur interface is congested, the SRNC initiates SRNS relocation to reduce the

transmission bandwidth occupation.

SRNS relocation based on separation time

The SRNC initiates SRNS relocation when the SRNC and the CRNC have been

separated for a period of time which exceeds the threshold.

SRNS relocation based on location separation

The SRNC initiates SRNS relocation when the UE moves to an area which is controlled

by the DRNC.

The UE’s only behavior during the procedure is that it is notified with new UTRAN

MOBILITY INFORMATION.

Enhancement

In RAN3.0, the SRNS relocation based on delay optimization is supported.

In RAN5.0, the SRNS relocation based on separation time and location separation are

supported.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

The CN and DRNC must support this feature simultaneously.

Dependency on CN

The CN node must support this feature simultaneously.

Dependency on Other Features

NA

Page 330: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 330 of 415

7.4.5 WRFD-02060502 SRNS Relocation with Hard Handover

Availability

This feature is available from RAN2.0.

Summary

When the Iur interface is unavailable, this feature enables the UE to move between RNCs.

Benefits

It can ensure communications are not interrupted when the UE moves to the coverage area of

another RNC while the Iur interface is not available.

Description

SRNS relocation with hard handover, which applies to UEs in CELL_DCH state, occurs in

the following conditions:

Inter-frequency or intra-frequency hard handover is performed.

The target cell and the source cell belong to different RNCs.

There is no Iur interface between the two RNCs or there are not enough resources to set

up a connection through the Iur interface.

In such scenarios, the UE is ordered to be relocated to a new RNC with hard handover to

prevent call drop.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

The CN and DRNC must support this feature simultaneously.

Dependency on CN

The CN node must support this feature simultaneously.

Dependency on Other Features

Page 331: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 331 of 415

NA

7.4.6 WRFD-02060503 SRNS Relocation with Cell/URA Update

Availability

This feature is available from RAN2.0.

Summary

When the Iur interface does not support CCH or Iur-CCH is unavailable, this feature enables

the UE in CELL_FACH, CELL_PCH, or URA_PCH state to move between RNCs.

Benefits

It ensures that communications are not interrupted when the UE in CCH state moves to the

coverage area of another RNC.

Description

If Iur interface support CCH, the cell/URA update does not trigger relocation immediately.

When Iur interface does not support CCH or Iur-CCH is unavailable, the SRNS relocation

with cell update occurs when all the following conditions are met:

The cell update procedure is performed.

The target cell and the source cell belong to different RNCs.

There is Iur interface between two RNCs, but Iur does not support CCH or Iur-CCH is

unavailable.

It is caused by cell reselection of UE in CELL_FACH, CELL_PCH or URA_PCH state. The

message Cell Update or URA Update sent by the UE is forwarded from the new RNC to the

old RNC through the Iur interface, and then the relocation procedure starts.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

The CN and DRNC must support this feature simultaneously.

Page 332: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 332 of 415

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

7.4.7 WRFD-02060504 Lossless SRNS Relocation

Availability

This feature is available from RAN3.0.

Summary

This feature enables the forwarding of SRNS contexts and DL N-PDU duplicates to the target

relocation cell during the relocation. With this feature, the higher layer on the user plane does

not need to resend the data lost during the relocation, thus improving the BE service

performance.

Benefits

This feature helps to keep the data transfer integrity and continuity, and improve the best

effort service performance in the SRNS relocation procedure.

Description

Lossless SRNS relocation is used to forward the context in SRNS and DL N-PDU duplicates

towards the relocation target RNC during the relocation procedure. That is, the RNC supports

the maintenance of PDCP sequence numbers for radio bearers which are used to forward data

not acknowledged by the UE. With this feature, the higher layer in user plane does not need to

resend the data lost during relocation procedure; therefore, the best effort service performance

is improved.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

The UE, CN and DRNC must support this feature simultaneously.

Page 333: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 333 of 415

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

7.5 Intra-system Radio Resource Management

7.5.1 WRFD-010615 Multiple RAB Package (PS RAB ≥2)

Availability

This feature is available from RAN2.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R99.

Summary

This feature is a combination of two or more PS RABs.

Benefits

Multi-RAB support capability provides operators with more choices for the service solution.

Description

Multi-RAB can provide many services simultaneously to the upper layer. When multi-RAB

has more than one PS RAB, Huawei supports the following specifications:

Combination of two PS services

One CS service + two PS services

Combination of three PS services

One CS service + three PS services

Combination of Four PS Services

In all the above combinations, the bit rates of CS and PS services are not limited. That is, any

bit rate defined in WRFD-010501 Conversational QoS Class, WRFD-010502 Streaming QoS

Class, WRFD-010503 Interactive QoS Class, and WRFD-010501 Background QoS Class can

be selected in the combination.

The PS conversational/streaming/interactive/background services can also be mapped onto

HS-DSCH or E-DCH channels, such a feature will be supported with the optional feature

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package and WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction

Package.

Enhancement

In RAN6.0, the following specifications can be supported:

Page 334: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 334 of 415

Combination of three PS services including IMS signaling

One CS service + three PS services including IMS signaling

In RAN10.0, the limitation that one of 3 PS service must be IMS signaling is removed.

In RAN11.0, the combination of four PS service is supported.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

The UE must have the corresponding multi-RAB support capability.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

The CN must have the corresponding multi-RAB support capability.

Dependency on Other Features

NA

7.5.2 WRFD-01061501 Combination of Two PS Services

Availability

This feature is available from RAN2.0.

Summary

This feature is a combination of two PS services.

Benefits

Multi-RAB support capability provides operators with more choices for the service solution.

Description

Huawei supports the combination of two PS services.

The bit rates of PS services are not limited. That is, any bit rate defined in WRFD-010501

Conversational QoS Class, WRFD-010502 Streaming QoS Class, WRFD-010503 Interactive

QoS Class, and WRFD-010501 Background QoS Class can be applied to this feature.

Page 335: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 335 of 415

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

The UE must have the corresponding multi-RAB support capability.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

The CN must have the corresponding multi-RAB support capability.

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010615 Multiple RAB Package (PS RAB ≥2)

7.5.3 WRFD-01061502 Combination of One CS Service and Two PS Services

Availability

This feature is available from RAN2.0.

Summary

This feature is a combination of one CS service and two PS services.

Benefits

This feature provides operators with more choices for the service solution.

Description

Huawei supports the combination of one CS service + two PS services.

The bit rates of CS and PS services are not limited. That is, any bit rate defined in

WRFD-010501 Conversational QoS Class, WRFD-010502 Streaming QoS Class,

WRFD-010503 Interactive QoS Class, and WRFD-010501 Background QoS Class can be

applied to this feature.

Page 336: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 336 of 415

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

The UE must have the corresponding multi-RAB support capability.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

The CN must have the corresponding multi-RAB support capability.

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010615 Multiple RAB Package (PS RAB ≥2)

7.5.4 WRFD-01061503 Combination of Three PS Services

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

This feature is a combination of three PS services.

Benefits

This feature provides operators with more choices for the service solution.

Description

Huawei supports the combination of three PS Services.

The bit rates of PS services are not limited. That is, any bit rate defined in WRFD-010501

Conversational QoS Class, WRFD-010502 Streaming QoS Class, WRFD-010503 Interactive

QoS Class, and WRFD-010501 Background QoS Class can be applied to this feature.

Enhancement

None.

Page 337: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 337 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

The UE must have the corresponding multi-RAB support capability.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

The CN must have the corresponding multi-RAB support capability.

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010615 Multiple RAB Package (PS RAB ≥2)

7.5.5 WRFD-01061504 Combination of One CS Service and Three PS Services

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

Summary

This feature is a combination of one CS service and three PS services (including IMS

signaling).

Benefits

This feature provides operators with more choices for the service solution.

Description

Huawei supports the combination of One CS Service + Three PS Services including IMS

Signaling.

The bit rates of CS + PS services are not limited. That is, any bit rate defined in

WRFD-010501 Conversational QoS Class, WRFD-010502 Streaming QoS Class,

WRFD-010503 Interactive QoS Class, and WRFD-010501 Background QoS Class can be

applied to this feature.

Enhancement

None.

Page 338: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 338 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

The UE must have the corresponding multi-RAB support capability.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

The CN must have the corresponding multi-RAB support capability.

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010615 Multiple RAB Package (PS RAB ≥2)

7.5.6 WRFD-01061505 Combination of Four PS Services

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

Summary

This feature is a combination of four PS services. The service combination can be VoIP + BE

or four PS BE services.

Benefits

This feature enhances the system's compatibility with various VoIP UEs and facilitates the

development of VoIP.

The service combination 3PS RAB VoIP + BE can be applied, which enriches the operator’s

services portfolio.

Description

RAN11.0 supports up to four PS RABs per user. A typical application of Multi-RAB is VoIP

plus BE service where VoIP may need up to three RABs to transmit SIP signaling, Real-Time

Transport Protocol (RTP) (voice), and Real-Time Control Protocol (RTCP) (media monitoring)

respectively, as shown in the following figure.

Page 339: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 339 of 415

RAN11.0 supports four PS RABs per user, and the service combination VoIP + BE is

supported. Other service combination like 4PS BE is also supported.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

The UE must have the corresponding multi-RAB support capability.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

The CN must have the corresponding multi-RAB support capability.

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010615 Multiple RAB Package (PS RAB ≥2)

7.5.7 WRFD-020103 Inter Frequency Load Balance

Availability

This feature is available from RAN2.0.

Summary

When a cell is in initial congestion state, this feature enables some UEs in the cell to be

handed over to an inter-frequency co-coverage cell, thus reducing the load of the cell.

Benefits

This feature is used to reduce the system load by handing over UE to neighbor cells, thus

keeping the system in a safe state.

Page 340: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 340 of 415

Description

This feature is an important action for Load Reshuffling (LDR). It enables the system to

perform inter-frequency handover that hands over UE to an inter-frequency neighbor cell,

thereby reducing the current cell load.

This action is triggered when system detects that the current serving cell load is beyond the

pre-defined congestion threshold and the cell is entering a basic congestion state. Normally

the resource used for cell load level measurement is the power resource, if inter frequency

load balance is taken as an action for LDR. The load measure is done both for UL and DL.

A target cell will then be selected according to the load difference between current cell load

and congestion threshold of each target cell. Only when the load difference exceeds a certain

value can the cell be selected as the target cell for blind handover. The limitation for target

cell selection is used to ensure that the handover does not cause the load increase of target

cell.

Besides, the system will select a UE to be handed over during the LDR according to the UE

priority. If the UEs have the same priority, the UE with higher service bit rate will be selected

first.

Inter-frequency load balance is also applied to hierarchical cell structure.

Enhancement

In RAN5.1, the user selection criterion considers the Traffic Class, ARP, and bear type (R99

or HSPA) when calculating the UE priority, and THP factor added in RAN6.0.

HSDPA service is considered during inter-frequency load balance procedure in RAN5.0.

HSUPA service is considered during inter-frequency load balance procedure in RAN6.0.

Blind handover is used to perform inter-frequency handover before RAN12.0. Measurement

based handover is added as one choice of actions to perform inter-frequency handover in

RAN12.0. In RAN12.0, by MML command, operator can inhibit some types of service being

selected for inter-frequency load balance.

Before RAN14.0, a load-based inter-frequency handover for LDR can be triggered only if

power resources are insufficient. In RAN14.0, this type of handover can also be triggered if

uplink channel element (CE) resources in an uplink CE resource group are insufficient. This is

to balance out uplink CE resources across CE resource groups, increasing uplink CE usage

and system capacity.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

Page 341: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 341 of 415

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

When this feature is used for HSDPA/HSUPA load control, WRFD-010610 HSDPA

Introduction Package and WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package are required as well.

7.5.8 WRFD-020114 Domain Specific Access Control (DSAC)

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

Summary

In urgent cases, for example, the CN is overloaded, this feature enables fast reduction of the

load, thus avoiding further overload.

Benefits

In urgent cases, for example, the overload of the CN, the DSAC function can quickly lower

the current load and reduce the risk of overload.

If one CN domain is overloaded or unavailable, the other CN domain is not affected. This

improves the disaster tolerance and availability of the network.

Description

In the 3GPP protocols, the PRACH resources (such as access slots and access preambles in

FDD mode) provide access services of different priorities by distinguishing different Access

Service Classes (ASCs). The value range of the ASC is 0–7. The value 0 represents the

highest priority and the value 7 represents the lowest priority. The value 0 of ASC is used for

emergency calls. The Information Element (IE) "AC-to-ASC mapping" in SIB 5 or SIB 5bis

indicates the mapping between Access Class (AC) and ASC. This mapping is usually applied

to the access phase, for example, sending an RRC CONNECTION REQUEST message;

therefore, different access services are provided by controlling the access probability of the

UEs which belong to the ASCs of different priorities.

In SIB 3/4, the IE "Domain Specific Access Restriction Parameters" is used to indicate which

access class is barred or allowed. The UE will read its access class and compare it with the

access class stored in the SIM card. After comparison, the UE knows whether it is allowed to

access the cell.

The DSAC function can be used in the following scenarios:

1. When the RNC knows through the Iu interface that the CN is overloaded, it triggers the

DSAC function as follows:

− The RNC sets the step as X% to limit the access of the UE under the RNC at a fixed

interval, namely, "Access Class Restriction interval". Within the next interval, the

RNC limits the other X% UEs and releases all the other UEs.

Page 342: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 342 of 415

− The RNC bars the access of UEs according to different domains. That is, the RNC

prevents the UEs from accessing the overloaded CS domain. If the PS domain is

overloaded, the RNC also prevents the UEs from accessing the PS domain.

− If X% = 100%, the RNC bars the access of all the UEs. The UEs camp on the

coverage area under the RNC but cannot access the corresponding domain.

− When the CN is no longer overloaded, all the barred ACs will be released.

− The operators can set X% and Access Class Restriction interval.

− The operator can decide whether to trigger the DSAC function when a domain of the

CN is overloaded.

2. When Iu Flex is used, the DSAC function can be automatically triggered only when all the

CN nodes of the corresponding domain connected to the RNC are overloaded.

3. When the DSAC function is triggered, based on logs and alarms, the operator can easily

monitor the DSAC status, network status, the process of removing restrictions on access

classes, and so on.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

Only the UEs of R6(or later) can support this function.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

CN nodes should support this message on the Iu interface.

Dependency on Other Features

NA

7.5.9 WRFD-020110 Multi Frequency Band Networking Management

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

Page 343: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 343 of 415

Summary

With this feature, the operator can simultaneously provide services on multiple frequency

bands. This feature implements the functions such as mobility management, load balancing,

and traffic balancing between frequency bands.

Benefits

In multi-frequency-band networking scenarios, this feature can provide seamless

communication to improve the system capacity.

Description

IMT-2000/UMTS service was launched in the core band (1920-1980 MHz/2110-2170 MHz)

during the year 2001, and by mid-2006 there were more than 75 million IMT-2000/UMTS

subscriptions worldwide in more than 110 IMT-2000/UMTS networks launched

commercially.

However, there are still sparsely populated and remote areas where there are difficulties to

provide IMT-2000/UMTS services in a cost-efficient way. Therefore, other frequency band

re-farming is required to provide UMTS service to meet the requirements. For example,

UMTS deployment in 900 MHz band can facilitate the provision of the expected

IMT-2000/UMTS services to users in those areas. The 900 MHz band is identified for

IMT-2000/UMTS at ITU and from a regulatory point of view it can be used for

IMT-2000/UMTS.

The most significant benefit comes from the fact that compared to 2 GHz band, radio wave

propagation path-loss in 900 MHz frequency band is much smaller. So, for the offering of the

same service (data rates) and same coverage, the required number of base station sites in 900

MHz band is reduced by 60% compared to that at 2 GHz, as shown by the following table.

Service 2 GHz band 900 MHz Band Site Number Reduction

Circuit switched, 64 kbit/s 224 90 60%

Packet switched, 384 kbit/s 468 181 61%

In addition, the use of the 900 MHz band can significantly improve indoor coverage in urban

areas. The economic benefit of the 900 MHz band on UMTS operators’ investments makes it

possible to propagate benefits to the end-users in terms of wider coverage and possibly lower

level of usage costs. Improved indoor coverage is important because more and more mobile

voice and data services are used in the indoor environment. This is of particular interest when

considering the increasing use of the mobile phones as a replacement or a complement to

fixed phone, PC and TV usage. The UMTS900 will be deployed by reusing the GSM sites

within the existing service area, and the benefits are achieved because of:

Reuse of the existing base station sites

Reuse of the existing antenna systems and feeders

From a practical implementation point of view, operators only need either to add a new base

station cabinet or to replace the existing GSM base station by a multimode GSM+UMTS base

Page 344: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 344 of 415

station subject to site situation or manufacturer’s design. It should be noted that the base

station equipment cost represents only a small portion of the total site cost.

Huawei supports the following frequency band:

Operating Band

UL Frequencies

UE transmit, Node B receive

DL frequencies

UE receive, Node B transmit

Availability

I 1920 to 1980 MHz 2110 to 2170 MHz RAN2.0

II 1850 to 1910 MHz 1930 to 1990 MHz Macro:RAN5.0

RRU: RAN5.1

III 1710 to 1785 MHz 1805 to 1880 MHz Macro:RAN5.0

RRU: RAN5.1

V 824 to 849 MHz 869 to 894 MHz RAN6.0

VIII 880 to 915 MHz 925 to 960 MHz RAN6.0

IV 1710 to1755 MHz 2110 to 2155 MHz RRU: RAN6.1

IX 1749.9 to 1784.9 MHz 1844.9 to 1879.9 MHz RRU: RAN6.0

Huawei also provides the full mobility solution between these frequency bands and the

mobility between these frequency bands and GSM cells. The main related features are as

follows:

Cell selection / reselection

Service distribution and Directed retry: Load Balance DRD is supported, which enables

the RNC to direct the UE to a preferable layer according to the load conditions of current

cell and target cell. Service priority could be set to cells, corresponding to different

service types including R99 RT, R99 NRT, HSPA and other (e.g. MBMS). This enables

service differentiation and/or load balance between multi-frequency layers. In call setup

procedures, the RNC would direct the UE to an inter-frequency cell with higher service

priority. The RNC also considers the capabilities of the cell/UE, and the requested RAB.

Service Differentiate DRD and Load Balance DRD could work independently or

cooperatively. In later case service priority will be first considered. Such a feature

depends on the optional feature WRFD-020400 DRD Introduction Package.

Coverage based handover: If coverage based inter-frequency handover is needed, the

optional feature WRFD-020302 Inter Frequency Hard Handover Based on Coverage

should be enabled. If coverage based inter-RAT handover is needed, WRFD-020303

Inter-RAT Handover Based on Coverage should be enabled.

Load based handover: Such feature enables the load based inter-RAT handover, which

depends on the optional feature WRFD-020306 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Load.

Service based handover: Such feature depends on the optional feature WRFD-020305

Inter-RAT Handover Based on Service

Hierarchical Cell Structure capability is also available which is operator configurable in

order to prioritize the different UMTS2100, UMTS900 and GSM layers. And such

feature depends on the optional feature WRFD-021200 HCS (Hierarchical Cell

Structure).

Page 345: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 345 of 415

The network operator can have full flexibility to prioritize different UMTS2100 and

UMTS900 cells.

Enhancement

In RAN12.0, the inter-band blind handover based on load is supported to share the load in

case of cell overload.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-020400 DRD Introduction Package or

WRFD-020302 Inter Frequency Hard Handover Based on Coverage or

WRFD-020303 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Coverage should be enabled or

WRFD-020306 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Load or

WRFD-020305 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Service or

WRFD-021200 HCS (Hierarchical Cell Structure)

If one of these dependent features is not enabled, the corresponding function will not be

available in the multi frequency band networking solution. Operator can choose which feature

to use or not.

7.5.10 WRFD-020160 Enhanced Multiband Management

Availability

This feature is available since RAN12.0.

Summary

In a multiband network, the cells that operate on different frequency bands have different

coverage areas. Generally, when the UE needs to perform an inter-frequency handover, it

Page 346: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 346 of 415

performs handover decision according to the inter-frequency measurement result rather than

performs a blind handover. This increases the handover success rate.

Inter-frequency measurement is performed for handover decision of the inter-frequency

handover based on traffic steering or load sharing.

Benefits

With this feature, the traffic steering or load sharing between the cells operating on different

frequency bands can be implemented, thus enhancing the resource usage while ensuring the

handover success rate.

Description

In the inter-frequency traffic steering, each cell is configured with the priority for carrying

each type of services (R99 RT, R99 NRT, HSPA, and others). After the RAB is setup,

inter-frequency measurement is performed to ensure that the UE accesses the cell with the

highest priority. To enable inter-frequency measurement for traffic steering, enable the

features WRFD-020110 Multi Frequency Band Networking Management and WRFD-020400

DRD Introduction Package.

In the inter-frequency load sharing, after the RAB setup, load reshuffling (LDR) may trigger a

load-based inter-frequency handover. The target cell is selected on the basis of the quality

measurement of cells. Only the cell that meets the quality requirement is selected. To enable

inter-frequency measurement for load sharing, enable the features WRFD-020110 Multi

Frequency Band Networking Management and WRFD-020103 Inter-Frequency Load

Balance.

Enhancement

Before RAN14.0, load-based inter-band handovers for inter-band load sharing are triggered

only by basic congestion of power resources. As of RAN14.0, load-based inter-band

handovers can also be triggered by basic congestion of uplink channel element (CE) resources.

This balances uplink CE resources between cell groups or NodeBs, increases uplink CE

utilization, expands uplink capacity, and increases the RAB setup success rate.

If CEs maintained on the RNC are congested whereas the actual occupied CEs maintained on

the NodeB are not congested, load-based inter-band handovers triggered by basic congestion

of CE resources does not increase uplink capacity.

If neighboring cells are configured for blind handovers between cell groups or NodeBs, the

RNC can perform directed retry on UEs that fail to access cells due to insufficient CE

resources. In this case, using this feature does not increase the RAB setup success rate.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

Only BSC6900 supports this feature.

Dependency on Node B

NA

Page 347: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 347 of 415

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-020110 Multi Frequency Band Networking Management and WRFD-020400

DRD Introduction Package or

WRFD-020110 Multi Frequency Band Networking Management and WRFD-020103

Inter-Frequency Load Balance

7.5.11 WRFD-020400 DRD Introduction Package

Availability

This feature is available from RAN3.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R99.

Summary

This feature supports inter-frequency or inter-system direct retry and redirect.

Benefits

These features can decrease the access failure rate and improve the QoS of the network.

Description

The DRD Introduction Package includes the following features:

Intra System Direct Retry

Inter System Direct Retry

Inter System Redirect

Traffic Steering and Load Sharing During RAB Setup

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

Page 348: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 348 of 415

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

7.5.12 WRFD-02040001 Intra System Direct Retry

Availability

This feature is available from RAN3.0.

Summary

This feature is related to intra-system direct retry during the RRC Connection setup or RAB

assignment.

Benefits

Intra system Directed Retry can decrease the access failure rate, and improve the QoS of the

network.

Description

Intra System Direct Retry is a feature used during Admission Control when a new call fails to

access to the network in the admission procedure. This feature can be executed in RRC

connection setup procedure and in RAB ASSIGNMENT procedure.

As for RRC procedure, it occurs when a UE initiates a RRC CONNECTION REQUEST and

the request is refused in the original cell. The system will then make a decision whether the

connection setup request can be set up in a inter-frequency neighbor cell. This decision is

done according to the configuration of inter-frequency blind neighbor cells. The new cell

information will be sent to UE in the RRC CONNECTION SETUP message, indicating UE to

access to the new cell.

As for RAB procedure, it occurs when a new call fails for admission during RAB

ASSIGNMENT procedure. The system will try a blind handover to inter-frequency neighbor

cell. In order to increase the blind handover success rate, the neighbor inter-frequency

neighbor cell should cover the original cell range.

Enhancement

None.

Page 349: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 349 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-020400 DRD Introduction Package

7.5.13 WRFD-02040002 Inter System Direct Retry

Availability

This feature is available from RAN3.0.

Summary

This feature is related to inter-system direct retry during the RAB assignment.

Benefits

Inter system Directed Retry can decrease the access failure rate, and improve the QoS of the

network.

Description

Inter System Direct Retry is a feature used during Admission Control when a new call fails to

access the network in the admission procedure. This feature is executed in RAB

ASSIGNMENT procedure.

If the RAB ASSIGNMENT procedure fails during admission, the RNC will respond with the

RAB ASSIGNEMNT RESPONSE message with the cause “Direct Retry”. Then, a relocation

procedure will be initiated by RNC with the cause of “Direct Retry”.

The following procedure is as the same as the normal inter-RAT handover procedure.

Enhancement

None.

Page 350: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 350 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-020400 DRD Introduction Package

7.5.14 WRFD-02040003 Inter System Redirect

Availability

This feature is available from RAN3.0.

Summary

This feature is related to inter-system redirect during the RRC assignment.

Benefits

Inter-system Redirect can decrease the access failure rate, and improve the QoS of the

network.

Description

Redirect feature is used during admission procedure when a new call is failed due to resource

unavailable. It occurs in RRC CONNECTION SETUP procedure.

When a UE initiates a RRC CONNECTION REQUEST and the request is refused in the

original cell. And RRC direct retry fails too. The system will send RRC CONNECTION

REJECT message with Redirection info indicating UE to access to an inter-system cell.

Compared with RRC Direct Retry procedure, UE will perform a new cell-reselection

procedure in inter-system Redirect.

Enhancement

None.

Page 351: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 351 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-020400 DRD Introduction Package

7.5.15 WRFD-02040004 Traffic Steering and Load Sharing During RAB Setup

Availability

This feature is available since RAN10.0.

Summary

With this feature, the load of the service and the required service type are considered during

RAB setup to implement traffic steering and load sharing between different frequencies or

different frequency bands.

Benefits

If traffic steering is enabled during RAB setup, newly admitted services are carried on the

specified frequency to reduce the impact on the old services, thus achieving smooth network

evolution.

If load sharing is enabled during RAB setup, the probability of congestion on each frequency

is reduced, the service access success rate is improved, and the number of load-based

handovers performed after service setup is reduced. Therefore, the quality of service is

improved.

Description

Services are classified into four types: R99 RT, R99 NRT, HSPA, and others (such as MBMS).

Different priorities are defined for different types of services in each cell. If traffic steering is

Page 352: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 352 of 415

enabled, the cell with the highest priority is selected according to the service type during the

RAB setup.

If load sharing is enabled, the load on the current cell and the loads on the neighboring cells

that cover the same area are considered during RAB setup to ensure that new services access

the cell with the lowest traffic load.

Traffic steering and load sharing during RAB setup can be enabled or disabled respectively. If

both of the functions are enabled, traffic steering takes precedence over load sharing. That is,

the cell with the highest priority is selected on the basis of traffic steering. If multiple cells

have the same priority, then the cell with the lowest traffic load is selected.

Traffic steering and load sharing are implemented through blind handovers. These two

functions apply to the scenarios where neighboring cells have the same coverage.

Enhancement

In RAN12 Periodically DRD based on measurement is introduced, RAB can be setup in the

original cell, and by following inter frequency measurement to chose a neighbor cell to

perform DRD, thus reduce the drop rate caused by blind handover. The Periodically DRD

based on blind handover or based on measurement can be selected by operator.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-020400 DRD Introduction Package

7.5.16 WRFD-020402 Measurement Based Direct Retry

Availability

This feature is available from RAN 12.0

Page 353: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 353 of 415

Summary

After the setup of UE RRC connection, RNC can immediately initiate inter frequency or inter

system measurement, then RNC can perform direct retry according to the measurement result

when the RAB assignment is received from CN.

Benefits

The feature can increase the success rate of DRD, reduce the drop rate caused by DRD with

blind handover, thus improves the network performance.

Description

When an RAB is set up and the DRD is triggered, the Directed Retry Decision (DRD)

algorithm uses the blind handover procedure to setup the RAB in another cell. In this situation,

if the current cell and the DRD target cell cover different areas, the UE DRD may fail.

After the Measurement based direct retry (MBDR) function is implemented, inter-frequency

or inter-RAT measurement is performed. This ensures good signal quality of the DRD target

cell. With this function, the success rate of inter-frequency or inter-RAT DRD can be ensured

even if the current cell and the DRD target cell cover different areas.

The function can be configured with the service type:

The following types of service support inter-frequency MBDR:

− CS AMR

− CS non-AMR

− PS R99

− PS HSPA

Only CS AMR services support inter-RAT MBDR.

After an RRC connection setup, the RNC determines whether to establish services in

inter-frequency or inter-RAT cells based on the current cell load and the type of services to be

established. If required, the RNC sends the UE an inter-frequency or inter-RAT measurement

control message, instructing the UE to measure the signal quality of the target cell. If the

signal quality of the target cell meets the specified requirements, the RNC establishes services

in the target cell.

If MBDR is executed, the other types of DRD will not be performed subsequently in the call.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

Page 354: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 354 of 415

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-020400 DRD Introduction Package

7.5.17 WRFD-020120 Service Steering and Load Sharing in RRC Connection Setup

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

Summary

This feature enables service and load sharing between different frequencies, bands, or systems

based on the service type and cell load.

Benefits

In the RRC connection setup phase, this feature can implement service steering and shorten

the delay of service setup. In addition, this feature can provide inter-frequency or inter-RAT

load sharing under different coverage and increase the success rate of load sharing.

Description

In the RRC connection setup phase, this feature enables the following functions: (1)

inter-frequency or inter-RAT service steering based on the setup reasons of RRC connections;

(2) inter-frequency or inter-RAT load sharing under different coverage based on the cell load

or redirect proportion.

With this feature, service steering and load sharing are available through RRC redirection in

the RRC connection setup phase. In the RAB setup phase, the direct retry is used for service

steering and load sharing. As the RRC redirection is a cell reselection procedure based on UE

measurement, this feature is more suitable for the scenarios (for example, different frequency

bands are available or no site is shared) to implement service steering and load sharing of two

TRXs.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

Page 355: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 355 of 415

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

The UE needs to be compliant with 3GPP Release 6 (or later) to support the feature.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-020400 DRD Introduction Package

7.5.18 WRFD-020124 Uplink Flow Control of User Plane

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

Summary

This feature enables the proprietary IEs on the Iub interface to detect the uplink packet loss of

R99 services. In addition, this feature enables the transmission of TF limitations to control

uplink traffic.

Benefits

This feature prevents the uplink transmission from packet loss for lack of flow control, and

increases the service transmission efficiency.

Description

This feature is applicable to R99 service. The Uplink Flow Control of User Plane feature for

HSUPA users is a standard flow control mode defined by the 3GPP protocols and has been

implemented.

In uplink single service data transmission, when the Node B transmits data on the Iub

interface, packet loss may occur due to insufficient processing capability of the buffer or

insufficient transport network capability. In this case, data is repeatedly retransmitted, which

causes the decrease of transmission and service processing efficiency.

Huawei RAN uses the spare field in the Iub FP frame, which enables the RNC to detect the

information about the packet loss in the uplink. When the packet loss threshold is reached, the

RNC decides that this service enters the congestion state in the uplink, and then reduces the

uplink data transmission rate of the UE by sending the TF Restriction message to the UE.

This is a proprietary feature of Huawei.

Page 356: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 356 of 415

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

7.5.19 WRFD-020104 Intra Frequency Load Balance

Availability

This feature is available from RAN2.0.

Summary

This feature enables the adjustment of the PCPICH power in a cell to change cell load.

Benefits

This feature is an action for reducing cell load. For those UEs in soft handover state, this

feature enables the intra-frequency neighbor cells to share the cell load by removing high load

cell from Active Set.

Description

When the PCPICH power changes, the coverage of a cell increases or decreases. In this case,

the UE at the edge of the cell, especially the UE in soft handover state, is affected.

In the case the UE is in soft handover state, the PCPICH power change can make the cell be

removed from the Active Set. By this way, the cell load can be reduced.

The system provides a switch for operator to enable or disable this feature. The power adjust

step and cell load threshold are configurable. In case the algorithm switch is ON, and cell load

is greater than pre-defined overload threshold, the system will automatically decrease the

Page 357: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 357 of 415

PCPICH power by one step. If the current cell load is less than the pre-defined underload

threshold, the system will automatically increase the PCIPCH power by one step

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

7.5.20 WRFD-140211 Dynamic Target ROT Adjustment

Availability

This feature is available from RAN14.0.

Summary

In a cell where the uplink coverage is not limited, this feature adaptively adjusts the target

Rise Over Thermal (ROT) to increase uplink cell throughput.

Benefits

With this feature, the RNC can dynamically adjust the target ROT based on cell coverage to

achieve a balance between coverage and capacity. In scenarios where the uplink coverage is

not limited, such as densely populated urban areas, the uplink throughput can be increased by

up to 20% with this feature.

Description

In the uplink cell load control algorithm, ROT is an important parameter that reflects the cell

uplink load level. A large target ROT leads to a heavy uplink cell load but a small cell coverage area. In a live network, the cell coverage performance varies greatly by radio

Page 358: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 358 of 415

environment, such as densely populated urban areas and suburbs. Setting the target ROT to a

fixed value cannot account for varied radio environments.

In a cell with good coverage, for example, in central business districts (CBDs), if the target

ROT is set to a fixed value, the uplink cell load may reach the preset maximum when the UE

transmit power is still sufficient. This leads to limited uplink cell throughput.

This feature enables the RNC to automatically adjust the target ROT to increase the uplink

cell throughput without affecting network performance. The RNC adjusts the target ROT by

changing the value of the information element (IE) Maximum Target Received Total Wide

Band contained in the PHYSICAL SHARED CHANNEL RECONFIGURATION REQUEST

message sent to the NodeB.

When the actual ROT for a cell approaches or exceeds the target cell load and the

transmit power resources for UEs in the cell are sufficient, the RNC gradually raises the

target cell load to increase cell throughput.

When the transmit power of a R99 UE in a cell is insufficient or when the transmit power

of an HSUPA UE is insufficient and its throughput is lower than the preset threshold, the

RNC rapidly decreases the target cell load to prevent KPI degradation.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

None

Dependency on NodeB

None

Dependency on UE

None

Dependency on other NEs

None

Dependency on CN

None

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package

Dependency on Service

This feature should be used with Huawei professional services.

Page 359: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 359 of 415

7.5.21 WRFD-140212 CE Overbooking

Availability

This feature is available from RAN14.0.

Summary

This feature enables the RNC to adjust the credit resource consumption based on the actual

channel element (CE) usage in Node B. improving the efficiency and admission capacity of

credit resource, admitting more users and allocating more users in 2ms TTI.

Benefits

When NodeB credit resources are insufficient during UE access and the uplink HSUPA

throughput is low, this feature provides the following benefits:

It improves CE resource utilization and therefore allows more UEs to be admitted to a

NodeB.

It enables more UEs to use the 2 ms transmission time interval (TTI), increasing the UE

throughput.

Description

To ensure user experience of high-priority users, the RNC generally reserves CE resources for

GBR services. Without this feature, when the accumulative number of reserved NodeB credit

resources exceeds the total number of NodeB credit resources, the RNC rejects new UE

access, even if the actual CE usage is low on the NodeB.

With this feature, the NodeB notifies the RNC of the minimum guaranteed CE resources

required by the cell group and by UEs admitted to the NodeB through a private interface.

Based on the minimum guaranteed CE resources:

The RNC determines CE-related bearer policies, admission control, load reshuffling

(LDR), and TTI switching.

The NodeB implements admission control on new UEs.

Using this feature has the following risks:

If multiple UEs simultaneously transmit data:

− The GBR of these UEs may not be guaranteed.

− The CE resources allocated by the NodeB to an HSUPA UE with a 2-ms TTI may not

be sufficient for the UE to transmit one Radio Link Control packet data unit (RLC

PDU). If the admission-CE-based dynamic TTI adjustment algorithm is enabled, TTI

switching will be triggered. During the TTI switching, the number of radio link

reconfigurations may increase, increasing the risk of call drops. If the

admission-CE-based dynamic TTI adjustment algorithm is disabled, Traffic Radio

Bearer (TRB) may reset, which could result in call drops.

In a network with low resource utilization, the air interface load may increase with the

number of admitted UEs, increasing the call drop rate.

Page 360: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 360 of 415

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

None

Dependency on Node B

None

Dependency on UE

None

Dependency on other NEs

None

Dependency on CN

None

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-010638 Dynamic CE Resource Management

Dependency on professional services

This feature should be used with Huawei professional services.

7.5.22 WRFD-140213 Intelligent Access Class Control

Availability

This feature is available from RAN14.0.

Summary

This feature prevents a large number of UEs from sending RRC connection setup requests

simultaneously. When the RNC determines that a cell is congested, the RNC restricts the

access of UEs of more access classes. When the RNC determines that congestion is relieved

in the cell, the RNC decreases number of access classes on which access control is performed.

Benefits

When a large number of RRC connection setup requests are rejected due to cell congestion,

this feature enables UEs to access the network at the scheduled time. This prevents excessive

RRC connection setup requests from wasting Um interface resources and RNC processing

resources, relieves network congestion, and improves system stability.

Page 361: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 361 of 415

Description

When this feature is enabled, the RNC periodically determines whether a cell is congested and

controls access classes based on the cell status. If a cell is congested, the RNC restricts the

access of UEs of more access classes. If congestion is relieved in the cell, the RNC decreases

number of access classes on which access control is performed. The access classes that are

allowed to access the network are defined in the system information. The RNC restricts the

access classes in round robin mode at the specified period so that UEs access the network at

the scheduled time. This prevents network storms caused by simultaneous access of a large

number of UEs, saves network resources, and relieves cell congestion as a result.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

None

Dependency on Node B

None

Dependency on the UE

UEs must support access class control delivered in system information.

For UEs complying with 3GPP release 5 and earlier releases, access class control cannot

be performed on CS and PS services separately. If the access class of such a UE is barred,

the UE can process neither CS nor PS services.

For UEs complying with 3GPP release 6 and later releases, access class control can be

performed on CS and PS services separately. Therefore, such a UE can process CS

services while being barred from processing PS services.

Dependency on other NEs

None

Dependency on the CN

None

Dependency on other RAN features

None

Page 362: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 362 of 415

7.6 GSM and UMTS Radio Resource Management

7.6.1 WRFD-070004 Load Based GSM and UMTS Handover Enhancement Based on Iur-g

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.1.

Summary

This feature is based on Huawei private information exchange mechanism over the Iur-g

interface. With this feature, the traffic is distributed through the RRC redirection and

load-based handover from the 3G network to the 2G network on the basis of the service

attributes and the load of the 2G networks when 3G cell enters LDR status. In this manner, the

load is shared by the GSM network when the load of UMTS network is heavy.

Benefits

Based on Huawei private information exchange mechanism over the Iur-g interface, this

feature shares the load of the UMTS network by the GSM network. As a result, the load of the

GSM network and the UMTS network in the same coverage area remains even, the risk of

network congestion due to the load imbalance between networks is reduced, and thus the

network usage is increased.

Description

With this feature, the networks in the same coverage area have nearly the same load. Thus, the

access failures during the MS access are greatly reduced, and each network has remaining

resources to provide a higher rate for the PS services. If the GSM cell and the UMTS cell

under the same MBSC with co-sited MBTSs have the same-coverage area, 3G-to-2G

handover algorithm enhancement in connection state is available based on the private

information exchange mechanism.

For the load management of the 3G cells, the inter-RAT handover based on load or HCS by

coverage is enhanced on the basis of Huawei private information exchange mechanism over

the Iur-g interface. With this feature, a more proper target cell can be selected for the

inter-RAT handover. In addition, the probability of the ping-pong handover due to the high

load of the neighboring 2G cell can be minimized if the following requirements are met:

The inter-RAT neighboring cell with the lowest load is selected.

The difference between the load in the source cell and the load in the target 2G cell

exceeds the configured threshold.

The handover does not lead to congestion in the target cell.

Enhancement

None.

Page 363: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 363 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

Interface board FG2a/FG2c/GOUa/GOUc should be configured to support Iur-g

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-020306 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Load or WRFD-021200 HCS

(Hierarchical Cell Structure)

GBFD-511101 GSM/UMTS Load Handover Enhancement based on Iur-g

7.6.2 WRFD-070005 NACC Procedure Optimization Based on Iur-g

Availability

This feature is available from RAN12.0.

Summary

This feature enables the exchange of messages containing the RAN Information Management

(RIM) information over the Iur-g interface between the RNC and BSC. The Iur-g protocol

stack complies with the 3GPP specifications. In this way, the NACC procedure for PS

services from a UMTS cell to a GSM cell does not require the information transfer via the

CN.

Benefits

This feature provides a solution that enables the NACC procedure when the CN does not

support the RIM procedure. The simulation results show that this feature helps shorten the

delay of PS handover by two seconds. As the delay is shortened, the user experience can be

improved.

Description

As indicated in the 3GPP specifications, the GERAN (P) SI is obtained through the RIM

procedure during the NACC procedure. The NACC procedure involves the RNC, UMTS SGSN, GSM SGSN, and BSC. When this feature is applied, the GSM/UMTS GERAN (P) SI

Page 364: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 364 of 415

information is transferred over the Iur-g interface between the base station controllers, without

being transferred via the CN.

This feature applies only to the Iur-g interface, which connects different base station

controllers. In such a case, the GERAN (P) SI information is transferred over the protocol

stack complying with the 3GPP specifications. If there is no Iur-g interface between UMTS

and GSM, the GERAN (P) SI information can be exchanged only via the CN, and accordingly

the NACC procedure can be implemented only through the CN, as specified in the 3GPP

specifications.

The following figure shows the network topology that supports this feature. As shown in the

figure, the Huawei RNCs and BSCs are connected through the Iur-g interface. This feature

applies to the BSC/RNC of other vendors only if it has passed the interoperability test (IOT).

Otherwise, the CN-involved NACC procedure is applied. For the BSC/RNC of other vendors,

the common cell reselection procedure is performed if the CN does not support the RIM

procedure.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

Interface board FG2a/FG2c/GOUa/GOUc should be configured to support Iur-g

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

Huawei RNC/MBSC

UMTS cell

GSM Cell

Huawei GBSC/MBSC

Iur-g

GBSC/RNC of other venders

UMTS SGSN SSGSN

GSM SGSN

NACC

NACC

GSM cell

Page 365: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 365 of 415

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

GBFD-511102 NACC Procedure Optimization Based on Iur-g between GSM and UMTS

or WRFD-020303 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Coverage

or WRFD-020305 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Service

or WRFD-020306 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Load

or WRFD-021200 Hierarchical Cell Structure (HCS)

7.6.3 WRFD-070006 GSM and UMTS Load Balancing Based on Iur-g

Availability

This feature is available from RAN12.0.

Summary

This feature implements RRC redirection and the load-based GSM/UMTS handover through

the exchange of Huawei proprietary IE over the Iur-g interface. The Iur-g protocol stack

complies with the 3GPP specifications. With this feature, the traffic is distributed on the basis

of the service handover indicator and the load of the GSM network and UMTS network

during RRC connection setup or after RAB setup. In this way, a load balance is achieved

between the GSM network and UMTS network.

Benefits

This feature aims at striking a load balance between the GSM network and UMTS network. It

reduces the possibility of congestion in areas covered by both GSM and UMTS. The network

utilization is consequently increased. The simulation results show that this feature reduces the

percentage of invalid handovers between the GSM network and UMTS network by up to 6 %

and decreases the access congestion rate during busy hours by up to 4%.

Description

As high-speed PS services are on great demand by a large number of GSM/UMTS dual-mode

handsets in well-established 2G/3G commercial networks, the load of UMTS network has

become increasingly heavy. Facing the situation, network operators focus on reducing the

congestion rate and making full utilization of the present network capacity. This feature can

efficiently address this issue. With this feature, the load balance between the GSM network

and UMTS network can be achieved. This helps reduce the possibility of network congestion

Page 366: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 366 of 415

and the percentage of invalid inter-RAT handovers. As a result, the capacity of both the GSM

network and UMTS network can be fully utilized.

The following figure shows the applicable scenario where the GSM cell and UMTS cell have

the same coverage. Through the exchange of load information of the GSM network and

UMTS network over the Iur-g interface, redirection for load-balancing can be performed

during RRC connection setup, and load-based handover can be performed after RAB setup.

Redirection for load-balancing during RRC connection setup

Redirection for load-balancing during RRC connection setup is performed on a number of

UEs requesting CS services in a UMTS cell when the same-coverage GSM cell is lightly

loaded. In such a case, the RNC redirects a number of UEs to the GSM cell according to the

predefined distribution rate. The rate is considered as a probability rate with respect to the

redirection of a single UE. In this way, a load balance between the UMTS network and GSM

network can be

maintained.

Load-based handover after RAB setup

Load-based handover from UMTS to GSM after RAB setup is performed on the basis of the

service handover indicator, PS service rate, and load difference between the UMTS network

and GSM network.

If the UE requests only the CS service in a UMTS cell, the RNC decides whether the UMTS

network or GSM network processes the request. The conditions on which the decision is

based are as follows:

The UE supports GSM services.

The service handover indicator assigned by the CN or configured at the RNC shows that

the CS service can be handed over to the GSM cell.

The target GSM cell is lightly loaded.

The load difference between the source UMTS cell and target GSM cell exceeds the

predefined threshold.

UMTS

GSM

UEs access the UMTS network

x% of CS calls redirected to GSM network

(1-x)% of CS calls and PS services

Page 367: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 367 of 415

The GBSC/MBSC determines whether to perform the inter-RAT handover on a number of

UEs according to the predefined distribution rate. The rate is considered as a probability rate

with respect to the redirection of a single UE. In this way, the load between the GSM network

and UMTS network is balanced.

Network operators can decide which load-balancing scheme to be applied according to the

actual situations. The major differences between the two schemes are as follows:

As it is difficult to learn the traffic class requested by the UE, the traffic class mapping

needs to be verified before performing redirection for load-balancing. For example,

whether the GSM network supports the conversational service from the UMTS network

should be verified. If the traffic class is not supported, the RNC can decide whether the

UE can be handed over to the GSM network only after RAB setup is complete.

The redirection function does not require the UE to enable the compressed mode but it

may prolong the delay of service access and also affect user experience. For the

handover performed after RAB setup, the RNC can select a candidate GSM cell as the

target cell, which improves the efficiency of load balancing. In addition, the handover

success rate is higher than the redirection success rate. In contrast to the redirection

process, the inter-RAT handover process requires the UE to enable the compressed mode.

Therefore, the handover is a relatively long process, during which the UMTS network

still provides system resources for the UEs steered to the GSM network.

To guarantee its success rate, the redirection process requires that the source UMTS cell

and the target GSM cell should have the same coverage. Differently, the handover

process only requires that the GSM cell and the UMTS cell should be neighboring cells.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

Interface board FG2a/FG2c/GOUa/GOUc should be configured to support Iur-g

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-020400 DRD Introduction Package

WRFD-020305 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Service

GBFD-511103 GSM and UMTS Load Balancing Based on Iur-g

Page 368: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 368 of 415

7.6.4 WRFD-070007 GSM and UMTS Traffic Steering Based on Iur-g

Availability

This feature is available from RAN12.0.

Summary

This feature supports RRC redirection and GSM/UMTS inter-RAT handover based on service.

With this feature, services are steered on the basis of the service handover indicator,

hierarchical network planning, and the load of the GSM network and UMTS network when an

MS accesses the network. Service steering enables UEs requesting speech or low-speed PS

services to access the GSM network and those requesting high-speed PS services to access the

UMTS network.

Benefits

This feature helps operators to develop network services in hierarchies, which facilitates the

hierarchical network planning. With this feature, the spectrum utilization is increased. The

simulation results show that this feature reduces the percentage of invalid inter-RAT

handovers by up to 8% and increases the total capacity of the GSM and UMTS networks by

up to 8%.

Description

In the case of evolution from a legacy GSM network to a GSM&UMTS network, the UMTS

network usually has a larger capacity in the early stage. How to fully utilize the UMTS

network to carry high-speed services has become a major concern for network operators. This

feature provides the service steering function for the benefit of network planning. Service

steering helps improve the utilization of resources in each network and divide frequencies and

RATs into different hierarchies.

When a GSM cell and a UMTS cell have the same coverage, considering resource utilization

and QoS requirements, speech services are steered to the GSM cell whereas data services are

steered to the UMTS cell.

In addition to service steering, the selection of RAT for a UE to access also depends on the

network load.

This helps optimize the network performance in the following aspects:

Tasks of different RATs can be clearly defined, which facilitates the planning of network

capacity.

Service steering can reduce interference between different traffic classes, thus increasing

the capacity of the UMTS network.

The flexible distribution of services to the UMTS and GSM cells can improve the

utilization of system resources, reduce the access congestion rate, and enhance the QoS

of the network.

Page 369: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 369 of 415

This feature provides two load-balancing schemes. One is to redirect CS services to the GSM

cell during RRC connection setup, and the other is to perform load-based handovers between

the GSM and UMTS cells after RAB setup.

During the redirection process, if the UE initiating the RRC connection request in the UMTS

cell uses the protocol of R6 or later, the UE carries information about the access domain and

call type when the GSM cell under the same coverage is lightly loaded. If the access domain

is the CS domain and the call type is the speech service, the service is redirected to the GSM

cell. In this way, the UE initiating the request for speech services in the UMTS cell is steered

to the GSM cell. Therefore, more capacity of the UMTS system is reserved for the UEs

requesting high-speed PS services.

The load-based handover between the UMTS and GSM cells after RAB setup is an enhanced

function of the existing handover feature provided by Huawei. This function is determined by

the service handover indicator, PS service rate, and load of the UMTS/GSM system after

RAB setup.

If the UE requests only the CS service in a UMTS cell, the RNC hands the UE over to a

neighboring GSM cell when the following conditions are met:

The UE supports GSM services.

The neighboring GSM cell is lightly loaded.

Network operators can decide which load-balancing scheme to be applied according to the

actual situations. The major differences between the two schemes are as follows:

As it is difficult to learn the traffic class requested by the UE, the traffic class mapping

needs to be verified before performing redirection for load-balancing. For example,

whether the GSM network supports the conversational service from the UMTS network

should be verified. If the traffic class is not supported, the RNC can decide whether the

UE can be handed over to the GSM network only after RAB setup is complete.

The redirection function does not require the UE to enable the compressed mode but it

may prolong the delay of service access and also affect user experience. For the

handover performed after RAB setup, the RNC can select a candidate GSM cell as the

target cell, which improves the efficiency of service steering. In addition, the handover

success rate is higher than the redirection success rate. In contrast to the redirection

process, the inter-RAT handover process requires the UE to enable the compressed mode.

Therefore, the handover is a relatively long process, during which the UMTS network

still provides system resources for the UEs steered to the GSM network.

To guarantee its success rate, the redirection process requires that the source UMTS cell

and the target GSM cell should have the same coverage. Differently, the handover

process only requires that the GSM cell and the UMTS cell should be neighboring cells.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

Interface board FG2a/FG2c/GOUa/GOUc should be configured to support Iur-g

Dependency on Node B

Page 370: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 370 of 415

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-020305 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Service

WRFD-020400 DRD Introduction Package

GBFD-511104 GSM and UMTS Traffic Steering Based on Iur-g

7.6.5 WRFD-020303 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Coverage

Availability

This feature is available from RAN2.0.

Summary

This feature is related to inter-RAT handover based on coverage such as Active Set Quality

measurement 2D, UE uplink Qos or emergency blind handover triggered by event 1F. This

feature deals with the inter-RAT handover caused by coverage reason or UE mobility.

Benefits

Inter-RAT handover improves flexibility in planning UMTS and GSM networks for the

network operator. It can also save cost by utilizing the existing GSM network resources and

provide coverage expansion, load sharing, and layered service.

Description

Inter-RAT handover from UMTS to GSM/GPRS Function is the procedure during which the

WCDMA RAN initiates handover (for CS services) or UE initiates cell reselection (for PS

services) to the GSM.

The GSM/GPRS system cannot perform CS and PS services simultaneously. Therefore, when

the handover for CS and PS domain combined services is determined, the CS service can be

handed over from the WCDMA system to the GSM/GPRS system successfully, but the PS

service will be suspended. After the CS call is finished, a resume request will be sent to the

2G SGSN to continue the PS service.

Inter-RAT handover from UMTS to GSM can be triggered by coverage reason, cell load,

service of UE and HCS. The trigger condition based on the cell load belongs to the optional

feature WRFD-020306 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Load. The trigger condition based on

the service assigned by CN node belongs to the optional feature WRFD-020305 Inter-RAT

Page 371: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 371 of 415

Handover Based on Service. This feature deals with inter-RAT handover triggered by

coverage reason.

This trigger condition is based on the quality measurement. The compressed mode for DL or

UL will be triggered by event measurement report 2d for inter-frequency and inter-RAT

handover and stopped by event measurement report 2f. When the compressed mode triggered,

the RNC will start the inter-RAT measurement in UE to get the target cell to handover if

inter-RAT neighboring cells are configured.

The related measurement quantity can be either Ec/N0 or RSCP. Moreover, event 3A and

period measurement report mode are supported and which measurement quantity and mode to

use can be configured by operator. The measurement related parameters include threshold,

hysteresis, and trigger delay time, etc. The inter-RAT neighboring cell number can be up to

32.

The compressed mode includes two types, spreading factor reduction (SF/2) and high layer

approaches. The usage of type of compressed mode is decided by the RNC automatically,

according to the configurable spreading factor used in uplink and downlink.

Another measurement report 1F can also trigger inter-RAT handover, but compressed mode

will not be triggered in this scenario since such report means call drop may occur in any time

and there is no time to implement measurement procedure. The target cell to handover will be

selected based on the configurable parameter “Blind Handover Priority” in the neighboring

inter RAT cells, Priority 0-15 indicates the handover successful rate can be guaranteed, such

parameter will be certain as the result of network planning.

Inter-RAT handover triggered by UE Tx power is available for PS BE, CS AMR services.

This function can be switched on/off by operator.

The procedure of Inter-RAT handover from UMTS to GSM is executed by Relocation

Preparation procedure at Iu interface and handover or cell change order command at Uu

interface.

When the UE is in CELL_FACH, CELL_PCH, or URA_PCH state, UMTS GSM handover

in PS domain is triggered through Inter-RAT Cell Re-selection from UMTS to GPRS

procedure. This procedure is triggered by UE and realized by Routing Area Update procedure.

The parameters for inter-RAT handover can be configured and are different for CS and PS

services respectively.

Since the GSM/GPRS system can’t perform CS and PS services simultaneously, Inter-RAT

handover from GSM/GPRS to UMTS Function can be divided to CS and PS individually.

On the UMTS side:

For CS: inter-RAT handover from GSM/GPRS to UMTS is comprised of Relocation Resource

Allocation, Relocation detect, Relocation complete procedure at Iu interface and

HANDOVER TO UTRAN COMPLETE message processing at Uu interface.

For PS: inter-RAT handover from GSM/GPRS to UMTS is the same as the setup of a PS

service.

Enhancement

In RAN10.0, inter-RAT handover triggered by UE Tx power or high UL BLER is available

for PS BE and CS AMR services.

Page 372: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 372 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

UE should support the relevant measurements and the procedure of handover.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

7.6.6 WRFD-020309 Inter-RAT Handover Based on DL QoS

Availability

This feature is introduced in RAN10.0

Summary

When the load of voice and PS BE services is higher in the cell and downlink QoS drops, this

feature enables the UE to be handed over to an inter-RAT cell, thus guaranteeing QoS

requirements.

Benefits

DL QoS based inter-RAT handover provides the method to prevent call drop and guarantee

the QoS in inter-RAT networking, therefore, improving the network performance and

enhancing the end user experience.

Description

In the scenarios of severe fading and high load, the call drop could take place due to the

limitation of DL transmitted code power. In addition, coverage area is different for different

services in network planning, thereby the system should take actions in order to guarantee the

downlink QoS and keep the connection as could as possible. The evaluation of downlink QoS

status is on the basis of TCP (Transmitted Code Power) or RLC retransmission (only for PS

BE).

Once the downlink QoS is detected in bad condition, inter-RAT handover could be triggered if

in inter-system networking:

For AMR service, inter-RAT handover could be triggered based on TCP;

Page 373: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 373 of 415

For PS BE service, inter-RAT handover could be triggered based on TCP and RLC

retransmission.

This feature can be switched on/off separately for AMR and PS BE services.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

UE should support the relevant measurements and the procedure of handover.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-020303 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Coverage

7.6.7 WRFD-020307 Video Telephony Fallback to Speech (AMR) for Inter-RAT HO

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R6.

Summary

Before VP services are handed over to the 2G system, this feature enables the fallback of

video telephony to speech to ensure continuous calls.

Benefits

This feature provides an inter-RAT handover mechanism for the VP service which falls back

to speech instead of call drop.

Page 374: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 374 of 415

Description

Video telephony is a service exclusive for 3G system. But due to the limitation of UE and

network support capability, it is possible that the service cannot be implemented. Therefore,

Service Change and UDI Fallback (SCUDIF) is introduced in Release 6. This feature provides

the mechanism to fall back to Speech instead of call drop in these scenarios.

In 3GPP protocol TS23.172, there are two defined fall back methods:

Fallback: multi-media service fall back to speech during the setup procedure

Service Change: multi-media service fall back to speech during the RAB modification

procedure

They all belong to the bound of multi-media fall back procedure.

Fallback

This procedure can be triggered by UE or network side and implemented by the NAS

signaling. Therefore, to RAN, it is corresponding to the RAB Assignment procedure over

the Iu interface.

Service Change

This procedure can also be triggered by UE or network. When it is triggered by UE, the

CN will initiate an RAB Assignment (Modify) procedure over the Iu interface when

receiving the fallback request from the UE. When it is triggered by UTRAN, the scenario

generally aims to the 3G to 2G handover during which the VP service cannot be

supported. The following flow chart describes the procedure:

UE A MSC A

MODIFY (BCspeech)

MSC B UE B

MODIFY (BCspeech)

MODIFY COMPLETE (BCspeech)

Core Network Procedure

MODIFY COMPLETE (BCspeech)

RNC A

RANAP RAB Assignment

(configuration1, configuration 2)

RANAP Modify Request

(alternate configuration requested)

RAB Assignment Modify (Configuration 2, Configuration1)

Firstly, the MSC must assign the alternative configuration when setting up a VP service to let

UTRAN know it has the fallback capability.

When the user with VP service needs to be handed over to the 2G network, the RNC will

initiate an RAB modify request to trigger fallback. Then, fallback will be implemented by the

MODIFY procedure. From UTRAN view, it is corresponding to the RAB Assignment

(Modify) procedure over the Iu interface.

After the VP service falls back to speech successfully, the following speech inter-RAT handover can be implemented.

Page 375: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 375 of 415

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

The UE needs to be compliant with 3GPP Release 6 to support the feature.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

The MSC needs to be compliant with 3GPP Release 6 to support the feature.

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-020303 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Coverage

or WRFD-020305 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Service

or WRFD-020306 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Load

or WRFD-021200 HCS (Hierarchical Cell Structure)

7.6.8 WRFD-020308 Inter-RAT Handover Phase 2

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.1.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R6.

Summary

This feature provides the inter-RAT relocation procedure for NACC and PS services to

shorten the interruption time of PS services caused by inter-RAT handover.

Benefits

The service interruption for PS service inter-system handover will be shorter or reduced. With

this feature, in scenario of inter-RAT handover, the user experience will be enhanced greatly

especially for the real-time PS service.

Page 376: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 376 of 415

Description

The inter-RAT Handover Enhanced Package includes following features:

NACC (Network Assisted Cell Change)

PS Handover Between UMTS and GPRS

With these features, the service interruption for PS service inter-system handover will be

shorter or reduced.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

UE should also support NACC and PS handover.

Dependency on Other Network Units

BSC should support NACC RIM (RAN Information Management) and PS handover

procedure.

Dependency on CN

SGSN should also support NACC and PS handover.

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-020303 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Coverage

or WRFD-020305 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Service

or WRFD-020306 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Load

or WRFD-021200 HCS (Hierarchical Cell Structure)

7.6.9 WRFD-02030801 NACC(Network Assisted Cell Change)

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.1 (BSC6900 only).

Summary

This feature supports the standard NACC procedure defined in 3GPP specifications.

Page 377: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 377 of 415

Benefits

Compared with the normal cell change, the NACC can shorten a service interruption of about

four to eight seconds and greatly enhance user experience.

Description

The NACC refers to Network Assisted Cell Change from UTRAN to GERAN, which is

different from normal cell change order procedure, due to network providing GERAN (P) SI

to UE.

In today's GPRS networks (without NACC), cell re-selection may cause a service interruption

between 4 – 8 seconds, which obviously has an impact on the user experience. Similar

interruption time can be expected in mixed UMTS and GPRS networks, during UE cell

re-selection from UTRAN to GERAN.

GERAN (P)SI information is acquired by RIM (RAN Information Management) procedure.

In this feature, when handover from UTRAN to GERAN is to be performed, and if both UE

and network support NACC, then RNC will firstly trigger the RIM procedure. If (P)SI is

obtained successfully, cell change order from UTRAN message carrying the GERAN (P)SI

information will be sent. That is, NACC is completed, which is illustrated in the following

figure. Otherwise, normal cell change order would be performed.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

BSC SRNC

UE

SGSN

RRC MEASUREMENT REPORT

WITH GERAN BEST CELL DIRECT INFORMATION

TRANSFER (RAN IFORMATION

REQUEST)

RAN INFORMATION DIRECT INFORMATION

TRANSFER (RAN

INFORMATION REPORT)

RAN INFORMATION

CELL CHANGE ORDER FROM

UTRAN ( (P)SI )

Page 378: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 378 of 415

Dependency on UE

UE should also support NACC handover.

Dependency on Other Network Units

BSC should support NACC RIM (RAN Information Management).

Dependency on CN

SGSN should also support NACC handover.

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-020308 Inter-RAT Handover Phase 2

7.6.10 WRFD-02030802 PS Handover Between UMTS and GPRS

Availability

This feature is available from RAN6.1.

Summary

This feature enables the relocation of PS services between systems.

Benefits

In inter-system handover scenarios, this feature can greatly improve user perception,

especially for real-time PS services.

Description

The PS handover is different from NACC or normal cell change function, with which the

relocation procedure between 3G and 2G is applied, just like the CS inter-system handover.

With this feature, the service interruption for PS service inter-system handover is reduced by a

great extent.

In this feature, both handover from UTRAN to GERAN and handover from GERAN to

UTRAN are supplied. If both UE and network support PS handover, handover between

UTRAN and GERAN would be performed. Otherwise, either NACC or normal cell change

order would be selected.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Page 379: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 379 of 415

Dependency on UE

UE should also support PS handover.

Dependency on Other Network Units

BSC should support PS handover procedure.

Dependency on CN

SGSN should also support PS handover.

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-020308 Inter-RAT Handover Phase 2

7.6.11 WRFD-020305 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Service

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R99.

Summary

This feature supports 3G to 2G handover based on service attributes. When 3G and 2G

coexist, this feature enables the 3G traffic to be directed to the 2G system.

Benefits

This feature provides an inter-RAT handover mechanism according to the service. It can

balance the load between the two systems by transferring some kind of appropriate services to

GSM/GPRS and prevent the handover course from bad effect to services according to

attributes of the services.

Description

Inter-RAT Handover based on Service introduces a precondition for UMTS to GSM/GPRS

handover to UTRAN.

The RAB ASSIGNMENT REQUEST message sent from the CN to the RNC may include a

service handover IE. With this IE, the UTRAN determines whether to switch the

corresponding RAB from UTRAN to GSM/GPRS. The operation (the CN sends the RAB

ASSIGNMENT REQUEST message to the RNC) can also influence decisions made

regarding UTRAN-initiated inter-system handovers.

If this indicator is not included in the RAB ASSIGNMENT REQUEST message, the RNC can

use its pre-configured value for various kinds of services.

Enhancement

None.

Page 380: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 380 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

7.6.12 WRFD-020306 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Load

Availability

This feature is available from RAN3.0.

Summary

When a cell is in initial congestion state, this feature enables some UEs in the cell to be

handed over to an inter-RAT co-coverage cell, thus reducing the load of the cell.

Benefits

This feature reduces the load of the cell in basic congestion and keeps the system in a safety

state.

Description

This feature is an important action for Load Reshuffling (LDR). It enables the system to

perform inter-RAT handover that handover UE to GSM/GPRS cell and reduce current cell

load.

This action is triggered when system detects that the current serving cell load is beyond the

pre-defined congestion threshold and cell is entering into a basic congestion state. Normally

the resource used for cell load level measurement includes the power resource, that used for

NodeB load level includes Iub transport resource and NodeB CE resource if Inter-RAT

handover is taken as an action for LDR. The load measurement is done both for UL and DL.

The system will select a UE to handover during the LDR according to the UE priority. If the

UEs have the same priority, the UE with higher service bit rate will be selected firstly.

Page 381: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 381 of 415

Enhancement

In RAN5.1, the user selection criterion considers the Traffic Class, ARP, and bear type (R99

or HSPA) when calculating the UE priority, and THP factor added in RAN6.0.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

When this feature is used for HSDPA/HSUPA load control, WRFD-010610 HSDPA

Introduction Package and WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package are required.

7.6.13 WRFD-020401 Inter-RAT Redirection Based on Distance

Availability

This feature is available from RAN 12.0

Summary

If UE initialize a voice call with a long distance to the antenna, UMTS RAN can consider it as

a call attempt in the pilot contaminated area, and redirect it to GSM to avoid handover drop in

the following call procedure.

Benefits

The feature can reduce the drop rate in handover in a 2G/3G co-coverage area, solve the pilot

contamination problem and improve the network performance.

Description

Pilot contamination is a phenomenon that can cause call drop in handover.

For example, in the picture, A’ is the pilot contaminated area of Cell A. If UE setup a call in

area A’, when it moves to the cells in blue which are not the neighboring cells of cell A, the

call will drop because cell A has no handover relation with these cells.

Page 382: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 382 of 415

To solve this problem, for the voice call initiated in the contaminated area which is

co-covered by 2G and 3G, RAN will directly redirect it to GSM.

Operator can configure a distance threshold for each cell by LMT, the UE distance is

measured by RAN when RRC CONNECT REQUEST message is received, if the distance to

the antenna is beyond this threshold, the UE location will be seemed as in the contaminated

area, the system then redirect the call to GSM. In this way, the handover drop in the call

procedure will be reduced.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-020400 DRD Introduction Package

7.6.14 WRFD-020310 3G/2G Common Load Management

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

Page 383: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 383 of 415

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R5.

Summary

During inter-RAT handover or inter-system direct retry, this feature supports the transfer of

load information as stipulated in 3GPP specifications to reduce inter-RAT ping-pong

handover.

Benefits Decrease the probability of 2G system overload or congestion due to inter-RAT handover

from 3G to 2G based on service or load.

Avoid 3G system overload due to inter-RAT handover from 2G to 3G.

Avoid ping-pong handover between 3G and 2G.

Description

The 3G/2G Common Load Management applies to inter-RAT handover and inter system

direct retry. The load of source cell and target cell are considered during inter-RAT handover

from 3G to 2G or from 2G to 3G and inter system direct retry.

During inter-RAT handover from 3G to 2G, the RNC will send the load information of the

source cell to 2G through RELOCATION REQUIRED message and may get the load

information of target cell from RELOCATION COMMAND message. If the load of target

cell is in a high level (over the threshold configured) and the inter-RAT handover from 3G to

2G is triggered not because of coverage, then the inter-RAT handover from 3G to 2G will be

cancelled.

During inter-RAT handover from 2G to 3G, the RNC may get the load information of the

source cell from RELOCATION REQUEST message. If the load of source cell is not in a

high level (less than the threshold configured) and the inter-RAT handover from 2G to 3G is

triggered not because of coverage, then the inter-RAT handover from 2G to 3G will be

refused.

During inter system direct retry, the procedure and decision is similar to that of inter-RAT

handover from 3G to 2G. If the load of target cell is in a high level (over the threshold

configured), inter system direct retry will be cancelled.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Page 384: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 384 of 415

Dependency on Other Network Units

BSS should support this feature.

Dependency on CN

CN should support this feature.

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-020305 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Service

or WRFD-020306 Inter-RAT Handover Based on Load

or WRFD-021200 HCS (Hierarchical Cell Structure)

or WRFD-020400 DRD Introduction Package

or WRFD-020308 Inter-RAT Handover Phase 2

7.7 UMTS and LTE Radio Resource Management

7.7.1 WRFD-020126 Mobility Between UMTS and LTE Phase1

Availability

This feature is available from RAN12.0.

Summary

This feature covers the following functions:

UE cell selects/reselects between LTE and UMTS network.

UE with PS service handovers from the LTE network to the UMTS network are

supported.

Benefits

This feature improves the high-speed service experience of LTE UEs in the area

simultaneously covered by the UMTS network and the LTE network. In addition, in the area

not covered by the LTE network or when the LTE network is heavily loaded, some UEs with

PS service are handed over from the LTE network to the UMTS network.

Description

This feature provides a basic mobility solution for the operators who want to evolve from

UMTS to LTE.

UE cell selects/reselects between UMTS and LTE network.

The RNC supports broadcasting the information about LTE frequencies in a cell and the

parameters related to cell select/reselect. Thus, the UEs in idle state can camp on an LTE cell

preferentially. In this way, on one hand, the UEs can obtain better experience of high-speed services in the area covered by the LTE network; on the other hand, the potential cell load and

Page 385: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 385 of 415

network load of the UMTS network are reduced because these UEs gain access to the LTE

network.

UE with PS service handovers from the LTE network to the UMTS network are

supported.

At the early construction stage of the LTE network, operators may plan the LTE network

coverage only in hot spot areas. When some UEs leave the hot spot area or the LTE system

load is heavy, these UEs need to be handed over from the LTE network to the UMTS network.

With this feature, the RNC can processes the migration requests from the LTE system. This

feature does not support the UE handover from the UMTS network to the LTE network.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

LTE Cell

UMTS Cell UMTS Cell

MTS Cell

Handover

LTE Cell

UMTS Cell

LTE Cell

UMTS Cell

Normal UE:

LTE UE

Cell reselection

Page 386: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 386 of 415

NA

Dependency on UE

UE has the capability of both UMTS and LTE.

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

LTE should also support this feature

Dependency on Other Features

NA

7.7.2 WRFD-020129 Service-Based PS Service Redirection from UMTS to LTE (Trial)

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0.

Summary

If a UMTS/LTE dual-mode UE establishes services in the UMTS network, this feature allows

the RNC to redirect the UE to the LTE network when both UMTS and LTE coverage is

available and the UE establishes only PS services.

Benefits

In a UMTS/LTE multi-layer network where PS handover from UMTS to LTE is not supported

by UE or network, this feature redirects the UEs that process only PS services from the

UMTS network to the LTE network, improving user experience for PS service users.

Description

In a UMTS/LTE multi-layer network, if UE or network doesnot support the handover from

UMTS to LTE, then the UE will be redirected from UMTS to LTE, the following conditions

must be met:

1. The conditions for PS handover from UMTS to LTE are met and the UE or the network

cannot support the handover from UMTS to LTE.

2. The UE supports both UMTS and LTE.

3. The UE is processing only the PS services. The RAB assignment message from the SGSN

does not indicate that the PS services cannot be handed over to the LTE network.

The RNC carries the LTE frequency information in the RRC Connection Release message and

directs the UE to access the LTE network.

Page 387: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 387 of 415

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

None

Dependency on NodeB hardware

None

Dependency on other RAN features

None

Dependency on CN

CN should support cooperation from UMTS to LTE.

Dependency on other NEs

The UE must support 3GPP Release 8 (Sept. 2008) or later. It also must support both UMTS

and LTE.

7.7.3 WRFD-140218 Service-Based PS Handover from UMTS to LTE

Availability

This feature is available from RAN14.0.

Summary

If a UMTS and LTE dual-mode UE in a UMTS and LTE overlapping coverage area processes

only PS services in the UMTS network, Service-Based PS Handover from UMTS to LTE

allows the RNC to hand over the PS services to the LTE network.

Benefits

The benefits of this feature are as follows:

Improved user experience for PS services

Reduced service interruption time compared with redirection

Reduced the traffic load of UMTS and increased LTE network utilization

Description

This feature allows the RNC to hand over a UE and its PS service to the LTE network in

either of the following scenarios:

Page 388: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 388 of 415

The UE in the UMTS and LTE overlapping coverage area originates a PS service in the

UMTS network.

For a UE in the UMTS and LTE overlapping coverage area that is handed over from the

LTE network to the UMTS network due to a CS fallback (CSFB), after the UE

terminates the CS service in the UMTS network, the UE still has ongoing PS services.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

None

Dependency on NodeB

None

Dependency on UE

The UE must support UMTS-to-LTE PS handovers and LTE measurement.

Dependency on CN

The SGSN must support UMTS-to-LTE PS handovers.

Dependency on other NEs

The eNodeB and MME must support UMTS-to-LTE PS handovers.

Dependency on other RAN features

None

7.8 QoS

7.8.1 WRFD-010505 Queuing and Pre-Emption

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R99.

Summary

This feature enables service differentiation when the network is congested to provide better

services for high-priority users.

Page 389: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 389 of 415

Benefits

This feature provides operators with a method to differentiate users according to their priority.

High priority users can obtain the system resources with high priority in case of resource

limitation. In this way, operators can provide better service to those high priority users.

Description

Queuing and Pre-emption are two functions related to access control and are methods for

differentiating services. It enables operators to provide different services by setting different

priorities, which will affect the user call setup success rate during the call setup procedure. If

there are not enough resources and a new call is not admitted to access to the network, high

priority user will have more chances to access to the network than low priority users by

queuing or pre-empting other low priority users.

The priority information is obtained from the RAB parameters including TC (Traffic Class),

ARP (Allocation / Retention Priority), and THP (Traffic Handling Priority for interactive

service), in the message of RAB ASSIGNMENT REQUEST. The RNC will assign the user

priority according to TC, ARP, as well as THP.

Pre-emption will take action if admitting a call fails due to lack of resource. The service with

the attribution of Pre-emption Capability and Pre-emption Vulnerability indicates the service

ability of pre-empt and pre-emption vulnerability. The pre-emption capability indicates the

pre-emption capability of the request on other RAB, and pre-emption vulnerability indicates

the vulnerability of the RAB to preemption of other RAB.

If a new call pre-emption doesn’t take effect due to some reasons such as no service can be

pre-empted or current call has no ability of pre-empting other calls, the call will perform

queuing function if queuing ability is allowed.

To support the call queuing function, there’s an establishment queue (actually a buffer) per

cell for RNC to keep the RABs when a call queuing is triggered. A configurable timer is used

to indicate how long the associated RAB can be queued and the maximum waiting length is

configured according to the Priority Levels. Resource re-allocation for the RABs in the queue

is done periodically.

If a queued RAB failed due to expiry of the maximum waiting length, it will be removed from

the queue, and the RNC will report in a subsequent RAB ASSIGNMENT RESPONSE

message indicating that the RAB failed to setup or modify with IE Cause "queuing Expiry".

Queuing and pre-emption can be applied into following procedures:

New RAB request

Existing RAB modification request

Partial RAB assignment failure request

SRNS relocation request

The users can also be divided to Golden/Silver/Copper level which is mapped from ARP, and

the mapping relation is configurable. And the Gold user is not allowed to be pre-empted.

Enhancement

In RAN5.0, only ARP is considered for candidate calls to be pre-empted. The functionalities

of preemption and queuing are applied for R99 and HSDPA, but DCH service can only

Page 390: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 390 of 415

pre-empt other DCH services with low priority and HSDPA can only pre-empt other HSDPA

services with low priority.

In RAN5.1, the priority is enhanced by introducing RAB integrate priority (TC top-priority or

ARP top-priority), user integrate priority and user priority (Gold, Silver and Copper)

considering Traffic Class (TC) and Carrier Type as parameters when selecting candidate call

to be pre-empted.

In RAN6.0, THP is considered for interactive service if TC and ARP have the same priority.

In addition, the functionalities of preemption and queuing are also applied for HSUPA, but

HSUPA can only pre-empt other HSUPA services with low priority.

In RAN10.0, there is an enhancement which ARP should be considered in the case of

different TC. This improvement is only applied for Streaming and I/B traffic class. That is, the

ARP of user to be pre-empted should be lower than or equal to that of a new request user in

the case of different traffic classes. For example, streaming service can preempt I/B with

equal or lower ARP.

In RAN10.0, pre-emption can take place between HSDPA and DCH services due to limitation

of power and Iub transmission resources. ARP, TC and THP are also used for pre-emption.

For example, Gold R99 user will be able to preempt a silver HSPA user, and a Gold HSPA

user will be able to preempt Silver R99 user.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

This feature need the CN bring the ARP IE to RNC during RAB assignment procedure so that

RNC can get the service priority with those RAB parameters.

Dependency on Other Features

This feature requires optional feature WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package and

WRFD-010612 HSUPA Introduction Package when HSDPA / HSUPA queuing and

Pre-emption are required.

7.8.2 WRFD-021103 Access Class Restriction

Availability

This feature is available from RAN5.1.

Page 391: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 391 of 415

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R99.

Summary

When the RNC’s Signaling Processing Unit(SPU) is overloaded as while as too many UEs

initiate random access, this feature allows operator to control the access priority according to

UEs’ Access Class (AC) via broadcasting System Information Block 3 (SIB3).

Benefits

The benefit of this feature is to decrease the signaling processing load of SPU in certain level

via controlling the UEs’ access sequence, as well as to increase the UEs’ access rate.

Description

In 3GPP prototol there are 16 categories of Access Class (AC), from AC0 to AC15, are

defined to classify the access priority of a UE, as decribed in following Table 7.8.2-1.

AC Application Scope

AC0–AC9 Common users

AC10 Indication of whether or not network access for emergency

calls is allowed for the UEs of AC0 to AC9 or without an IMSI

AC11 PLMN management

AC12 Security service

AC13 Public utilities, such as water and gas suppliers

AC14 Emergency services

AC15 PLMN staff

RNC allocates the Random Access Channel (RACH) resources, including usable access

timeslots and usable access preamble signatures, to the UE according to it’s Access Class. In

the scenario of network congestion, the UE with high access priority will have more

opportunity to access the network than the UE with low access priority.

Huawei’s feature, Access Class Restriction (ACR), only fulfills the access control of user

Access Class from AC0 to AC9 which are in the same level of access priority. Therefore, in

order to implement the user access control of this category of ACs, when RNC’s SPU is under

overloaded, a set of ACs is barred in a restriction interval , then the barred ACs are unbarred

and another set of ACs is restricted in the next restriction interval. This process continues until

the SPU usage becomes normal. As a result, it can help to decrease the network’s signaling

congestion in certain level and increase the user’s access rate.

Page 392: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 392 of 415

Figure 7-8-2-1 Example of Huawei’s ACR control

The access control information of ACR is contained in SIB3 and broadcasted to the UEs with

broadcast channel. As the contents of “Access Class Barred list” IE in SIB3 and their

categories of ACs, UEs make the decision whether to trigger access request in a certain

restriction interval.

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

Page 393: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 393 of 415

7.8.3 WRFD-050424 Traffic Priority Mapping onto Transmission Resources

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

Summary

This feature enables the dynamical mapping of the services onto the transport bearers

according to the TC, ARP, and THP of the user. The operator can flexibly configure the

mapping to fulfill differentiated services while guaranteeing the QoS.

Benefits

This feature implements the mapping from traffic priorities to transmission resources and

provides flexible configuration means for differentiated services and for guarantee of QoS.

Description

This feature dynamically maps the services onto the transport bearers, according to the TC

(Traffic Class), ARP (Allocation/Retention Priority), and THP (Traffic Handling Priority for

interactive service) of the user. The operator can flexibly configure the mapping of service

types onto transmission resources. According to different combinations of TC+ARP+THP, the

operator can choose the transmission resources with different QoS requirements to fulfill

differentiated services while guaranteeing the QoS.

TC\ARP Gold Silver Bronze

R99 conversational R99 C

R99 streaming R99 S1 R99 S2 R99 S3

R99 interactive THP

High

THP

Middle

THP

Low

THP

High

THP

Middle

THP

Low

THP

High

THP

Middle

THP

Low

R99

I11

R99 I12 R99

I13

R99

I21

R99 I22 R99

I23

R99

I31

R99 I32 R99

I33

R99 background R99 B1 R99 B2 R99 B3

HSPA

conversational

HS C

HSPA streaming HS S1 HS S2 HS S3

HSPA interactive THP

High

THP

Middle

THP

Low

THP

High

THP

Middle

THP

Low

THP

High

THP

Middle

THP

Low

HS I11 HS I12 HS

I13

HS I21 HS I22 HS

I23

HS I31 HS I32 HS

I33

HSPA background HS B1 HS B2 HS B3

Page 394: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 394 of 415

ATM transport

In ATM transport, the service data with different priorities is mapped to different ATM

service types. The practical mapping can be flexibly configured.

IP transport

In IP transport, the service data with different priorities is mapped to the IP data stream

with different PHB attributes. The practical mapping can be flexibly configured.

Page 395: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 395 of 415

Page 396: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 396 of 415

The mapping between service bearer and transmission resource also support the primary and

secondary path configuration. In the admission of transmission resource, the primary path is

considered for the service setup firstly, and secondary path will be selected in case of the lack

of primary path bandwidth or failure of the primary path, with this feature, both transmission

reliability and transport efficiency can be improved.

In RAN11.0, the load balancing algorithm is introduced for the path selection to prevent the

uneven load distribution on the primary and secondary path which may lead to the decrease of

transport efficiency. That is, when the load of primary path is too high and the difference with

the secondary path is higher than a configurable threshold, the secondary path will be

selected.

Enhancement

In RAN11.0, the mapping from AAL2 path types to ATM service types is removed, which

makes the priority mapping of ATM services more flexible.

In RAN11.0, the mapping from IP path types to PHBs is removed, which makes the priority

mapping of IP services more flexible.

In RAN11.0, the load balancing algorithm is introduced for the transmission path selection to

enhance transmission efficiency improvement.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

7.8.4 WRFD-020806 Differentiated Service Based on SPI Weight

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

Page 397: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 397 of 415

Summary

HSPA users share Uu interface resources, CE resources, and Iub interface resources. If these

resources cannot provide the maximum bit rate (MBR) for all online HSPA users,

differentiated resource allocation can be performed on users according to user priority or

service type (interactive or background). The differentiation in resource allocation is

controlled by SPI weight.

Benefits

With the development of the HSPA technology, HSPA channels have become the main radio

bearer of UMTS services. This feature is mainly applicable to HSPA channels. It provides

users with differentiated services according to user priority or service type, so that the service

quality of high-priority users is preferentially ensured and high-priority services are

preferentially processed when resources are insufficient. In addition, while meeting the

requirement of GBR,the ratio of the user throughput will try to reach the ratio of SPI weight.

There are three user priorities: gold, silver, and copper. If gold, silver, and copper users are in

the same radio environment, the ratio of user throughput of these users is equivalent to the

ratio of SPI weights of the users. Here is an example:

The ratio of SPI weights of gold, silver, and copper users is 9:3:1.

Services are processed in a cell whose total available bandwidth is 3 Mbit/s.

The cell has a total number of 10 users, and all the users have a large amount of data to

transmit but resources are insufficient.

The mean user throughput of gold, silver, and copper users is 1.1 Mbit/s, 380 kbit/s, and

120 kbit/s, which is equivalent to 9:3:1.

The following table shows the details:

User Priority Gold Silver Copper

Mean Cell Throughput

3 Mbit/s

Number of Online Users

1 3 6

Mean User Throughput

1.1 Mbit/s 380 kbit/s 120 kbit/s

This feature supports differentiated tariff policies, for example, high-tariff users are provided

with better services. It also supports differentiated service quality according to service type

(interactive or background), for example, background services are provided with low service

quality if network bandwidth is insufficient.

Description

HSPA users share Uu interface resources, CE resources, and Iub interface resources, which

are allocated according to their respective resource scheduling algorithms. If this feature is not

enabled, the resource scheduling algorithms mainly ensure the fairness between BE services

(interactive and background services). That is, the resource scheduling algorithms fairly

allocate resources between users based on the guaranteed bit rate (GBR) and maximum bit rate (MBR) required.

Page 398: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 398 of 415

After this feature is enabled, SPI weights can be set for user priorities (gold, silver, and

copper). Resources are allocated according to the set SPI weights. The quality of services with

high SPI weight is preferentially ensured. For example, if Uu interface resources are

insufficient, higher data rate or shorter transmission delay is achieved preferentially for

services with high SPI weight.

Enhancement

In RAN13, except user priority (golden, silver, bronze), SPI Weight can be configured

according to UE category or user subscribed MBR. In this way, the operator can adopt more

flexible promotion strategy to increase the revenue.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

None

Dependency on NodeB hardware

None

Dependency on other RAN features

When applied in the downlink on the Uu interface, this feature depends on the feature

WRFD-01061103 Scheduling based on EPF and GBR.

When applied in the uplink on the Uu interface, this feature depends on the feature

WRFD-01061402 Enhanced Fast UL Scheduling or WRFD-010638 Dynamic CE

Resource Management. When this feature is enabled together with the feature

WRFD-01061402 Enhanced Fast UL Scheduling, only the uplink Uu interface resources

can be differentially scheduled. When this feature is enabled together with the feature

WRFD-010638 Dynamic CE Resource Management, both the uplink Uu interface

resources and CE resources can be differentially scheduled.

When applied in the downlink on the Iub interface, this feature depends on the features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package and WRFD-050405 Overbooking on ATM

Transmission, or depends on the features WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

and WRFD-050408 Overbooking on IP Transmission.

When applied in the uplink on the Iub interface, this feature depends on the feature

WRFD-01061212 HSUPA Iub Flow Control in Case of Iub Congestion.

Dependency on other NEs

None

7.8.5 WRFD-020131 Optimization of R99 and HSUPA Users Fairness

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0.

Page 399: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 399 of 415

Summary

In scenarios where R99 users and HSUPA users share the same carrier, this feature enables

telecom operators to provide service for R99 and HSUPA users in a fair way and thus improve

the experience of HSUPA users. This is achieved by considering the satisfaction rate

(real-time user rate/GBR) of both types of user.

Benefits

This feature helps improve the fairness of resource allocation between HSUPA and R99 users

and raise the satisfaction of HSUPA users.

Description

With the increase of the commercial use of HSUPA, the HSUPA user experience has become

more and more important. As a result, the original policy based on which R99 users take

precedence over other users does not follow this trend. In scenarios where R99 users and

HSUPA users share the same carrier, the throughput of R99 users might be higher than that of

HSUPA users at the same priority level.

This feature enables the periodic comparison of satisfaction between R99 and HSUPA users.

The comparison considers the ratio of actual service rates of users to the Guaranteed Bit Rate

(GBR) values. If the satisfaction degree of R99 users is higher than that of HSUPA users and

reaches a certain preset threshold, the rate decrease of high-rate R99 BE services is triggered

and the rate increase of low-rate R99 BE services is limited.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

None

Dependency on NodeB hardware

BTS3812E/BTS3812AE should be configured with EBBI, EDLP; HBBI and HDLP

cannot support this feature.

DBS3800 should be configured with EBBC or EBBCd; BBU3806 cannot support this

feature; BBU3806C should be configured with EBBM;

3900 series base station should be configured with WBBPb or WBBPd; WBBPa cannot

support this feature.

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-010612 HSUPA introduction package

WRFD-021101 Dynamic Channel Configuration Control (DCCC)

Dependency on other NEs

None

Page 400: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 400 of 415

7.8.6 WRFD-011502 Active Queue Management (AQM)

Availability

This feature is available from RAN10.0.

Summary

This feature provides approach of queue management and shorten the period of HTTP

queuing.

Benefits

AQM can improve user’s feeling when HTTP and download services simultaneously exist.

Description

This feature is valid for R99 packet connections for up to 384 kbit/s packet data.

In an interactive packet-data connection, the packet data to transfer is typically characterized

by large variations, so the buffer is introduced to even out the variations. However, if the

buffer is filled up or an overflow situation takes place, it will result in loss of data packets.

Currently, TCP as the main transport layer protocol is used on Internet. Packet loss is regarded

as link congestion by TCP, and TCP will correspondingly reduce the data transmission rate.

TCP protocol is also sensitive to round trip delays and it will take actions differently in case

just one packet is missing or if a burst of packets is lost. In case of uncontrolled packet losses,

it may take a considerable time for the data rate to increase again, leading to poor radio link

utilization and causing long delays for the end user.

In addition, in case a user is performing parallel activities, e.g. FTP download and web

browsing, if the file download would fill the buffers and thereby cause a long delay before

anything would happen when clicking on a link.

The functionality of AQM is provided as an optimized buffer handling method, in order to

interact with the TCP protocol in a favorable manner and reduce the buffering delay. It is

possible for the operator to switch on/off the Active Queue Management function

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Page 401: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 401 of 415

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

7.8.7 WRFD-020128 Quality Improvement for Subscribed Service

Availability

This feature is available from RAN12.0.

Summary

To provide better services to customers and to enhance the competitiveness, some service

providers are ready to pay extra to network operators to sign a contract for obtaining better

transmission quality for specific services. These service providers are called subscribed

customers and the specific services are called subscribed services.

IP transmission is used widely. In IP transmission, the service data is transmitted in IP packets,

and the IP header contains the information that indicates the source IP address, destination IP

address, source port number, and destination port number. So the data source can be identified

through IP header analyzing. Based on this technique, the network operator can identify the

data of subscribed services and ensure that the subscribed services have better quality such as

higher throughput or shorter delay. In this way, customers can have better experience for

subscribed services than for ordinary services.

Benefits

With this feature, end users can have better experience for subscribed services and the status

of the subscribed service provider is elevated. In this way, the competitiveness of the

subscribed service provider is enhanced. Moreover, the network operator can get extra income

from the subscribed service provider.

Description

If IP transmission is used at the network layer, the IP header contains the information that

indicates the source of the service data. So the operator can identify whether the data is of the

subscribed services by checking the IP address and port number in the IP header. For the data

of subscribed services, if the data is carried over HSPA channels, the operator enhances the

capability of the service to obtain Iub interface resources, Uu interface resources, and CE

resources. In this way, the throughput of the service on the radio access network is enhanced,

the data transmission delay is reduced, and thus the user experience is enhanced.

The effect of this feature is more obvious when the traffic load over the access network is

high.

Page 402: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 402 of 415

Enhancement

None.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

Only BSC6900 supports this feature.

Dependency on Node B

For BTS3812E and BTS3812AE, EBBI, EBOI, EULP or EULPd board is needed.

For BBU3806, EBBC/EBBCd is needed.

For BBU3806C, EBBM is needed.

For BBU3900, WBBPb or WBBPd is needed.

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

WRFD-010610 HSDPA Introduction Package

7.8.8 WRFD-020123 TCP Accelerator

Availability

This feature is available from RAN11.0.

Summary

A series of enhanced TCP functions adaptive to the link characteristics on the RAN side are

implemented on the RNC. This feature enables the performance of the TCP protocol derived

from the wired network to be greatly improved in the wireless network, thus improving user

experience and system efficiency.

Benefits

This feature mitigates the impact of some factors such as packet loss on the RAN to affect

negatively the performance of TCP data transmission, accelerates the slow startup and fast

retransmission of the server during the data transmission, increases the UL/DL data

transmission efficiency, and reduces the UL/DL transmission delay, thus greatly improving

the PS data transmission performance.

Page 403: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 403 of 415

For example: (1) The time to download a small size file of 500kbyte can be decreased by 20%.

(2) When a user downloads and uploads large size files with the bandwidth of 2Mbit/s and

one TCP connection at the same time, the downlink rate can be increased by 50%.

Feature Description

The TCP/IP protocol is extensively used all over the world. It was initially developed for

wired transmission and later also used in wireless networks. However wireless networks

exhibit some characteristics quite different from the wired network. A typical example is that

of packet losses which, in a wired network, is commonly due to congestion in some network

elements, whereas in a wireless network such losses can be due to transmission errors over the

air interface. This has a significant impact on the overall performance of the data transmission,

due to the way the TCP/IP protocols reacts to such packet losses. To mitigate this effect, a

number of enhancements have been implemented in the RNC

A TCP accelerator functionality is implemented in the RNC. The TCP Proxy Entity (TPE for

short) is used to improve the data transmission performance in the wireless network. The TPE

processes the TCP/IP packets by adopting TCP performance optimization technologies such

buffering and sorting of DL data, ACK splitting, DupACK duplication, local retransmission,

building Window Scaling (WS) indication, and enhanced simultaneous DL/UL data

transmission. In addition, the buffering and sorting of UL data is adopted to prevent factors,

such as packet loss and transmission delay in the RAN, from affecting the UL TCP data

transmission. This feature also accelerates the slow startup and congestion prevention of the

server during the UL data transmission, increases the UL data transmission efficiency, reduces

the UL transmission delay, and improves the DL throughput in the case of simultaneous

uploading and downloading. Therefore, this feature greatly improves the PS data transmission

performance.

ACK splitting

In TCP, the congestion window is updated according to the number of received ACK

messages and is expanded by increasing the number of ACK messages. When a slow

startup occurs at the transmitting end, ACK splitting can quickly recover the congestion

window; when the transmitting end works in congestion avoidance mode, ACK splitting

can accelerate the expansion of the congestion window.

DupACK duplication

In TCP, a lost TCP packet is retransmitted after three DupACK are received. With this

feature, after the TPE receives the ACK message from the UE, the TPE immediately

duplicates three DupACK messages and sends them to the Server if it detects that the

packets requested by the ACK are not in the buffer. This shortens the time for packet

retransmission.

Local retransmission

When packet loss occurs on the air interface, the TPE, rather than the transmitting end,

retransmits the packet to the receiving end, thus reducing the time for retransmission.

Packet sorting

Sorting of the disordered DL packets is as follows. The TPE sorts and transmits the

disordered DL packets to avoid unnecessary transmission of DupACKs in the uplink and

to prevent TPE local retransmission caused by disordered packets. In this way,

transmission resources are saved.

Sorting of the disordered UL packets is as follows. The TPE sorts the UL packets and

transmits them to the core network (CN) in sequence. This avoids the deterioration of the

UL data transmission performance caused by the disordered UL packets.

Page 404: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 404 of 415

Building WS indication

When TCP window size in server side is 64KB, the synchronization packet will not

include WS indication. If the receiving side detects that there is no WS indication, the

synchronization ACK packet returned by receiving side will not include WS indication.

In this case, even if the capability of the receiving end is greater than 64KB, the window

size is limited to 64KB. Therefore, the throughput is decreased if the actual receiving

capability exceeds 64KB.

Enhanced simultaneous downlink and uplink transmission

If data are transmitted in the uplink and downlink simultaneously, UE needs to send data

and TCP ACK/NACK information corresponding to downlink data. However, TCP

ACK/NACK information may be blocked on the UE side by uplink data packet.

Therefore, the TCP ACK information of downlink data is delayed, which may affect the

downlink throughput. This feature can monitor the TCP packet reception in UE. If a TCP

packet is received by UE correctly, TPE builds ACK information and sends it to the

server. Then, the server TCP tx window can slide more quickly and the downlink

throughput will be increased.

Enhancement

The enhanced UL data transmission is introduced in RAN12.0.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

NA

Dependency on Other Features

NA

7.8.9 WRFD-010507 Rate Negotiation at Admission Control

Availability

This feature is available from RAN3.0.

This feature is introduced in 3GPP R4.

Page 405: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 405 of 415

Summary

This feature enables QoS negotiation and RAB downsizing on the Iu interface.

Benefits

Based on the QoS negotiation mechanism, this feature can enhance the RAB setup process

and shorten the service setup time.

This feature can greatly increase the success rate of call setup and hard handover and

maximize resource usage and system capacity.

Description

This feature makes it possible for a call to access the network with a lower bit rate in case that

cell resource is not enough, and it comprises the following two parts

Iu QoS negotiation

RAB Downsizing

The access success rate, system capacity, and performance can be improved with this feature.

I. Iu QoS negotiation

In Release 99, the UTRAN accepts or rejects a radio access bearer request only from the CN.

If the QoS requirement of the service defined in the RAN establishment request is higher than

that can be handled by UTRAN, the UTRAN cannot accept it. For the services having higher

QoS requirement could accept lower QoS requirements than those requested by the CN in the

RAB establishment request. There are no means for the UTRAN to propose an alternative

(lower) QoS.

For such services, the RAB establishment will fail, or alternatively the CN could re-attempt

the RAB re-establishment with lower QoS requirements. This would significantly increase the

setup time. Therefore, a QoS negotiation mechanism is introduced in Release 4. This aligns

the procedure with the already existing CN solution used in GPRS and shortens the service

setup time. Such a mechanism also applies to the relocation procedure by adding Alternative

RAB Parameter Values IE in the RANAP RAB ASSIGNMENT REQUEST or

RELOCATION REQUEST message.

The Iu QoS negotiation mainly aims for the PS streaming service and is used to negotiate the

maximum and initial bit rate for the service.

Maximum bit rate negotiation

The UE capability will be considered to decide the maximum bit rate. That is, the

maximum bit rate will be selected among the maximum bit rate assigned and the

alternative ones in descending order until it meets the UE capability. If the HSPA is

related, the UE capability with HSPA will be used.

Initial bit rate negotiation

To decide the initial bit rate, the following load information should be considered:

− Uplink and downlink radio load states of the cell

− Iub resource state

− Minimum spreading factor supported

− HSPA capability. If a service is related to HSPA, the UE capability must be

considered to get a proper bit rate.

Page 406: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 406 of 415

When the cell with radio load or Iub resource load is congested, the minimum bit rate among

the assigned Guaranteed Bit Rate (GBR) will be selected for service admission. Otherwise,

the bit rate among negotiated maximum bit rate and guaranteed bit rate will be selected in

descending order until it meets the load and capability requirements mentioned above.

After the maximum and initial bit rates are made certain and the subsequent admission

procedure is successful, the RNC will inform the CN node of the negotiated bit rate through

RAB ASSIGNMENT REPONSE or RELOCATION REQUEST ACKNOWLEDGE message.

II. RAB downsizing

The RAB downsizing applies mainly to Best Effort (BE) service (interactive or background

service). In an ideal scenario, BE service can always access the network with the maximum

request bit rate if there is enough cell resources, but such a process cannot meet the system

capacity and performance requirements while the system resource is limited. Therefore, the

RNC will try to negotiate the proper maximum and initial bit rate as Iu QoS negotiation does.

Maximum bit rate negotiation

UE capability will be considered to decide the maximum bit rate. That is, the maximum

bit rate will be selected among the maximum bit rate assigned to 8 kbit/s in descending

order until it meets the UE capability. If the HDPA is related, UE capability with HSPA

will be used.

Initial or target bit rate negotiation

The following load information will be considered to decide the initial bit rate:

− Uplink and downlink radio load states of the cell

− Available Iub resource

− Minimum spreading factor supported

− Available credit resource

− HSPA capability, if the service related to HSPA, the UE-related capability must be

considered to get a proper bit rate.

When radio load is congested, GBR will be selected to admit to maximize the access

successful rate. Otherwise, the bit rate among negotiated maximum bit rate to 8 kbit/s will be

selected in descending order until it meets the load and capability requirements mentioned

above.

RAB downsizing can also be applied in the hard handover procedure. That is, with this feature,

during the hard handover procedure, the target cell load will be considered, the downgraded

hard handover may be triggered to maximize the handover successful rate.

Enhancement

In RAN5.0, Iu QoS negotiation feature is introduced.

In RAN5.0, RAB downsizing used in the hard handover procedure is supported.

In RAN5.1, HSPA capability is taken into consideration, and in RAN6.0 the HSUPA feature is

introduced.

In RAN10.0, RAB downsizing can also be applied when the request for adding new radio

links in the AS in soft/softer handover is rejected by admission control due to resource

limitation. The rate will be downgraded according to the cell load information, in order to

avoid the call drop due to soft handover failure.

Page 407: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 407 of 415

In RAN11.0, the newly added policy is that the access of the PS service, if denied, allows an

access rate of 0 kbit/s or the implementation on the FACH.

RAN11.0 decides the downlink initial access rate of the R99 BE service on the DCH

according to the Ec/Io contained in the RRC CONNECTION REQUEST message. If the

Ec/Io is higher than the related threshold, the downlink initial access rate is min[384k, MBR]

(where MBR is the maximum bit rate assigned by the CN); if the Ec/Io is lower than the

threshold, the downlink initial access rate is the default value.

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

NA

Dependency on Node B

NA

Dependency on UE

NA

Dependency on Other Network Units

NA

Dependency on CN

For Iu QoS negotiation, the CN node needs to support this feature, but for RAB downsizing,

the CN node does not need to support this feature.

Dependency on Other Features

NA

7.8.10 WRFD-020130 Videophone Service Restriction

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0.

Summary

This feature disables the videophone (VP) function of a cell through cell-level configurations.

Benefits

This feature meets telecom operators' requirements for information security in restricted areas.

It prevents leakage of information through VP.

Description

In restricted areas such as military management areas and key laboratories, the use of VP may

lead to leakage of information. To meet the security requirements in these areas, the RNC

Page 408: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 408 of 415

supports the prohibition of VP services at the cell level. Through configurations on the Local

Maintenance Terminal (LMT), the VP services of all UEs in a cell can be prohibited.

The implementation of this feature involves the following aspects:

Prohibiting VP service setup during service establishment

Releasing VP services in the case of an incoming handover, for example, retaining other

services except VP services when the UE has multiple concurrent services to process

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC hardware

None

Dependency on NodeB hardware

None

Dependency on other RAN features

None

Dependency on other NEs

None

7.8.11 WRFD-020135 Intelligent Inter-Carrier UE Layered Management

Availability

This feature is available from RAN13.0.

Summary

This feature allows the RAN to intelligently distinguish between UEs and data cards in

multi-carrier scenarios and to separately set up services on different carriers.

Benefits

With the rapid growth of mobile broadband, use of data cards to access the Internet has

become a common occurrence. Data card traffic is characterized by its long duration and high

volume. It increases operator profit but also increases network load. Other services of the

same carrier may be negatively affected.

Use of separate carriers for data card services allows full utilization of carrier resources and

keeps data card traffic from affecting other services. This helps operators formulate flexible

billing policies, develop large-scale data card services, and establish Mobile Broadband (MBB) brands.

Page 409: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 409 of 415

Description

This feature allows the RAN to intelligently distinguish between UEs and data cards in

multi-carrier scenarios and to separately establish services on different carriers based on

priority configuration. This feature is applicable to UEs during the access procedure and in

connected mode.

This feature requires operators to separately allocate IMSI ranges to UEs and data cards. The

RNC determines the terminal type based on the IMSI of the terminal and configured rules.

Each carrier is assigned a priority corresponding to a terminal type. During the RAB setup,

the cell with the highest priority for the terminal type is chosen for access. This achieves the

layered assignment of terminals to specific carriers. After a service is established, periodic

directed retry based on the terminal type can be performed for handover to the highest-priority

carrier.

Enhancement

None

Dependency

This feature requires operators to separately allocate IMSI ranges to mobile and data card

UEs.

Dependency on the RNC hardware

None

Dependency on the NodeB hardware

None

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-020400 DRD Introduction Package

Page 410: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 410 of 415

8 O&M Experience

8.1 Advanced Planning

8.1.1 WRFD-140219 Micro NodeB Self-Planning

Availability

This feature is available from RAN14.0.

Summary

This feature provides an automatic network planning function for micro NodeBs, which can

determine available UTRA Absolute Radio Frequency Channel Numbers (UARFCNs),

scrambling codes, neighboring cell relationships, and LAC/SAC/RAC parameters for micro

NodeBs.

Benefits

With this feature, the system automatically scans the radio environment and sets the radio

parameters such as UARFCNs and scrambling codes. This feature simplifies micro NodeB

network planning while also making it more efficient and reducing the cost.

Description

Network planning is mandatory for WCDMA network deployment. WCDMA network

planning, including site survey and network dimensioning, is generally performed manually,

which results in a high cost and a lengthy deployment schedule.

To improve network planning efficiency and meet the customers' requirements of automatic

micro NodeB deployment, this feature automatically determines available UTRA Absolute

Radio Frequency Channel Numbers (UARFCNs), scrambling codes, neighboring cell

relationships, and LAC/SAC/RAC parameters for micro NodeBs. With this feature, the

system automatically performs the following functions:

Scans the radio environment to collect raw data.

Sets radio parameters by using radio parameter planning algorithms.

Configures radio parameters on network elements (NEs) through the operation and

maintenance (O&M) channel.

Enhancement

None

Page 411: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 411 of 415

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

Need RNC to support M2000 remoting configuration.

Dependency on NodeB

Only the BTS3902E supports this feature.

Dependency on UE

None

Dependency on CN

None

Dependency on other NEs

The M2000 must support Node B plug and play and BTS3902E WCDMA self-planning.

Need GBSC, whose verion is GBSS14.0 or later, to support M2000 remoting revision.

Dependency on other RAN features

WRFD-031101 NodeB Self-Discovery Based on IP Route

WRFD-031102 NodeB Remote Self-configuration

9 Site Solution

9.1 Solution

9.1.1 WRFD-140220 Intelligent Battery Management

Availability

This feature is available from RAN14.0.

Summary

With this feature,

Page 412: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 412 of 415

The battery management mode automatically changes depending on the selected grid

type, which prolongs the battery lifespan.

The battery self-protection function is triggered under high temperature, which prevents

battery overuse and damage.

The runtime of batteries is displayed if the mains supply is cut off. Users can then take

measures to prevent service interruption.

Benefits

The benefits of this feature are as follows:

Prolonged battery lifespan

Less energy consumption

Reduced operation costs

Improved system stability

Description Automatic change of the battery management mode

The PMU board records the number of times the power supply is cut and the duration of each

instance. Then, the PMU board determines the grid type and correspondingly activates the

appropriate power management mode. If the grid type is 1 or 2, batteries can enter the

hibernation state, in which batteries do not charge or discharge, which helps prolong battery

lifespan.

Number of

Hours Without

External Power

in a 15-Day

Period

Grid

Type

Charge and

Discharge

Mode

Current

Limitation

Valve

Hibernation

Voltage (V)

Hibernation

Duration

(Days)

Estimated

Battery

Lifespan

Improvement

Rate

≤ 5 1 Mode A 0.10 C 52 13 100%

5-30 2 Mode B 0.15 C 52 6 50%

30-120 3 Mode C 0.15 C N/A N/A 0%

≥ 120 4 Mode C N/A N/A

The automatic change function of the battery management mode is under license control. This

function is disabled by default and users can enable it by running an MML command.

Self-protection under high temperature

If the battery temperature exceeds the threshold for entering the floating charge state for 5

minutes, the batteries enter this state and no alarms are generated.

If the battery temperature exceeds the threshold for triggering the self-protection function for

5 minutes, the batteries are automatically powered off or the battery voltage is automatically

adjusted.

Battery runtime display

Page 413: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 413 of 415

If the mains supply is cut off, the base station calculates the battery runtime based on such

information as the remaining power capacity and discharge current. Users can query the

runtime by running an MML command.

The NodeB calculates the runtime of batteries with the following formula:

Runtime of batteries = (Remaining power capacity x Total power capacity x Discharge

efficiency)/(Mean discharge current x Aging coefficient)

Enhancement

None

Dependency

Dependency on RNC

None

Dependency on NodeB

The PMU board, PSU board, and batteries must be configured.

Dependency on other RAN features

None

Dependency on the UE

None

Dependency on the CN

None

Page 414: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 414 of 415

10 Acronyms and Abbreviations

3G The Third Generation

AP Access Point

APM Advanced Power Module

AQM Active Queue Management

BBU Baseband Unit

BITS Building Integrated Timing Supply System

BTS Base Station

CBS Cell Broadcast Service

CPC Continuous Packet Connectivity

CPE Customer Premises Equipment

DNBS Distributed Node B System

DSAC Domain Specific Access Control

ETSI European Telecommunications Standards Institute

FTP File Transfer Protocol

GIS Geographical Information System

GA General Available

GBR Guaranteed Bit Rate

GLONASS GLObal Navigation Satellite System

GPS Global Position System

HCS hierarchical Cell Structure

HSDPA High Speed Downlink Packet Access

HSUPA High Speed Uplink Packet Access

LCS Location Service

Page 415: RAN14.0 Optional Feature Description

RAN12.0 Optional Feature Description

Issue 0.5 (2010-06-10) Commercial in Confidence Page 415 of 415

LTE Long Term Evolution

MBMS Multimedia Broadcast Multicast Service

MIMO Multi-Input Multi-Output

NACC Network Assisted Cell Change

PA Power Amplifier

PARC Platform Advanced Radio Control

PPS Pulse Per Second

QAM Quadrature Amplitude Modulation

RAN Radio Access Network

RET Remote Electrical Antenna

RNC Radio Network Controller

ROHC Robust Header Compression

RRM Radio Resource Management

SAE System Architecture Evolution

SASA Same Band Antenna Sharing Adapter

SASU Same Band Antenna Sharing Unit

SNA Shared Network Area

TGW Transmission Gateway

VoIP Voice over IP

WCDMA Wideband Code Division Multiple Access